MS 10-Q Quarterly Report June 30, 2014 | Alphaminr

MS 10-Q Quarter ended June 30, 2014

MORGAN STANLEY
10-Ks and 10-Qs
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
10-Q
10-Q
10-Q
10-K
PROXIES
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
DEF 14A
10-Q 1 d763478d10q.htm FORM 10-Q Form 10-Q
Table of Contents

UNITED STATES SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

Washington, D.C. 20549

FORM 10-Q

x QUARTERLY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES

EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

For the quarterly period ended June 30, 2014

OR

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES

EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

Commission File Number 1-11758

LOGO

(Exact Name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

Delaware

(State or other jurisdiction of

incorporation or organization)

1585 Broadway

New York, NY 10036

(Address of principal executive offices, including zip code)

36-3145972

(I.R.S. Employer Identification No.)

(212) 761-4000

(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.    Yes x No ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§ 232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the Registrant was required to submit and post such files).    Yes x No ¨

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

Large Accelerated Filer x

Accelerated Filer ¨

Non-Accelerated Filer ¨

Smaller reporting company ¨

(Do not check if a smaller reporting company)

Indicate by check mark whether the Registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).    Yes ¨ No x

As of July 31, 2014, there were 1,963,354,359 shares of the Registrant’s Common Stock, par value $0.01 per share, outstanding.


Table of Contents

LOGO

QUARTERLY REPORT ON FORM 10-Q

For the quarter ended June 30, 2014

Table of Contents Page

Part I—Financial Information

Item 1.

Financial Statements (unaudited) 1

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition—June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013

1

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income—Three and Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

2

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income—Three and Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

3

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows—Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013

4

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Changes in Total Equity—Six Months Ended June  30, 2014 and 2013

5

Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited)

7

Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

96

Item 2.

Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations 97

Introduction

97

Executive Summary

98

Business Segments

105

Accounting Developments

121

Other Matters

122

Critical Accounting Policies

126

Liquidity and Capital Resources

130

Item 3.

Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk 150

Item 4.

Controls and Procedures 167

Financial Data Supplement (unaudited)

168

Part II—Other Information

Item 1.

Legal Proceedings 174

Item 2.

Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds 177

Item 6.

Exhibits 177

i LOGO


Table of Contents

AVAILABLE INFORMATION

Morgan Stanley files annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy statements and other information with the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”). You may read and copy any document we file with the SEC at the SEC’s public reference room at 100 F Street, NE, Washington, DC 20549. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for information on the public reference room. The SEC maintains an internet site that contains annual, quarterly and current reports, proxy and information statements and other information that issuers (including Morgan Stanley) file electronically with the SEC. Morgan Stanley’s electronic SEC filings are available to the public at the SEC’s internet site, www.sec.gov .

Morgan Stanley’s internet site is www.morganstanley.com . You can access Morgan Stanley’s Investor Relations webpage at www.morganstanley.com/about/ir . Morgan Stanley makes available free of charge, on or through its Investor Relations webpage, its proxy statements, Annual Reports on Form 10-K, Quarterly Reports on Form 10-Q, Current Reports on Form 8-K and any amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), as soon as reasonably practicable after such material is electronically filed with, or furnished to, the SEC. Morgan Stanley also makes available, through its Investor Relations webpage, via a link to the SEC’s internet site, statements of beneficial ownership of Morgan Stanley’s equity securities filed by its directors, officers, 10% or greater shareholders and others under Section 16 of the Exchange Act.

Morgan Stanley has a Corporate Governance webpage. You can access information about Morgan Stanley’s corporate governance at www.morganstanley.com/about/company/governance . Morgan Stanley posts the following on its Corporate Governance webpage:

Amended and Restated Certificate of Incorporation;

Amended and Restated Bylaws;

Charters for its Audit Committee; Operations and Technology Committee; Compensation, Management Development and Succession Committee; Nominating and Governance Committee; and Risk Committee;

Corporate Governance Policies;

Policy Regarding Communication with the Board of Directors;

Policy Regarding Director Candidates Recommended by Shareholders;

Policy Regarding Corporate Political Activities;

Policy Regarding Shareholder Rights Plan;

Code of Ethics and Business Conduct;

Code of Conduct; and

Integrity Hotline information.

Morgan Stanley’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct applies to all directors, officers and employees, including its Chief Executive Officer, Chief Financial Officer and Deputy Chief Financial Officer. Morgan Stanley will post any amendments to the Code of Ethics and Business Conduct and any waivers that are required to be disclosed by the rules of either the SEC or the New York Stock Exchange LLC (“NYSE”) on its internet site. You can request a copy of these documents, excluding exhibits, at no cost, by contacting Investor Relations, 1585 Broadway, New York, NY 10036 (212-761-4000). The information on Morgan Stanley’s internet site is not incorporated by reference into this report.

LOGO ii


Table of Contents

Part I—Financial Information.

Item 1. Financial Statements.

MORGAN STANLEY

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition

(dollars in millions, except share data)

(unaudited)

June 30,
2014
December 31,
2013

Assets

Cash and due from banks ($48 and $544 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, related to consolidated variable interest entities, generally not available to the Company)

$ 18,863 $ 16,602

Interest bearing deposits with banks

22,022 43,281

Cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements ($129 and $117 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, related to consolidated variable interest entities, generally not available to the Company)

44,713 39,203

Trading assets, at fair value ($126,867 and $151,078 were pledged to various parties at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively) ($1,218 and $2,825 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, related to consolidated variable interest entities, generally not available to the Company)

259,561 280,744

Available for sale securities, at fair value

65,474 53,430

Securities received as collateral, at fair value

19,498 20,508

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell (includes $864 and $866 at fair value at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively)

108,956 118,130

Securities borrowed

147,466 129,707

Customer and other receivables

54,557 57,104

Loans:

Held for investment (net of allowances of $138 and $156 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively)

48,630 36,545

Held for sale

6,630 6,329

Other investments ($511 and $561 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, related to consolidated variable interest entities, generally not available to the Company)

4,899 5,086

Premises, equipment and software costs (net of accumulated depreciation of $6,406 and $6,420 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively) ($194 and $201 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, related to consolidated variable interest entities, generally not available to the Company)

5,911 6,019

Goodwill

6,600 6,595

Intangible assets (net of accumulated amortization of $1,849 and $1,703 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively) (includes $6 and $8 at fair value at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively)

3,137 3,286

Other assets ($23 and $11 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, related to consolidated variable interest entities, generally not available to the Company)

9,651 10,133

Total assets

$ 826,568 $ 832,702

Liabilities

Deposits (includes $0 and $185 at fair value at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively).

$ 117,695 $ 112,379

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings (includes $1,315 and $1,347 at fair value at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively)

1,783 2,142

Trading liabilities, at fair value ($1 and $33 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, related to consolidated variable interest entities, generally non-recourse to the Company)

109,877 104,521

Obligation to return securities received as collateral, at fair value

25,449 24,568

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase (includes $614 and $561 at fair value at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively)

111,420 145,676

Securities loaned

30,808 32,799

Other secured financings (includes $5,056 and $5,206 at fair value at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively) ($370 and $543 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, related to consolidated variable interest entities, generally non-recourse to the Company)

14,007 14,215

Customer and other payables

178,883 157,125

Other liabilities and accrued expenses ($70 and $76 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, related to consolidated variable interest entities, generally non-recourse to the Company)

14,962 16,672

Long-term borrowings (includes $35,219 and $35,637 at fair value at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively)

149,483 153,575

Total liabilities

754,367 763,672

Commitments and contingent liabilities (see Note 11)

Equity

Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity:

Preferred stock (see Note 13)

5,020 3,220

Common stock, $0.01 par value:

Shares authorized: 3,500,000,000 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013;

Shares issued: 2,038,893,979 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013;

Shares outstanding: 1,964,503,356 and 1,944,868,751 at June 30,2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively

20 20

Additional paid-in capital

23,608 24,570

Retained earnings

45,145 42,172

Employee stock trusts

2,147 1,718

Accumulated other comprehensive loss

(733 ) (1,093 )

Common stock held in treasury, at cost, $0.01 par value:

Shares outstanding: 74,390,623 and 94,025,228 at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively

(2,305 ) (2,968 )

Common stock issued to employee stock trusts

(2,147 ) (1,718 )

Total Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity

70,755 65,921

Nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

1,446 3,109

Total equity

72,201 69,030

Total liabilities and equity

$ 826,568 $ 832,702

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements

1 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income

(dollars in millions, except share and per share data)

(unaudited)

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013

Revenues:

Investment banking

$ 1,633 $ 1,303 $ 2,941 $ 2,527

Trading

2,516 2,894 5,478 5,588

Investments

227 188 586 526

Commissions and fees

1,138 1,217 2,354 2,384

Asset management, distribution and administration fees

2,621 2,404 5,170 4,750

Other

206 305 451 522

Total non-interest revenues

8,341 8,311 16,980 16,297

Interest income

1,250 1,268 2,593 2,612

Interest expense

983 1,064 2,018 2,226

Net interest

267 204 575 386

Net revenues

8,608 8,515 17,555 16,683

Non-interest expenses:

Compensation and benefits

4,200 4,103 8,505 8,317

Occupancy and equipment

359 374 718 751

Brokerage, clearing and exchange fees

458 456 901 884

Information processing and communications

411 470 835 918

Marketing and business development

165 163 312 297

Professional services

532 458 984 898

Other

550 695 1,042 1,221

Total non-interest expenses

6,675 6,719 13,297 13,286

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

1,933 1,796 4,258 3,397

Provision for income taxes

15 574 795 925

Income from continuing operations

1,918 1,222 3,463 2,472

Discontinued operations:

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes

(2 ) (44 ) 42 (74 )

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

(1 ) (13 ) 4 (24 )

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(1 ) (31 ) 38 (50 )

Net income

$ 1,917 $ 1,191 $ 3,501 $ 2,422

Net income applicable to redeemable noncontrolling interests

100 222

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

18 111 97 258

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 1,899 $ 980 $ 3,404 $ 1,942

Preferred stock dividends and other

79 177 135 203

Earnings applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders

$ 1,820 $ 803 $ 3,269 $ 1,739

Amounts applicable to Morgan Stanley:

Income from continuing operations

$ 1,900 $ 1,011 $ 3,366 $ 1,992

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(1 ) (31 ) 38 (50 )

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 1,899 $ 980 $ 3,404 $ 1,942

Earnings per basic common share:

Income from continuing operations

$ 0.94 $ 0.44 $ 1.68 $ 0.94

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(0.02 ) 0.02 (0.03 )

Earnings per basic common share

$ 0.94 $ 0.42 $ 1.70 $ 0.91

Earnings per diluted common share:

Income from continuing operations

$ 0.92 $ 0.43 $ 1.64 $ 0.92

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(0.02 ) 0.02 (0.03 )

Earnings per diluted common share

$ 0.92 $ 0.41 $ 1.66 $ 0.89

Dividends declared per common share

$ 0.10 $ 0.05 $ 0.15 $ 0.10

Average common shares outstanding:

Basic

1,928,250,328 1,907,737,175 1,926,260,244 1,904,470,952

Diluted

1,969,698,239 1,951,362,736 1,969,675,518 1,945,813,411

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

LOGO 2


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income

(dollars in millions)

(unaudited)

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013

Net income

$ 1,917 $ 1,191 $ 3,501 $ 2,422

Other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax:

Foreign currency translation adjustments(1)

$ 86 $ (201 ) $ 152 $ (446 )

Amortization of cash flow hedges(2)

1 1 2 2

Change in net unrealized gains (losses) on available for sale securities(3)

162 (342 ) 236 (369 )

Pension, postretirement and other related adjustments(4)

4 10 6 11

Total other comprehensive income (loss)

$ 253 $ (532 ) $ 396 $ (802 )

Comprehensive income

$ 2,170 $ 659 $ 3,897 $ 1,620

Net income applicable to redeemable noncontrolling interests

100 222

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

18 111 97 258

Other comprehensive income (loss) applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

18 (57 ) 36 (149 )

Comprehensive income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 2,134 $ 505 $ 3,764 $ 1,289

(1) Amounts are net of provision for (benefit from) income taxes of $(56) million and $135 million for the quarters ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and $(112) million and $300 million for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(2) Amounts are net of provision for income taxes of $1 million for the quarter ended June 30, 2013, and $1 million and $2 million for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(3) Amounts are net of provision for (benefit from) income taxes of $112 million and $(234) million for the quarters ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and $162 million and $(253) million for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(4) Amounts are net of provision for income taxes of $1 million and $6 million for the quarters ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and $2 million and $11 million for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

3 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows

(dollars in millions)

(unaudited)

Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013

CASH FLOWS FROM OPERATING ACTIVITIES

Net income

$ 3,501 $ 2,422

Adjustments to reconcile net income to net cash provided by operating activities:

Income from equity method investments

(76 ) (228 )

Compensation payable in common stock and options

629 559

Depreciation and amortization

612 716

Net gain on business dispositions

(88 ) (30 )

Net gain on sale of available for sale securities

(16 ) (38 )

Impairment charges

77 112

Provision for credit losses on lending activities

15 63

Other non-cash adjustments to net income

(43 ) 13

Changes in assets and liabilities:

Cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements

(5,510 ) (4,393 )

Trading assets, net of Trading liabilities

26,695 12,075

Securities borrowed

(17,759 ) (7,413 )

Securities loaned

(1,991 ) (714 )

Customer and other receivables and other assets

2,904 (883 )

Customer and other payables and other liabilities

21,972 13,315

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

9,174 (8,082 )

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

(34,221 ) 10,908

Net cash provided by operating activities

5,875 18,402

CASH FLOWS FROM INVESTING ACTIVITIES

Proceeds from (payments for):

Premises, equipment and software

(413 ) (583 )

Business dispositions, net of cash disposed

167 530

Loans

(11,798 ) (3,441 )

Purchases of available for sale securities

(19,329 ) (14,335 )

Sales of available for sale securities

5,499 8,377

Maturities and redemptions of available for sale securities

2,153 2,663

Other investing activities

(388 ) 186

Net cash used for investing activities

(24,109 ) (6,603 )

CASH FLOWS FROM FINANCING ACTIVITIES

Net proceeds from (payments for):

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings

(359 ) 228

Noncontrolling interests

(189 ) (540 )

Other secured financings

194 (1,761 )

Deposits

5,316 (1,752 )

Proceeds from:

Excess tax benefits associated with stock-based awards

85 13

Derivatives financing activities

360 459

Issuance of preferred stock, net of issuance costs

1,788

Issuance of long-term borrowings

14,825 21,698

Payments for:

Long-term borrowings

(21,342 ) (22,958 )

Derivatives financing activities

(170 ) (498 )

Repurchases of common stock and employee tax withholdings

(964 ) (314 )

Purchase of additional stake in Wealth Management JV

(4,725 )

Cash dividends

(387 ) (239 )

Net cash used for financing activities

(843 ) (10,389 )

Effect of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents

127 (735 )

Effect of cash and cash equivalents related to variable interest entities

(48 ) (380 )

Net increase (decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

(18,998 ) 295

Cash and cash equivalents, at beginning of period

59,883 46,904

Cash and cash equivalents, at end of period

$ 40,885 $ 47,199

Cash and cash equivalents include:

Cash and due from banks

$ 18,863 $ 16,295

Interest bearing deposits with banks

22,022 30,904

Cash and cash equivalents, at end of period

$ 40,885 $ 47,199

SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURE OF CASH FLOW INFORMATION

Cash payments for interest were $1,162 million and $2,177 million for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

Cash payments for income taxes were $374 million and $537 million for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

LOGO 4


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Changes in Total Equity

Six Months Ended June 30, 2014

(dollars in millions)

(unaudited)

Preferred
Stock
Common
Stock
Additional
Paid-in
Capital
Retained
Earnings
Employee
Stock
Trusts
Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
Common
Stock
Held in
Treasury
at Cost
Common
Stock
Issued to
Employee
Stock
Trusts
Non-
redeemable
Non-
controlling
Interests
Total
Equity

BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 2013

$ 3,220 $ 20 $ 24,570 $ 42,172 $ 1,718 $ (1,093 ) $ (2,968 ) $ (1,718 ) $ 3,109 $ 69,030

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

3,404 3,404

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

97 97

Dividends

(431 ) (431 )

Shares issued under employee plans and related tax effects

(950 ) 429 1,627 (429 ) 677

Repurchases of common stock and employee tax withholdings

(964 ) (964 )

Net change in Accumulated other comprehensive income

360 36 396

Issuance of preferred stock

1,800 (12 ) 1,788

Deconsolidation of certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund

(1,606 ) (1,606 )

Other net decreases

(190 ) (190 )

BALANCE AT JUNE 30, 2014

$ 5,020 $ 20 $ 23,608 $ 45,145 $ 2,147 $ (733 ) $ (2,305 ) $ (2,147 ) $ 1,446 $ 72,201

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

5 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Changes in Total Equity—(Continued)

Six Months Ended June 30, 2013

(dollars in millions)

(unaudited)

Preferred
Stock
Common
Stock
Additional
Paid-in
Capital
Retained
Earnings
Employee
Stock
Trusts
Accumulated
Other
Comprehensive
Income (Loss)
Common
Stock
Held in
Treasury
at Cost
Common
Stock
Issued to
Employee
Stock
Trusts
Non-
Redeemable
Non-
controlling
Interests
Total
Equity

BALANCE AT DECEMBER 31, 2012

$ 1,508 $ 20 $ 23,426 $ 39,912 $ 2,932 $ (516 ) $ (2,241 ) $ (2,932 ) $ 3,319 $ 65,428

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

1,942 1,942

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

258 258

Dividends

(248 ) (248 )

Shares issued under employee plans and related tax effects

507 (1,111 ) (11 ) 1,111 496

Repurchases of common stock and employee tax withholdings

(314 ) (314 )

Net change in Accumulated other comprehensive income

(653 ) (149 ) (802 )

Wealth Management JV redemption value adjustment

(151 ) (151 )

Other net decreases

(495 ) (495 )

BALANCE AT JUNE 30, 2013

$ 1,508 $ 20 $ 23,933 $ 41,455 $ 1,821 $ (1,169 ) $ (2,566 ) $ (1,821 ) $ 2,933 $ 66,114

See Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements.

LOGO 6


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

1. Introduction and Basis of Presentation.

The Company. Morgan Stanley, a financial holding company, is a global financial services firm that maintains significant market positions in each of its business segments—Institutional Securities, Wealth Management and Investment Management. The Company, through its subsidiaries and affiliates, provides a wide variety of products and services to a large and diversified group of clients and customers, including corporations, governments, financial institutions and individuals. Unless the context otherwise requires, the terms “Morgan Stanley” or the “Company” mean Morgan Stanley (the “Parent”) together with its consolidated subsidiaries.

A summary of the activities of each of the Company’s business segments is as follows:

Institutional Securities provides financial advisory and capital raising services, including: advice on mergers and acquisitions, restructurings, real estate and project finance; corporate lending; sales, trading, financing and market-making activities in equity and fixed income securities and related products, including foreign exchange and commodities; and investment activities.

Wealth Management provides brokerage and investment advisory services to individual investors and small-to-medium sized businesses and institutions covering various investment alternatives; financial and wealth planning services; annuity and other insurance products; credit and other lending products; cash management services; retirement services; and engages in fixed income trading, which primarily facilitates clients’ trading or investments in such securities.

Investment Management provides a broad array of investment strategies that span the risk/return spectrum across geographies, asset classes and public and private markets to a diverse group of clients across the institutional and intermediary channels as well as high net worth clients.

Discontinued Operations. On March 27, 2014, the Company completed the sale of its Canadian terminal business, Canterm Canadian Terminals Inc. (“CanTerm”), for approximately $110 million, resulting in a gain of approximately $45 million. Given completion of the sale in the prior quarter, net revenues were $0 million and $5 million for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and $49 million and $10 million for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Net pre-tax gain (loss) was $44 million for the six months ended June 30, 2014. Net pre-tax gain (loss) for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 and the quarter ended and six months ended June 30, 2013 were not material. The results of CanTerm are reported as discontinued operations within the Institutional Securities business segment for all periods presented.

Remaining pre-tax loss amounts for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 were not material. Remaining pre-tax loss amounts were $(43) million and $(73) million for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, respectively, that were included in discontinued operations primarily related to the prior sale of Saxon and a principal investment.

Prior-period amounts have been recast for discontinued operations, see Note 2.

Basis of Financial Information. The condensed consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America (“U.S.”), which require the Company to make estimates and assumptions regarding the valuations of certain financial instruments, the valuation of goodwill and intangible assets, compensation, deferred tax assets, the outcome of litigation and tax matters, allowance for credit losses and other matters that affect the condensed consolidated financial statements and related disclosures. The Company believes that the estimates utilized in the preparation of the condensed consolidated financial statements are prudent and reasonable. Actual results could differ materially from these estimates. Intercompany balances and transactions have been eliminated.

7 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The condensed consolidated financial statements should be read in conjunction with the Company’s consolidated financial statements and notes thereto included in the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013 (“Form 10-K”). The condensed consolidated financial statements reflect all adjustments of a normal recurring nature that are, in the opinion of management, necessary for the fair presentation of the results for the interim period. The results of operations for interim periods are not necessarily indicative of results for the entire year.

Consolidation. The condensed consolidated financial statements include the accounts of the Company, its wholly owned subsidiaries and other entities in which the Company has a controlling financial interest, including certain variable interest entities (“VIE”) (see Note 7). For consolidated subsidiaries that are less than wholly owned, the third-party holdings of equity interests are referred to as noncontrolling interests. The portion of net income attributable to noncontrolling interests for such subsidiaries is presented as either Net income (loss) applicable to redeemable noncontrolling interests or Net income (loss) applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests in the condensed consolidated statements of income. The portion of shareholders’ equity of such subsidiaries that is redeemable would be presented as Redeemable noncontrolling interests outside of the equity section in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. The portion of shareholders’ equity of such subsidiaries that is nonredeemable is presented as Nonredeemable noncontrolling interests, a component of total equity, in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.

For entities where (1) the total equity investment at risk is sufficient to enable the entity to finance its activities without additional subordinated financial support and (2) the equity holders bear the economic residual risks and returns of the entity and have the power to direct the activities of the entity that most significantly affect its economic performance, the Company consolidates those entities it controls either through a majority voting interest or otherwise. For VIEs ( i.e. , entities that do not meet these criteria), the Company consolidates those entities where the Company has the power to make the decisions that most significantly affect the economic performance of the VIE and has the obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits that could potentially be significant to the VIE, except for certain VIEs that are money market funds, are investment companies or are entities qualifying for accounting purposes as investment companies. Generally, the Company consolidates those entities when it absorbs a majority of the expected losses or a majority of the expected residual returns, or both, of the entities.

For investments in entities in which the Company does not have a controlling financial interest but has significant influence over operating and financial decisions, the Company generally applies the equity method of accounting with net gains and losses recorded within Other revenues. Where the Company has elected to measure certain eligible investments at fair value in accordance with the fair value option, net gains and losses are recorded within Investments revenues (see Note 4).

Equity and partnership interests held by entities qualifying for accounting purposes as investment companies are carried at fair value.

The Company’s significant regulated U.S. and international subsidiaries include Morgan Stanley & Co. LLC (“MS&Co.”), Morgan Stanley Smith Barney LLC (“MSSB LLC”), Morgan Stanley & Co. International plc (“MSIP”), Morgan Stanley MUFG Securities Co., Ltd. (“MSMS”), Morgan Stanley Bank, N.A. (“MSBNA”) and Morgan Stanley Private Bank, National Association (“MSPBNA”).

Income Statement Presentation. The Company, through its subsidiaries and affiliates, provides a wide variety of products and services to a large and diversified group of clients and customers, including corporations, governments, financial institutions and individuals. In connection with the delivery of the various products and

LOGO 8


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

services to clients, the Company manages its revenues and related expenses in the aggregate. As such, when assessing the performance of its businesses, primarily in its Institutional Securities business segment, the Company considers its trading, investment banking, commissions and fees, and interest income, along with the associated interest expense, as one integrated activity.

2. Significant Accounting Policies.

For a detailed discussion about the Company’s significant accounting policies, see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K.

During the quarter ended June 30, 2014, other than the following, no updates were made to the Company’s significant accounting policies.

Software Costs.

As a result of an analysis completed by the Company, effective April 1, 2014, the Company revised the estimated useful lives for software costs from generally 3 to 5 years to generally 3 to 10 years. The adoption of these revised estimated useful lives for software costs resulted in lower amortization expense of approximately $27 million in the second quarter of 2014.

Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows.

For purposes of the condensed consolidated statements of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents consist of Cash and due from banks and Interest bearing deposits with banks, which are highly liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less, held for investment purposes, and readily convertible to known amounts of cash.

On April 1, 2014, the Company deconsolidated approximately $1.6 billion in total assets that were related to certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund sponsored by the Company. The deconsolidation resulted in a non-cash reduction of assets of $1.3 billion. The Company had no significant non-cash activities in the six months ended June 30, 2013.

Goodwill.

The Company completed its annual goodwill impairment testing at July 1, 2013. The Company’s impairment testing did not indicate any goodwill impairment as each of the Company’s reporting units with goodwill had a fair value that was substantially in excess of its carrying value. Adverse market or economic events could result in impairment charges in future periods.

Accounting Developments.

Obligations Resulting from Joint and Several Liability Arrangements for Which the Total Amount of the Obligation Is Fixed at the Reporting Date .    In February 2013, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”) issued an accounting update that requires an entity to measure obligations resulting from joint and several liability arrangements for which the total amount of the obligation is fixed at the reporting date, as the sum of the amount the reporting entity agreed to pay and any additional amount the reporting entity expects to pay on behalf of its co-obligors. This update also requires additional disclosures about those obligations. This guidance became effective for the Company retrospectively beginning on January 1, 2014. The adoption of this accounting guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements.

9 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Parent’s Accounting for the Cumulative Translation Adjustment upon Derecognition of Certain Subsidiaries or Groups of Assets within a Foreign Entity or of an Investment in a Foreign Entity. In March 2013, the FASB issued an accounting update requiring the parent entity to release any related cumulative translation adjustment into net income when the parent ceases to have a controlling financial interest in a subsidiary that is a foreign entity. When the parent ceases to have a controlling financial interest in a subsidiary or group of assets that is a business within a foreign entity, the related cumulative translation adjustment would be released into net income only if the sale or transfer results in the complete or substantially complete liquidation of the foreign entity in which the subsidiary or group of assets had resided. This guidance became effective for the Company prospectively beginning on January 1, 2014. The adoption of this accounting guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements.

Amendments to the Scope, Measurement, and Disclosure Requirements of an Investment Company. In June 2013, the FASB issued an accounting update that modifies the criteria used in defining an investment company under generally accepted accounting principles in the U.S. (“U.S. GAAP”) and sets forth certain measurement and disclosure requirements. This update requires an investment company to measure noncontrolling interests in another investment company at fair value and requires an entity to disclose the fact that it is an investment company, and provide information about changes, if any, in its status as an investment company. An entity will also need to include disclosures around financial support that has been provided or is contractually required to be provided to any of its investees. This guidance became effective for the Company prospectively beginning January 1, 2014. The adoption of this accounting guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements.

Presentation of an Unrecognized Tax Benefit When a Net Operating Loss Carryforward, a Similar Tax Loss, or a Tax Credit Carryforward Exists. In July 2013, the FASB issued an accounting update providing guidance on the financial statement presentation of an unrecognized tax benefit when a deferred tax asset from a net operating loss carryforward, similar tax loss, or tax credit carryforward exists. This guidance requires an unrecognized tax benefit, or a portion of an unrecognized tax benefit, to be presented in the financial statements as a reduction to such deferred tax asset if a settlement in such manner is expected in the event the uncertain tax position is disallowed. This guidance became effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2014. This guidance was applied prospectively to unrecognized tax benefits that existed at the effective date. The adoption of this accounting guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements.

Accounting for Investments in Qualified Affordable Housing Projects. In January 2014, the FASB issued an accounting update providing guidance on accounting for investments in flow-through limited liability entities that manage or invest in affordable housing projects that qualify for the low-income housing tax credit. The Company adopted this guidance on April 1, 2014, as early adoption is permitted. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements. For further information on the adoption of this guidance, see Note 17.

Reporting Discontinued Operations and Disclosures of Disposals of Components of an Entity. In April 2014, the FASB issued an accounting update that changes the requirements and disclosure for reporting discontinued operations. The new guidance defines a discontinued operation as a disposal of a component or group of components that is disposed of or is classified as held for sale and represents a strategic shift that has (or will have) a major effect on an entity’s operations and financial results. Individually significant components that have been disposed of or are held for sale that do not meet the definition of a discontinued operation require new disclosures. The Company adopted this guidance on April 1, 2014, as early adoption is permitted. The adoption of this guidance did not have a material impact on the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements.

LOGO 10


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

3. Wealth Management JV.

In 2009, the Company and Citigroup Inc. (“Citi”) consummated the combination of each institution’s respective wealth management business. The combined businesses operated as the “Wealth Management JV”. Prior to September 2012, the Company owned 51% and Citi owned 49% of the Wealth Management JV. In September 2012, the Company purchased an additional 14% stake in the Wealth Management JV from Citi for $1.89 billion, increasing the Company’s interest from 51% to 65%. In June 2013, the Company purchased the remaining 35% stake in the Wealth Management JV for $4.725 billion, increasing the Company’s interest from 65% to 100%.

For the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, no results were attributed to Citi since the Company owned 100% of the Wealth Management JV. For the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, Citi’s 35% interest was reported on the balance sheet as redeemable noncontrolling interest and the results related to its 35% interest were reported in net income (loss) applicable to redeemable noncontrolling interests in the condensed consolidated statement of income.

Concurrent with the acquisition of the remaining 35% stake in the Wealth Management JV, the deposit sweep agreement between Citi and the Company was terminated. During the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, $5 billion and $10 billion, respectively, of deposits held by Citi relating to the Company’s customer accounts were transferred to the Company’s depository institutions. At June 30, 2014, approximately $18 billion of additional deposits are scheduled to be transferred to the Company’s depository institutions on an agreed-upon basis through June 2015.

4. Fair Value Disclosures.

Fair Value Measurements.

For a description of the valuation techniques applied to the Company’s major categories of assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis, see Note 4 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K.

The following fair value hierarchy tables present information about the Company’s assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

11 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis at June 30, 2014.

Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
Counterparty
and Cash
Collateral
Netting
Balance at
June 30,
2014
(dollars in millions)

Assets at Fair Value

Trading assets:

U.S. government and agency securities:

U.S. Treasury securities

$ 24,740 $ $ $ $ 24,740

U.S. agency securities

1,317 12,968 14,285

Total U.S. government and agency securities

26,057 12,968 39,025

Other sovereign government obligations

23,114 7,370 14 30,498

Corporate and other debt:

State and municipal securities

1,594 4 1,598

Residential mortgage-backed securities

2,210 55 2,265

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

1,316 47 1,363

Asset-backed securities

644 65 709

Corporate bonds

17,494 510 18,004

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

520 1,332 1,852

Loans and lending commitments

7,898 5,829 13,727

Other debt

2,485 22 2,507

Total corporate and other debt

34,161 7,864 42,025

Corporate equities(1)

104,842 1,128 243 106,213

Derivative and other contracts:

Interest rate contracts

855 448,625 2,729 452,209

Credit contracts

32,638 1,711 34,349

Foreign exchange contracts

8 41,493 241 41,742

Equity contracts

855 53,810 1,503 56,168

Commodity contracts

2,179 13,592 2,307 18,078

Other

227 227

Netting(2)

(3,324 ) (504,880 ) (4,564 ) (58,039 ) (570,807 )

Total derivative and other contracts

573 85,505 3,927 (58,039 ) 31,966

Investments:

Private equity funds

2,555 2,555

Real estate funds

7 1,813 1,820

Hedge funds

373 371 744

Principal investments

80 40 883 1,003

Other

205 86 380 671

Total investments

285 506 6,002 6,793

Physical commodities

3,041 3,041

Total trading assets

154,871 144,679 18,050 (58,039 ) 259,561

Available for sale securities

35,170 30,304 65,474

Securities received as collateral

19,456 42 19,498

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

864 864

Intangible assets(3)

6 6

Total assets measured at fair value

$ 209,497 $ 175,889 $ 18,056 $ (58,039 ) $ 345,403

LOGO 12


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
Counterparty
and Cash
Collateral
Netting
Balance at
June 30,
2014
(dollars in millions)

Liabilities at Fair Value

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings

$ $ 1,315 $ $ $ 1,315

Trading liabilities:

U.S. government and agency securities:

U.S. Treasury securities

11,522 11,522

U.S. agency securities

1,634 118 1,752

Total U.S. government and agency securities

13,156 118 13,274

Other sovereign government obligations

17,861 2,516 20,377

Corporate and other debt:

State and municipal securities

2 2

Asset-backed securities

1 1

Corporate bonds

5,187 14 5,201

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

2 2

Unfunded lending commitments

17 12 29

Other debt

184 42 226

Total corporate and other debt

5,393 68 5,461

Corporate equities(1)

34,364 971 6 35,341

Derivative and other contracts:

Interest rate contracts

820 426,855 2,838 430,513

Credit contracts

30,969 2,421 33,390

Foreign exchange contracts

3 42,456 132 42,591

Equity contracts

927 59,122 2,600 62,649

Commodity contracts

2,492 13,639 1,175 17,306

Other

57 3 60

Netting(2)

(3,324 ) (504,880 ) (4,564 ) (38,317 ) (551,085 )

Total derivative and other contracts

918 68,218 4,605 (38,317 ) 35,424

Total trading liabilities

66,299 77,216 4,679 (38,317 ) 109,877

Obligation to return securities received as collateral

25,396 53 25,449

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

459 155 614

Other secured financings

4,921 135 5,056

Long-term borrowings

33,440 1,779 35,219

Total liabilities measured at fair value

$ 91,695 $ 117,404 $ 6,748 $ (38,317 ) $ 177,530

(1) The Company holds or sells short for trading purposes equity securities issued by entities in diverse industries and of varying size.
(2) For positions with the same counterparty that cross over the levels of the fair value hierarchy, both counterparty netting and cash collateral netting are included in the column titled “Counterparty and Cash Collateral Netting.” For contracts with the same counterparty, counterparty netting among positions classified within the same level is included within that level. For further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities, see Note 10.
(3) Amount represents mortgage servicing rights (“MSR”) accounted for at fair value.

Transfers Between Level 1 and Level 2 During the Quarter and Six Months Ended June 30, 2014.

For assets and liabilities that were transferred between Level 1 and Level 2 during the period, fair values are ascribed as if the assets or liabilities had been transferred as of the beginning of the period.

In the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, there were no material transfers between Level 1 and Level 2.

13 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis at December 31, 2013.

Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
for
Identical
Assets
(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
Counterparty
and Cash
Collateral
Netting
Balance at
December 31,
2013
(dollars in millions)

Assets at Fair Value

Trading assets:

U.S. government and agency securities:

U.S. Treasury securities

$ 32,083 $ $ $ $ 32,083

U.S. agency securities

1,216 17,720 18,936

Total U.S. government and agency securities

33,299 17,720 51,019

Other sovereign government obligations

25,363 6,610 27 32,000

Corporate and other debt:

State and municipal securities

1,615 1,615

Residential mortgage-backed securities

2,029 47 2,076

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

1,534 108 1,642

Asset-backed securities

878 103 981

Corporate bonds

16,592 522 17,114

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

802 1,468 2,270

Loans and lending commitments

7,483 5,129 12,612

Other debt

6,365 27 6,392

Total corporate and other debt

37,298 7,404 44,702

Corporate equities(1)

107,818 1,206 190 109,214

Derivative and other contracts:

Interest rate contracts

750 526,127 2,475 529,352

Credit contracts

42,258 2,088 44,346

Foreign exchange contracts

52 61,570 179 61,801

Equity contracts

1,215 51,656 1,234 54,105

Commodity contracts

2,396 8,595 2,380 13,371

Other

43 43

Netting(2)

(3,836 ) (606,878 ) (4,931 ) (54,906 ) (670,551 )

Total derivative and other contracts

577 83,371 3,425 (54,906 ) 32,467

Investments:

Private equity funds

2,531 2,531

Real estate funds

6 1,637 1,643

Hedge funds

377 432 809

Principal investments

43 42 2,160 2,245

Other

202 45 538 785

Total investments

245 470 7,298 8,013

Physical commodities

3,329 3,329

Total trading assets

167,302 150,004 18,344 (54,906 ) 280,744

Available for sale securities

24,412 29,018 53,430

Securities received as collateral

20,497 11 20,508

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

866 866

Intangible assets(3)

8 8

Total assets measured at fair value

$ 212,211 $ 179,899 $ 18,352 $ (54,906 ) $ 355,556

LOGO 14


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
for
Identical
Assets
(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
Counterparty
and Cash
Collateral
Netting
Balance at
December 31,
2013
(dollars in millions)

Liabilities at Fair Value

Deposits

$ $ 185 $ $ $ 185

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings

1,346 1 1,347

Trading liabilities:

U.S. government and agency securities:

U.S. Treasury securities

15,963 15,963

U.S. agency securities

2,593 116 2,709

Total U.S. government and agency securities

18,556 116 18,672

Other sovereign government obligations

14,717 2,473 17,190

Corporate and other debt:

State and municipal securities

15 15

Corporate bonds

5,033 22 5,055

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

3 3

Unfunded lending commitments

127 2 129

Other debt

1,144 48 1,192

Total corporate and other debt

6,322 72 6,394

Corporate equities(1)

27,983 513 8 28,504

Derivative and other contracts:

Interest rate contracts

675 504,292 2,362 507,329

Credit contracts

40,391 2,235 42,626

Foreign exchange contracts

23 61,925 111 62,059

Equity contracts

1,033 57,797 2,065 60,895

Commodity contracts

2,637 8,749 1,500 12,886

Other

72 4 76

Netting(2)

(3,836 ) (606,878 ) (4,931 ) (36,465 ) (652,110 )

Total derivative and other contracts

532 66,348 3,346 (36,465 ) 33,761

Total trading liabilities

61,788 75,772 3,426 (36,465 ) 104,521

Obligation to return securities received as collateral

24,549 19 24,568

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

407 154 561

Other secured financings

4,928 278 5,206

Long-term borrowings

33,750 1,887 35,637

Total liabilities measured at fair value

$ 86,337 $ 116,407 $ 5,746 $ (36,465 ) $ 172,025

(1) The Company holds or sells short for trading purposes equity securities issued by entities in diverse industries and of varying size.
(2) For positions with the same counterparty that cross over the levels of the fair value hierarchy, both counterparty netting and cash collateral netting are included in the column titled “Counterparty and Cash Collateral Netting.” For contracts with the same counterparty, counterparty netting among positions classified within the same level is included within that level. For further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities, see Note 10.
(3) Amount represents MSRs accounted for at fair value.

Transfers Between Level 1 and Level 2 During the Quarter and Six Months Ended June 30, 2013.

For assets and liabilities that were transferred between Level 1 and Level 2 during the period, fair values are ascribed as if the assets or liabilities had been transferred as of the beginning of the period.

In the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, there were no material transfers between Level 1 and Level 2.

Level 3 Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis.

The following tables present additional information about Level 3 assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis for the quarters and six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively. Level 3 instruments may

15 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

be hedged with instruments classified in Level 1 and Level 2. As a result, the realized and unrealized gains (losses) for assets and liabilities within the Level 3 category presented in the tables below do not reflect the related realized and unrealized gains (losses) on hedging instruments that have been classified by the Company within the Level 1 and/or Level 2 categories.

Additionally, both observable and unobservable inputs may be used to determine the fair value of positions that the Company has classified within the Level 3 category. As a result, the unrealized gains (losses) during the period for assets and liabilities within the Level 3 category presented in the tables below may include changes in fair value during the period that were attributable to both observable ( e.g. , changes in market interest rates) and unobservable ( e.g. , changes in unobservable long-dated volatilities) inputs.

For assets and liabilities that were transferred into Level 3 during the period, gains (losses) are presented as if the assets or liabilities had been transferred into Level 3 at the beginning of the period; similarly, for assets and liabilities that were transferred out of Level 3 during the period, gains (losses) are presented as if the assets or liabilities had been transferred out at the beginning of the period.

LOGO 16


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Changes in Level 3 Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis for the Quarter Ended June 30, 2014.

Beginning
Balance at
March 31,
2014
Total
Realized and
Unrealized
Gains
(Losses)(1)
Purchases Sales Issuances Settlements Net
Transfers
Ending
Balance at
June 30,
2014
Unrealized
Gains

(Losses) for
Level 3

Assets/
Liabilities
Outstanding
at June 30,
2014(2)
(dollars in millions)

Assets at Fair Value

Trading assets:

Other sovereign government obligations

$ 8 $ $ 7 $ (2 ) $ $ $ 1 $ 14 $

Corporate and other debt:

State and municipal securities

4 4

Residential mortgage-backed securities

51 10 1 (7 ) 55 8

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

80 5 14 (52 ) 47 (1 )

Asset-backed securities

146 28 (115 ) 6 65

Corporate bonds

538 64 100 (223 ) 31 510 42

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

1,293 79 497 (534 ) (27 ) 24 1,332 32

Loans and lending commitments

4,988 146 1,505 (423 ) (304 ) (83 ) 5,829 188

Other debt

31 2 8 (17 ) (2 ) 22 2

Total corporate and other debt

7,127 306 2,157 (1,371 ) (333 ) (22 ) 7,864 271

Corporate equities

263 16 68 (29 ) (75 ) 243 11

Net derivative and other contracts(3):

Interest rate contracts

(121 ) (64 ) 1 77 (2 ) (109 ) (25 )

Credit contracts

(231 ) (362 ) 8 (8 ) (157 ) 40 (710 ) (357 )

Foreign exchange contracts

52 21 3 (1 ) 30 4 109 21

Equity contracts

(1,099 ) 3 29 (1 ) (32 ) (102 ) 105 (1,097 ) (25 )

Commodity contracts

1,074 (43 ) 108 (7 ) 1,132 (55 )

Other

(1 ) (1 ) (1 ) (3 ) (1 )

Total net derivative and other contracts

(326 ) (446 ) 149 (2 ) (40 ) (160 ) 147 (678 ) (442 )

Investments:

Private equity funds

2,576 126 35 (183 ) 1 2,555 30

Real estate funds

1,643 93 124 (47 ) 1,813 135

Hedge funds

394 4 18 (9 ) (36 ) 371 4

Principal investments

2,193 (14 ) 16 (72 ) (1,234 ) (6 ) 883 65

Other

521 2 2 (10 ) (135 ) 380 9

Total investments

7,327 211 195 (321 ) (1,234 ) (176 ) 6,002 243

Securities received as collateral

3 (3 )

Intangible assets

7 (1 ) 6 (1 )

Liabilities at Fair Value

Trading liabilities:

Corporate and other debt:

Corporate bonds

$ 3 $ (1 ) $ (4 ) $ 13 $ $ $ 1 $ 14 $

Unfunded lending commitments

6 (5 ) 1 12 (5 )

Other debt

68 11 5 (20 ) 42 2

Total corporate and other debt

77 5 (4 ) 19 (20 ) 1 68 (3 )

Corporate equities

10 (1 ) (21 ) 17 (1 ) 6

Obligation to return securities received as collateral

3 (3 )

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

154 (1 ) 155 (1 )

Other secured financings

275 (5 ) 17 (178 ) 16 135 (4 )

Long-term borrowings

1,878 (50 ) 160 (89 ) (220 ) 1,779 (50 )

17 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(1) Total realized and unrealized gains (losses) are primarily included in Trading revenues in the condensed consolidated statements of income except for $211 million related to Trading assets—Investments, which is included in Investments revenues.
(2) Amounts represent unrealized gains (losses) for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 related to assets and liabilities still outstanding at June 30, 2014.
(3) Net derivative and other contracts represent Trading assets—Derivative and other contracts net of Trading liabilities—Derivative and other contracts. For further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities, see Note 10.

In the quarter ended June 30, 2014, there were no material transfers into or out of Level 3.

Changes in Level 3 Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014.

Beginning
Balance at
December 31,
2013
Total
Realized
and
Unrealized
Gains
(Losses)(1)
Purchases Sales Issuances Settlements Net
Transfers
Ending
Balance at
June 30,
2014
Unrealized
Gains

(Losses) for
Level 3 Assets/
Liabilities
Outstanding

at June 30,
2014(2)
(dollars in millions)

Assets at Fair Value

Trading assets:

Other sovereign government obligations

$ 27 $ $ 8 $ (21 ) $ $ $ $ 14 $

Corporate and other debt:

State and municipal securities

4 4

Residential mortgage-backed securities

47 13 1 (5 ) (1 ) 55 9

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

108 13 23 (97 ) 47 (1 )

Asset-backed securities

103 (4 ) 30 (88 ) 24 65

Corporate bonds

522 96 169 (304 ) 27 510 68

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

1,468 134 658 (886 ) (72 ) 30 1,332 52

Loans and lending commitments

5,129 (137 ) 1,770 (343 ) (634 ) 44 5,829 (117 )

Other debt

27 2 8 (18 ) 3 22 1

Total corporate and other debt

7,404 117 2,663 (1,741 ) (706 ) 127 7,864 12

Corporate equities

190 18 79 (38 ) (6 ) 243 14

Net derivative and other contracts(3):

Interest rate contracts

113 (141 ) 1 (46 ) (36 ) (109 ) (130 )

Credit contracts

(147 ) (576 ) 45 (62 ) 47 (17 ) (710 ) (582 )

Foreign exchange contracts

68 14 4 (1 ) 38 (14 ) 109 15

Equity contracts

(831 ) (15 ) 175 (2 ) (218 ) (280 ) 74 (1,097 ) (58 )

Commodity contracts

880 121 164 (33 ) 1,132 98

Other

(4 ) (3 ) 4 (3 ) (3 )

Total net derivative and other contracts

79 (600 ) 389 (3 ) (280 ) (270 ) 7 (678 ) (660 )

Investments:

Private equity funds

2,531 297 110 (384 ) 1 2,555 119

Real estate funds

1,637 145 134 (103 ) 1,813 177

Hedge funds

432 17 36 (21 ) (93 ) 371 17

Principal investments

2,160 47 16 (84 ) (1,234 ) (22 ) 883 128

Other

538 (10 ) 13 (21 ) (140 ) 380 (3 )

Total investments

7,298 496 309 (613 ) (1,234 ) (254 ) 6,002 438

Intangible assets

8 (1 ) (1 ) 6 (1 )

LOGO 18


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Beginning
Balance at
December 31,
2013
Total
Realized
and
Unrealized
Gains
(Losses)(1)
Purchases Sales Issuances Settlements Net
Transfers
Ending
Balance at
June 30,
2014
Unrealized
Gains

(Losses) for
Level 3 Assets/
Liabilities
Outstanding

at June 30,
2014(2)
(dollars in millions)

Liabilities at Fair Value

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings

$ 1 $ $ $ $ $ (1 ) $ $ $

Trading liabilities:

Corporate and other debt:

Corporate bonds

22 1 (50 ) 47 (4 ) 14

Unfunded lending commitments

2 (9 ) 1 12 (9 )

Other debt

48 10 3 1 42 1

Total corporate and other debt

72 2 (50 ) 48 3 (3 ) 68 (8 )

Corporate equities

8 (1 ) (22 ) 15 4 6 (1 )

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

154 (1 ) 155 (1 )

Other secured financings

278 (9 ) 18 (186 ) 16 135 (5 )

Long-term borrowings

1,887 (80 ) 359 (233 ) (314 ) 1,779 (81 )

(1) Total realized and unrealized gains (losses) are primarily included in Trading revenues in the condensed consolidated statements of income except for $496 million related to Trading assets—Investments, which is included in Investments revenues.
(2) Amounts represent unrealized gains (losses) for the six months ended June 30, 2014 related to assets and liabilities still outstanding at June 30, 2014.
(3) Net derivative and other contracts represent Trading assets—Derivative and other contracts net of Trading liabilities—Derivative and other contracts. For further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities, see Note 10.

In the six months ended June 30, 2014, there were no material transfers into or out of Level 3.

19 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Changes in Level 3 Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis for the Quarter Ended June 30, 2013.

Beginning
Balance at
March 31,
2013
Total
Realized and
Unrealized
Gains
(Losses)(1)
Purchases Sales Issuances Settlements Net
Transfers
Ending
Balance at
June 30,
2013
Unrealized
Gains

(Losses) for
Level 3

Assets/
Liabilities
Outstanding

at June 30,
2013(2)
(dollars in millions)

Assets at Fair Value

Trading assets:

Other sovereign government obligations

$ 3 $ $ 7 $ (6 ) $ $ $ $ 4 $

Corporate and other debt:

Residential mortgage-backed securities

19 15 (5 ) (10 ) 19 (1 )

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

174 26 (19 ) 181 21

Asset-backed securities

11 1 107 (11 ) 108

Corporate bonds

888 (11 ) 183 (402 ) (149 ) 509 2

Collateralized debt obligations

1,666 36 302 (596 ) (87 ) 12 1,333 20

Loans and lending commitments

5,284 (55 ) 1,086 (190 ) (850 ) (32 ) 5,243 8

Other debt

1 7 4 12 7

Total corporate and other debt

8,043 (22 ) 1,723 (1,223 ) (937 ) (179 ) 7,405 57

Corporate equities

270 (24 ) 20 (13 ) 3 256 12

Net derivative and other contracts(3):

Interest rate contracts

(22 ) (43 ) 3 (24 ) 40 62 16 63

Credit contracts

1,403 (472 ) 130 (221 ) (130 ) (25 ) 685 (369 )

Foreign exchange contracts

(235 ) 95 58 (14 ) (96 ) 95

Equity contracts

(1,340 ) 18 7 (35 ) (1 ) 67 (1,284 ) (79 )

Commodity contracts

703 81 26 (13 ) (13 ) (3 ) 781 58

Other

(3 ) (2 ) (1 ) (6 ) (2 )

Total net derivative and other contracts

506 (323 ) 166 (293 ) (47 ) 87 96 (234 )

Investments:

Private equity funds

2,291 104 20 (129 ) 2,286 97

Real estate funds

1,370 47 41 (36 ) 1,422 87

Hedge funds

545 (2 ) 10 (104 ) (42 ) 407 (16 )

Principal investments

2,855 (18 ) 60 (75 ) 2,822 82

Other

496 5 4 (30 ) (90 ) 385 6

Total investments

7,557 136 135 (374 ) (132 ) 7,322 256

Intangible assets

8 3 (2 ) 9 2

LOGO 20


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Beginning
Balance at
March 31,
2013
Total
Realized and
Unrealized
Gains
(Losses)(1)
Purchases Sales Issuances Settlements Net
Transfers
Ending
Balance at
June 30,
2013
Unrealized
Gains

(Losses) for
Level 3

Assets/
Liabilities
Outstanding

at June 30,
2013(2)
(dollars in millions)

Liabilities at Fair Value

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings

$ 5 $ $ $ $ $ (2 ) $ (3 ) $ $

Trading liabilities:

Corporate and other debt:

Residential mortgage-backed securities

4 4

Corporate bonds

424 4 (248 ) 36 (166 ) 42 (1 )

Unfunded lending commitments

25 17 8 17

Other debt

11 1 (4 ) 2 3 11

Total corporate and other debt

464 22 (252 ) 38 (163 ) 65 16

Corporate equities

4 3 (8 ) 17 6 16 2

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

155 7 148 7

Other secured financings

275 16 (3 ) 256 16

Long-term borrowings

2,784 68 466 (457 ) (20 ) 2,705 65

(1) Total realized and unrealized gains (losses) are primarily included in Trading revenues in the condensed consolidated statements of income except for $136 million related to Trading assets—Investments, which is included in Investments revenues.
(2) Amounts represent unrealized gains (losses) for the quarter ended June 30, 2013 related to assets and liabilities still outstanding at June 30, 2013.
(3) Net derivative and other contracts represent Trading assets—Derivative and other contracts net of Trading liabilities—Derivative and other contracts. For further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities, see Note 10.

21 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Changes in Level 3 Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Recurring Basis for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2013.

Beginning
Balance at
December 31,
2012
Total
Realized
and
Unrealized
Gains
(Losses)(1)
Purchases Sales Issuances Settlements Net
Transfers
Ending
Balance at
June 30,
2013
Unrealized
Gains

(Losses) for
Level 3

Assets/
Liabilities
Outstanding
at June 30,
2013(2)
(dollars in millions)

Assets at Fair Value

Trading assets:

Other sovereign government obligations

$ 6 $ $ 8 $ (8 ) $ $ $ (2 ) $ 4 $

Corporate and other debt:

Residential mortgage-backed securities

45 27 16 (44 ) (25 ) 19 10

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

232 17 25 (93 ) 181 30

Asset-backed securities

109 1 6 (8 ) 108

Corporate bonds

660 2 193 (296 ) (12 ) (38 ) 509 (19 )

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

1,951 284 429 (1,314 ) (15 ) (2 ) 1,333 (54 )

Loans and lending commitments

4,694 (55 ) 1,616 (294 ) (1,050 ) 332 5,243 (16 )

Other debt

45 (2 ) 20 (50 ) (1 ) 12 (1 )

Total corporate and other debt

7,736 274 2,305 (2,099 ) (1,077 ) 266 7,405 (50 )

Corporate equities

288 (9 ) 37 (41 ) (19 ) 256 (24 )

Net derivative and other contracts(3):

Interest rate contracts

(82 ) (193 ) 6 (30 ) 179 136 16 (76 )

Credit contracts

1,822 (937 ) 169 (235 ) (127 ) (7 ) 685 (789 )

Foreign exchange contracts

(359 ) 114 140 9 (96 ) 79

Equity contracts

(1,144 ) 48 74 (1 ) (116 ) (236 ) 91 (1,284 ) (5 )

Commodity contracts

709 46 36 (17 ) 9 (2 ) 781 38

Other

(7 ) (4 ) 5 (6 ) (4 )

Total net derivative and other contracts

939 (926 ) 285 (1 ) (398 ) (30 ) 227 96 (757 )

Investments:

Private equity funds

2,179 218 88 (199 ) 2,286 194

Real estate funds

1,370 128 42 (119 ) 1 1,422 207

Hedge funds

552 38 (136 ) (47 ) 407 (19 )

Principal investments

2,833 45 95 (160 ) 9 2,822 143

Other

486 21 16 (47 ) (91 ) 385 22

Total investments

7,420 412 279 (661 ) (128 ) 7,322 547

Intangible assets

7 7 (5 ) 9 3

LOGO 22


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Beginning
Balance at
December 31,
2012
Total
Realized
and
Unrealized
Gains
(Losses)(1)
Purchases Sales Issuances Settlements Net
Transfers
Ending
Balance at
June 30,
2013
Unrealized
Gains

(Losses) for
Level 3

Assets/
Liabilities
Outstanding at
June 30,
2013(2)
(dollars in millions)

Liabilities at Fair Value

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings

$ 19 $ $ $ $ $ (2 ) $ (17 ) $ $

Trading liabilities:

Corporate and other debt:

Residential mortgage-backed securities

4 4

Corporate bonds

177 (7 ) (437 ) 83 212 42 9

Unfunded lending commitments

46 38 8 38

Other debt

49 13 (33 ) 5 3 11 10

Total corporate and other debt

276 44 (470 ) 88 215 65 57

Corporate equities

5 5 (13 ) 29 16 5

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

151 3 148 3

Other secured financings

406 29 14 (135 ) 256 21

Long-term borrowings

2,789 24 955 (361 ) (654 ) 2,705 16

(1) Total realized and unrealized gains (losses) are primarily included in Trading revenues in the condensed consolidated statements of income except for $412 million related to Trading assets—Investments, which is included in Investments revenues.
(2) Amounts represent unrealized gains (losses) for six months ended June 30, 2013 related to assets and liabilities still outstanding at June 30, 2013.
(3) Net derivative and other contracts represent Trading assets—Derivative and other contracts, net of Trading liabilities—Derivative and other contracts. For further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities, see Note 10.

23 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Quantitative Information about and Sensitivity of Significant Unobservable Inputs Used in Recurring Level 3 Fair Value Measurements at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

The disclosures below provide information on the valuation techniques, significant unobservable inputs and their ranges and averages for each major category of assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a recurring basis with a significant Level 3 balance. The level of aggregation and breadth of products cause the range of inputs to be wide and not evenly distributed across the inventory. Further, the range of unobservable inputs may differ across firms in the financial services industry because of diversity in the types of products included in each firm’s inventory. The following disclosures also include qualitative information on the sensitivity of the fair value measurements to changes in the significant unobservable inputs.

At June 30, 2014.

Balance at
June 30,
2014

(dollars in
millions)

Valuation
Technique(s)

Significant Unobservable Input(s) /
Sensitivity of the Fair Value to

Changes in the Unobservable Inputs
Range(1) Averages(2)

Assets

Trading assets:

Corporate and other debt:

Residential mortgage-backed securities

$ 55 Comparable pricing Comparable bond price / (A) 3 to 5 points 4 points

Asset-backed securities

65 Comparable pricing Comparable bond price / (A) 4 to 82 points 49 points

Corporate bonds

510 Comparable pricing Comparable bond price / (A) 1 to 160 points 84 points

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

1,332 Comparable pricing(6) Comparable bond price / (A) 20 to 105 points 75 points
Correlation model Credit correlation / (B) 45 to 63% 56%

Loans and lending commitments

5,829 Corporate loan model Credit spread / (C) 33 to 516 basis points 262 basis points
Margin loan model Credit spread / (C)(D) 150 to 300 basis points 193 basis points
Volatility skew / (C)(D) 4 to 52% 26%
Comparable bond price / (A)(D) 80 to 120 points 100 points
Discount rate / (C)(D) 2 to 3% 3%
Option model Volatility skew / (C) -1 to 0% -1%
Comparable pricing(6) Comparable loan price / (A) 5 to 110 points 96 points

Corporate equities(3)

243 Net asset value Discount to net asset value / (C) 0 to 84% 42%
Comparable pricing(6) Comparable equity price / (A) 100% 100%
Market approach EBITDA multiple / (A)(D) 5 to 11 times 7 times
Price/Book ratio / (A)(D) 0 times 0 times

Net derivative and other contracts:

Interest rate contracts

(109 ) Option model Interest rate volatility concentration
liquidity multiple / (C)(D)
0 to 3 times 2 times
Comparable bond price / (A)(D) 2 to 13 points 9 points /10 points (4)
Interest rate - Foreign
exchange correlation / (A)(D)
47 to 48% 48% / 48%(4)
Interest rate volatility skew / (A)(D) 25 to 59% 39% / 29%(4)
Interest rate quanto correlation /
(A)(D)
-11 to 37% 6% / -8%(4)
Interest rate curve correlation / (A)(D) 36 to 94% 71% / 76%(4)
Inflation volatility / (A)(D) 79% 79% / 79%(4)
Interest rate - Inflation correlation /
(A)(D)
-39 to -42% -41% / -41%(4)

Credit contracts

(710 ) Comparable pricing Cash synthetic basis / (C)(D) 5 to 12 points 11 points
Comparable bond price / (C)(D) 0 to 60 points 21 points
Correlation model(6) Credit correlation / (B) 45 to 79% 59%

LOGO 24


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Balance at
June 30,
2014

(dollars in
millions)

Valuation
Technique(s)

Significant Unobservable Input(s) /
Sensitivity of the Fair Value to

Changes in the Unobservable Inputs
Range(1) Averages(2)

Foreign exchange contracts(5)

109 Option model Comparable bond price / (A)(D) 2 to 13 points 9 points /10 points(4)
Interest rate quanto correlation /
(A)(D)
-11 to 37 % 6% / -8%(4)
Interest rate -
Credit spread correlation / (A)(D)
-61 to 16 % -20% /-19%(4)
Interest rate curve correlation / (A)(D) 36 to 94 % 71% / 76%(4)
Interest rate -Foreign exchange
correlation / (A)(D)
47 to 48 % 48% / 48%(4)
Interest rate volatility skew / (A)(D) 25 to 59 % 39% / 29%(4)
Interest rate curve / (A)(D) 0 to 1 % 1% / 0%(4)

Equity contracts(5)

(1,097 ) Option model At the money volatility / (A)(D) 10 to 57 % 30%
Volatility skew / (A)(D) -5 to 1 % -1%
Equity - Equity correlation / (C)(D) 30 to 99 % 67%
Equity - Foreign exchange
correlation /(C)(D)
-60 to 10 % -17%
Equity - Interest rate correlation /
(C)(D)
17 to 71 % 27% / 12%(4)

Commodity contracts

1,132 Option model Forward power price / (C)(D) $13 to $79 per Megawatt hour $38 per Megawatt hour
Commodity volatility / (A)(D) 12 to 73 % 19%
Cross commodity correlation / (C)(D) 34 to 100 % 93%

Investments(3):

Principal investments

883 Discounted cash flow Implied weighted average cost of
capital / (C)(D)
11% 11%
Exit multiple / (A)(D) 10 times 10 times
Discounted cash flow Equity discount rate / (C)(D) 25 % 25%
Market approach(6) EBITDA multiple / (A) 4 to 16 times 6 times

Other

380 Discounted cash flow Implied weighted average cost of
capital / (C)(D)
10 % 10%
Exit multiple / (A)(D) 9 times 9 times
Market approach(6) EBITDA multiple / (A) 9 to 10 times 10 times

Liabilities

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

$ 155 Discounted cash flow Funding spread / (A) 75 to 79 basis points 78 basis points

Other secured financings

135 Comparable pricing Comparable bond price / (A) 94 to 111 points 97 points
Discounted cash flow Discount rate / (C) 19 % 19%

Discounted cash flow(6)

Funding spread / (A) 68 to 85 basis points 74 basis points

Long-term borrowings

1,779 Option model At the money volatility / (C)(D) 18 to 31 % 24%
Volatility skew / (A)(D) -2 to 0 % 0%
Equity - Equity correlation / (A)(D) 32 to 97 % 64%
Equity - Foreign exchange correlation /
(C)(D)
-86 to 30 % -9%

EBITDA—Earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization

(1) The ranges of significant unobservable inputs are represented in points, percentages, basis points, times or megawatt hours. Points are a percentage of par; for example, 5 points would be 5% of par. A basis point equals 1/100th of 1%; for example, 516 basis points would equal 5.16%.
(2) Amounts represent weighted averages except where simple averages and the median of the inputs are provided (see footnote 4 below). Weighted averages are calculated by weighting each input by the fair value of the respective financial instruments except for collateralized debt and loan obligations, long-term borrowings and derivative instruments where some or all inputs are weighted by risk.
(3) Investments in funds measured using an unadjusted net assets value (“NAV”) are excluded.
(4) The data structure of the significant unobservable inputs used in valuing Interest rate contracts, Foreign exchange contracts and certain Equity contracts may be in a multi-dimensional form, such as a curve or surface, with risk distributed across the structure. Therefore, a simple average and median, together with the range of data inputs, may be more appropriate measurements than a single point weighted average.
(5) Includes derivative contracts with multiple risks ( i.e., hybrid products).
(6) This is the predominant valuation technique for this major asset or liability class.

Sensitivity of the fair value to changes in the unobservable inputs:

(A) Significant increase (decrease) in the unobservable input in isolation would result in a significantly higher (lower) fair value measurement.

25 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(B) Significant changes in credit correlation may result in a significantly higher or lower fair value measurement. Increasing (decreasing) correlation drives a redistribution of risk within the capital structure such that junior tranches become less (more) risky and senior tranches become more (less) risky.

(C) Significant increase (decrease) in the unobservable input in isolation would result in a significantly lower (higher) fair value measurement.

(D) There are no predictable relationships between the significant unobservable inputs.

At December 31, 2013.

Balance at
December 31,
2013

(dollars in
millions)

Valuation
Technique(s)

Significant Unobservable Input(s) /
Sensitivity of the Fair Value to
Changes in the Unobservable Inputs

Range(1) Averages(2)

Assets

Trading assets:

Corporate and other debt:

Commercial mortgage-backed securities

$ 108 Comparable pricing Comparable bond price / (A) 40 to 93 points 78 points

Asset-backed securities

103 Discounted cash flow Discount rate / (C) 18% 18%

Corporate bonds

522 Comparable pricing Comparable bond price / (A) 1 to 159 points 85 points

Collateralized debt and loan obligations

1,468 Comparable pricing(6) Comparable bond price / (A) 18 to 99 points 73 points
Correlation model Credit correlation / (B) 29 to 59 % 43%

Loans and lending commitments

5,129 Corporate loan model Credit spread / (C) 28 to 487 249 basis
basis points points
Margin loan model Credit spread / (C)(D) 10 to 265 135 basis
basis points points
Volatility skew / (C)(D) 3 to 40 % 14%

Comparable bond price / (A)(D)

80 to 120 points 100 points
Option model Volatility skew / (C) -1 to 0 % 0%
Comparable pricing(6) Comparable loan price / (A) 10 to 100 points 76 points

Corporate equities(3)

190 Net asset value(6) Discount to net asset value / (C) 0 to 85 % 43%
Comparable pricing

Comparable equity price / (A)

100 % 100%
Comparable pricing Comparable price / (A) 100 % 100%
Market approach EBITDA multiple / (A)(D) 5 to 9 times 6 times

Price/Book ratio / (A)(D)

0 to 1 times 1 times

Net derivative and other contracts:

Interest rate contracts

113 Option model

Interest rate volatility concentration liquidity multiple / (C)(D)

0 to 6 times 2 times

Comparable bond price / (A)(D)

5 to 100 points 58 points / 65 points(4)

Interest rate - Foreign exchange correlation / (A)(D)

3 to 63 % 43% / 48%(4)
Interest rate volatility skew /(A)(D) 24 to 50 % 33% / 28%(4)
Interest rate quanto correlation / (A)(D) -11 to 34 % 8% / 5%(4)

Interest rate curve correlation / (A)(D)

46 to 92 % 74% / 80%(4)

Inflation volatility / (A)(D)

77 to 86 % 81% / 80%(4)

Credit contracts

(147 ) Comparable pricing Cash synthetic basis / (C)(D) 2 to 5 points 4 points
Comparable bond price / (C)(D) 0 to 75 points 27 points
Correlation model(6) Credit correlation / (B) 19 to 96 % 56%

Foreign exchange contracts(5)

68 Option model Comparable bond price / (A)(D) 5 to 100 points 58 points / 65 points(4)
Interest rate quanto correlation / (A)(D) -11 to 34 % 8% / 5%(4)

Interest rate curve correlation / (A)(D)

46 to 92 % 74% / 80%(4)

Interest rate - Foreign exchange correlation / (A)(D)

3 to 63 % 43% / 48%(4)

Interest rate volatility skew / (A)(D)

24 to 50 % 33% / 28%(4)

Interest rate curve / (A)(D)

0 to 1 % 1% / 0%(4)

LOGO 26


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Balance at
December 31,
2013

(dollars in
millions)

Valuation
Technique(s)

Significant Unobservable Input(s) /
Sensitivity of the Fair Value to
Changes in the Unobservable Inputs

Range(1) Averages(2)

Equity contracts(5)

(831 ) Option model

At the money volatility / (A)(D)

20 to 53 % 31%

Volatility skew / (A)(D)

-3 to 0 % -1%

Equity - Equity correlation / (C)(D)

40 to 99 % 69%

Equity - Foreign exchange correlation / (C)(D)

-50 to 9 % -20%

Equity - Interest rate correlation / (C)(D)

-4 to 70 % 39% / 40%(4)

Commodity contracts

880 Option model Forward power price / (C)(D) $14 to $91 per Megawatt hour $40 per Megawatt hour
Commodity volatility / (A)(D) 11 to 30 % 14%
Cross commodity correlation /(C)(D) 34 to 99 % 93%

Investments(3):

Principal investments

2,160 Discounted cash flow

Implied weighted average cost of capital / (C)(D)

12 % 12%
Exit multiple / (A)(D) 9 times 9 times
Discounted cash flow(6) Capitalization rate / (C)(D) 5 to 13 % 7%
Equity discount rate / (C)(D) 10 to 30 % 21%
Market approach EBITDA multiple / (A) 5 to 6 times 5 times

Other

538 Discounted cash flow

Implied weighted average cost of capital / (C)(D)

7 to 10 % 8%
Exit multiple / (A)(D) 7 to 9 times 9 times
Market approach(6) EBITDA multiple / (A) 8 to 14 times 10 times
Liabilities

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

$ 154 Discounted cash flow Funding spread / (A) 92 to 97 basis points 95 basis points

Other secured financings

278 Comparable pricing(6) Comparable bond price / (A) 99 to 102 points 101 points
Discounted cash flow Funding spread / (A) 97 basis points 97 basis points
Long-term borrowings 1,887 Option model At the money volatility / (C)(D) 20 to 33 % 26%
Volatility skew / (A)(D) -2 to 0 % 0%
Equity - Equity correlation / (A)(D) 50 to 70 % 69%

Equity - Foreign exchange correlation / (C)(D)

-60 to 0 % -23%

(1) The ranges of significant unobservable inputs are represented in points, percentages, basis points, times or megawatt hours. Points are a percentage of par; for example, 93 points would be 93% of par. A basis point equals 1/100th of 1%; for example, 487 basis points would equal 4.87%.
(2) Amounts represent weighted averages except where simple averages and the median of the inputs are provided (see footnote 4 below). Weighted averages are calculated by weighting each input by the fair value of the respective financial instruments except for long-term borrowings and derivative instruments where inputs are weighted by risk.
(3) Investments in funds measured using an unadjusted NAV are excluded.
(4) The data structure of the significant unobservable inputs used in valuing Interest rate contracts, Foreign exchange contracts and certain Equity contracts may be in a multi-dimensional form, such as a curve or surface, with risk distributed across the structure. Therefore, a simple average and median, together with the range of data inputs, may be more appropriate measurements than a single point weighted average.
(5) Includes derivative contracts with multiple risks ( i.e., hybrid products).
(6) This is the predominant valuation technique for this major asset or liability class.

Sensitivity of the fair value to changes in the unobservable inputs:

(A) Significant increase (decrease) in the unobservable input in isolation would result in a significantly higher (lower) fair value measurement.
(B) Significant changes in credit correlation may result in a significantly higher or lower fair value measurement. Increasing (decreasing) correlation drives a redistribution of risk within the capital structure such that junior tranches become less (more) risky and senior tranches become more (less) risky.
(C) Significant increase (decrease) in the unobservable input in isolation would result in a significantly lower (higher) fair value measurement.
(D) There are no predictable relationships between the significant unobservable inputs.

27 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The following provides a description of significant unobservable inputs included in the June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 tables above for all major categories of assets and liabilities:

Comparable bond price —a pricing input used when prices for the identical instrument are not available. Significant subjectivity may be involved when fair value is determined using pricing data available for comparable instruments. Valuation using comparable instruments can be done by calculating an implied yield (or spread over a liquid benchmark) from the price of a comparable bond, then adjusting that yield (or spread) to derive a value for the bond. The adjustment to yield (or spread) should account for relevant differences in the bonds such as maturity or credit quality. Alternatively, a price-to-price basis can be assumed between the comparable instrument and bond being valued in order to establish the value of the bond. Additionally, as the probability of default increases for a given bond ( i.e. , as the bond becomes more distressed), the valuation of that bond will increasingly reflect its expected recovery level assuming default. The decision to use price-to-price or yield/spread comparisons largely reflects trading market convention for the financial instruments in question. Price-to-price comparisons are primarily employed for residential mortgage-backed securities, commercial mortgage-backed securities (“CMBS”), collateralized debt obligations (“CDOs”), collateralized loan obligations (“CLOs”), Other debt, interest rate contracts, foreign exchange contracts, Other secured financings, mortgage loans and distressed corporate bonds. Implied yield (or spread over a liquid benchmark) is utilized predominately for non-distressed corporate bonds, loans and credit contracts.

Correlation —a pricing input where the payoff is driven by more than one underlying risk. Correlation is a measure of the relationship between the movements of two variables ( i.e ., how the change in one variable influences a change in the other variable). Credit correlation, for example, is the factor that describes the relationship between the probability of individual entities to default on obligations and the joint probability of multiple entities to default on obligations.

Credit spread —the difference in yield between different securities due to differences in credit quality. The credit spread reflects the additional net yield an investor can earn from a security with more credit risk relative to one with less credit risk. The credit spread of a particular security is often quoted in relation to the yield on a credit risk-free benchmark security or reference rate, typically either U.S. Treasury or London Interbank Offered Rate (“LIBOR”).

Volatility skew —the measure of the difference in implied volatility for options with identical underliers and expiry dates but with different strikes. The implied volatility for an option with a strike price that is above or below the current price of an underlying asset will typically deviate from the implied volatility for an option with a strike price equal to the current price of that same underlying asset.

EBITDA multiple / Exit multiple —is the Enterprise Value to EBITDA ratio, where the Enterprise Value is the aggregate value of equity and debt minus cash and cash equivalents. The EBITDA multiple reflects the value of the company in terms of its full-year EBITDA, whereas the exit multiple reflects the value of the company in terms of its full-year expected EBITDA at exit. Either multiple allows comparison between companies from an operational perspective as the effect of capital structure, taxation and depreciation/amortization is excluded.

Price / Book ratio —the ratio used to compare a stock’s market value to its book value. It is calculated by dividing the current closing price of the stock by the latest book value per share. This multiple allows comparison between companies from an operational perspective.

Volatility —the measure of the variability in possible returns for an instrument given how much that instrument changes in value over time. Volatility is a pricing input for options and, generally, the lower the volatility, the less risky the option. The level of volatility used in the valuation of a particular option depends on a number of factors, including the nature of the risk underlying that option ( e.g. , the volatility

LOGO 28


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

of a particular underlying equity security may be significantly different from that of a particular underlying commodity index), the tenor and the strike price of the option.

Cash synthetic basis —the measure of the price differential between cash financial instruments (“cash instruments”) and their synthetic derivative-based equivalents (“synthetic instruments”). The range disclosed in the table above signifies the number of points by which the synthetic bond equivalent price is higher than the quoted price of the underlying cash bonds.

Interest rate curve —the term structure of interest rates (relationship between interest rates and the time to maturity) and a market’s measure of future interest rates at the time of observation. An interest rate curve is used to set interest rate and foreign exchange derivative cash flows and is a pricing input used in the discounting of any over-the-counter (“OTC”) derivative cash flow.

Implied weighted average cost of capital (“WACC”) —the WACC implied by the current value of equity in a discounted cash flow model. The model assumes that the cash flow assumptions, including projections, are fully reflected in the current equity value while the debt to equity ratio is held constant. The WACC theoretically represents the required rate of return to debt and equity investors, respectively.

Capitalization rate —the ratio between net operating income produced by an asset and its market value at the projected disposition date.

Funding spread —the difference between the general collateral rate (which refers to the rate applicable to a broad class of U.S. Treasury issuances) and the specific collateral rate (which refers to the rate applicable to a specific type of security pledged as collateral, such as a municipal bond). Repurchase agreements and certain other secured financings are discounted based on collateral curves. The curves are constructed as spreads over the corresponding overnight indexed swap (“OIS”) or LIBOR curves, with the short end of the curve representing spreads over the corresponding OIS curves and the long end of the curve representing spreads over LIBOR.

Fair Value of Investments That Calculate Net Asset Value.

The Company’s Investments measured at fair value were $6,793 million and $8,013 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. The following table presents information solely about the Company’s investments in private equity funds, real estate funds and hedge funds measured at fair value based on NAV at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively:

At June 30, 2014 At December 31, 2013
Fair Value Unfunded
Commitment
Fair Value Unfunded
Commitment
(dollars in millions)

Private equity funds

$ 2,555 $ 569 $ 2,531 $ 559

Real estate funds

1,820 104 1,643 124

Hedge funds(1):

Long-short equity hedge funds

470 469

Fixed income/credit-related hedge funds

73 82

Event-driven hedge funds

39 38

Multi-strategy hedge funds

162 3 220 3

Total

$ 5,119 $ 676 $ 4,983 $ 686

(1) Fixed income/credit-related hedge funds, event-driven hedge funds, and multi-strategy hedge funds are redeemable at least on a three-month period basis primarily with a notice period of 90 days or less. At June 30, 2014, approximately 39% of the fair value amount of long-short equity hedge funds is redeemable at least quarterly, 43% is redeemable every six months and 18% of these funds have a redemption frequency of greater than six months. The notice period for long-short equity hedge funds at June 30, 2014 is primarily greater than six months. At December 31, 2013, approximately 42% of the fair value amount of long-short equity hedge funds is redeemable at least quarterly, 42% is redeemable every six months and 16% of these funds have a redemption frequency of greater than six months. The notice period for long-short equity hedge funds at December 31, 2013 is primarily greater than six months.

29 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Private Equity Funds. Amount includes several private equity funds that pursue multiple strategies including leveraged buyouts, venture capital, infrastructure growth capital, distressed investments, and mezzanine capital. In addition, the funds may be structured with a focus on specific domestic or foreign geographic regions. These investments are generally not redeemable with the funds. Instead, the nature of the investments in this category is that distributions are received through the liquidation of the underlying assets of the fund. At June 30, 2014, it was estimated that 6% of the fair value of the funds will be liquidated in the next five years, another 57% of the fair value of the funds will be liquidated between five to 10 years and the remaining 37% of the fair value of the funds have a remaining life of greater than 10 years.

Real Estate Funds. Amount includes several real estate funds that invest in real estate assets such as commercial office buildings, retail properties, multi-family residential properties, developments or hotels. In addition, the funds may be structured with a focus on specific geographic domestic or foreign regions. These investments are generally not redeemable with the funds. Distributions from each fund will be received as the underlying investments of the funds are liquidated. At June 30, 2014, it was estimated that 4% of the fair value of the funds will be liquidated within the next five years, another 57% of the fair value of the funds will be liquidated between five to 10 years and the remaining 39% of the fair value of the funds have a remaining life of greater than 10 years.

Hedge Funds .    Investments in hedge funds may be subject to initial period lock-up restrictions or gates. A hedge fund lock-up provision is a provision that provides that, during a certain initial period, an investor may not make a withdrawal from the fund. The purpose of a gate is to restrict the level of redemptions that an investor in a particular hedge fund can demand on any redemption date.

Long-Short Equity Hedge Funds. Amount includes investments in hedge funds that invest, long or short, in equities. Equity value and growth hedge funds purchase stocks perceived to be undervalued and sell stocks perceived to be overvalued. Investments representing approximately 12% of the fair value of the investments in this category cannot be redeemed currently because the investments include certain initial period lock-up restrictions. The remaining restriction period for these investments subject to lock-up restrictions was primarily two years or less at June 30, 2014. Investments representing approximately 21% of the fair value of the investments in long-short equity hedge funds cannot be redeemed currently because an exit restriction has been imposed by the hedge fund manager. The restriction period for these investments subject to an exit restriction was primarily indefinite at June 30, 2014.

Fixed Income/Credit-Related Hedge Funds. Amount includes investments in hedge funds that employ long-short, distressed or relative value strategies in order to benefit from investments in undervalued or overvalued securities that are primarily debt or credit related. Investments representing approximately 9% of the fair value of the investments in this category cannot be redeemed currently because the investments include certain initial period lock-up restrictions. The remaining restriction period for these investments subject to lock-up restrictions was primarily over three years at June 30, 2014.

Event-Driven Hedge Funds. Amount includes investments in hedge funds that invest in event-driven situations such as mergers, hostile takeovers, reorganizations, or leveraged buyouts. This may involve the simultaneous purchase of stock in companies being acquired and the sale of stock in its acquirer, with the expectation to profit from the spread between the current market price and the ultimate purchase price of the target company. At June 30, 2014, there were no restrictions on redemptions.

Multi-strategy Hedge Funds. Amount includes investments in hedge funds that pursue multiple strategies to realize short- and long-term gains. Management of the hedge funds has the ability to overweight or underweight different strategies to best capitalize on current investment opportunities. At June 30, 2014, investments representing approximately 24% of the fair value of the investments in this category cannot be redeemed currently because the investments include certain initial period lock-up

LOGO 30


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

restrictions. The remaining restriction period for these investments subject to lock-up restrictions was primarily over three years at June 30, 2014. Investments representing approximately 19% of the fair value of the investments in multi-strategy hedge funds cannot be redeemed currently because an exit restriction has been imposed by the hedge fund manager. The restriction period for these investments subject to an exit restriction was indefinite at June 30, 2014.

Fair Value Option.

The Company elected the fair value option for certain eligible instruments that are risk managed on a fair value basis to mitigate income statement volatility caused by measurement basis differences between the elected instruments and their associated risk management transactions or to eliminate complexities of applying certain accounting models. The following table presents net gains (losses) due to changes in fair value for items measured at fair value pursuant to the fair value option election for the quarters and six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively:

Trading
Revenues
Interest
Income
(Expense)
Gains
(Losses)
Included in
Net
Revenues
(dollars in millions)

Three Months Ended June 30, 2014

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

$ (1 ) $ 2 $ 1

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings(1)

(14 ) (14 )

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

(5 ) (1 ) (6 )

Long-term borrowings(1)

(678 ) (174 ) (852 )

Six Months Ended June 30, 2014

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

$ (2 ) $ 4 $ 2

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings(1)

(37 ) (37 )

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

(5 ) (2 ) (7 )

Long-term borrowings(1)

(948 ) (346 ) (1,294 )

Three Months Ended June 30, 2013

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

$ (2 ) $ 2 $

Deposits

16 (16 )

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings(2)

117 (1 ) 116

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

9 (2 ) 7

Long-term borrowings(2)

1,116 (231 ) 885

Six Months Ended June 30, 2013

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

$ (1 ) $ 3 $ 2

Deposits

30 (33 ) (3 )

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings(2)

180 (2 ) 178

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

5 (3 ) 2

Long-term borrowings(2)

1,207 (528 ) 679

(1) Of the total gains (losses) recorded in Trading revenues for short-term and long-term borrowings for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, $87 million and $213 million, respectively, are attributable to changes in the credit quality of the Company and other credit factors, and the respective remainder is attributable to changes in foreign currency rates or interest rates or movements in the reference price or index for structured notes before the impact of related hedges.
(2) Of the total gains (losses) recorded in Trading for short-term and long-term borrowings for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, $175 million and $(142) million, respectively, are attributable to changes in the credit quality of the Company and other credit factors, and the respective remainder is attributable to changes in foreign currency rates or interest rates or movements in the reference price or index for structured notes before the impact of related hedges.

31 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

In addition to the amounts in the above table, as discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K, all of the instruments within Trading assets or Trading liabilities are measured at fair value, either through the election of the fair value option or as required by other accounting guidance. The amounts in the above table are included within Net revenues and do not reflect gains or losses on related hedging instruments, if any.

The Company hedges the economics of market risk for short-term and long-term borrowings ( i.e ., risks other than that related to the credit quality of the Company) as part of its overall trading strategy and manages the market risks embedded within the issuance by the related business unit as part of the business unit’s portfolio. The gains and losses on related economic hedges are recorded in Trading revenues and largely offset the gains and losses on short-term and long-term borrowings attributable to market risk.

At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, a breakdown of the short-term and long-term borrowings measured at fair value on a recurring basis by business unit responsible for risk-managing each borrowing is shown in the table below:

Short-Term and  Long-Term
Borrowings

Business Unit

At
June  30,
2014
At
December  31,
2013
(dollars in millions)

Interest rates

$ 15,514 $ 15,933

Equity

17,933 17,945

Credit and foreign exchange

2,393 2,561

Commodities

694 545

Total

$ 36,534 $ 36,984

The following tables present information on the Company’s short-term and long-term borrowings (primarily structured notes), loans and unfunded lending commitments for which the fair value option was elected:

Gains (Losses) due to Changes in Instrument-Specific Credit Risk.

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Short-term and long-term borrowings(1)

$ 87 $ 175 $ 213 $ (142 )

Loans(2)

126 55 128 115

Unfunded lending commitments(3)

13 81 27 215

(1) The change in the fair value of short-term and long-term borrowings (primarily structured notes) includes an adjustment to reflect the change in credit quality of the Company based upon observations of the Company’s secondary bond market spreads and changes in other credit factors.
(2) Instrument-specific credit gains (losses) were determined by excluding the non-credit components of gains and losses, such as those due to changes in interest rates.
(3) Gains (losses) were generally determined based on the differential between estimated expected client yields and contractual yields at each respective period-end.

LOGO 32


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Net Difference between Contractual Principal Amount and Fair Value.

Contractual Principal
Amount Exceeds Fair
Value
At
June 30,
2014
At
December 31,
2013
(dollars in millions)

Short-term and long-term borrowings(1)

$ (1,780 ) $ (2,409 )

Loans(2)

16,952 17,248

Loans 90 or more days past due and/or on nonaccrual status(2)(3)

15,267 15,113

(1) These amounts do not include structured notes where the repayment of the initial principal amount fluctuates based on changes in the reference price or index.
(2) The majority of this difference between principal and fair value amounts emanates from the Company’s distressed debt trading business, which purchases distressed debt at amounts well below par.
(3) The aggregate fair value of loans that were in nonaccrual status, which includes all loans 90 or more days past due, was $1,604 million and $1,205 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. The aggregate fair value of loans that were 90 or more days past due was $582 million and $655 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.

The tables above exclude non-recourse debt from consolidated VIEs, liabilities related to failed sales of financial assets, pledged commodities and other liabilities that have specified assets attributable to them.

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Non-recurring Basis .

Certain assets were measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis and are not included in the tables above. These assets may include loans, other investments, premises, equipment and software costs, and intangible assets.

The following tables present, by caption on the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition, the fair value hierarchy for those assets measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis for which the Company recognized a non-recurring fair value adjustment for the quarters and six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

Three Months and Six Months Ended June 30, 2014.

Fair Value Measurements Using:
Carrying
Value at
June 30,
2014(1)
Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
Total
Gains (Losses)
for the Three
Months Ended
June  30,
2014(2)
Total Gains
(Losses)

for  the Six
Months Ended
June 30,
2014(2)
(dollars in millions)

Loans(3)

$ 2,390 $ $ 1,999 $ 391 $ (21 ) $ (7 )

Other investments(4)

47 47 (3 ) (25 )

Premises, equipment and software costs(5)

(41 ) (41 )

Intangible assets(4)

(2 )

Other assets(5)

(9 )

Total

$ 2,437 $ $ 1,999 $ 438 $ (65 ) $ (84 )

33 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(1) Carrying values relate only to those assets that had fair value adjustments during the quarter ended June 30, 2014. These amounts do not include assets that had fair value adjustments during the six months ended June 30, 2014, unless the assets also had a fair value adjustment during the quarter ended June 30, 2014.
(2) Fair value adjustments related to Loans and losses related to Other investments are recorded within Other revenues whereas losses related to Premises, equipment and software costs, Intangible assets and Other assets are recorded within Other expenses in the condensed consolidated statements of income.
(3) Non-recurring changes in the fair value of loans held for investment or held for sale were calculated using recently executed transactions; market price quotations; valuation models that incorporate market observable inputs where possible, such as comparable loan or debt prices and credit default swap spread levels adjusted for any basis difference between cash and derivative instruments; or default recovery analysis where such transactions and quotations are unobservable.
(4) Losses were determined primarily using discounted cash flow models and methodologies that incorporate multiples of certain comparable companies.
(5) Losses were determined primarily using a default recovery analysis.

There were no significant liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis during the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014.

Three Months and Six Months Ended June 30, 2013.

Fair Value Measurements Using:
Carrying
Value at
June 30,
2013(1)
Quoted Prices
in Active
Markets for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs
(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
Total
Gains (Losses)
for the Three
Months Ended
June  30,
2013(2)
Total Gains
(Losses)
for the Six
Months Ended
June 30,
2013(2)
(dollars in millions)

Loans(3)

$ 1,511 $ $ 1,254 $ 257 $ (51 ) $ (77 )

Other investments(4)

64 64 (5 ) (20 )

Premises, equipment and software costs(4)

(6 ) (6 )

Intangible assets(4)

25 25 (8 ) (9 )

Total

$ 1,600 $ $ 1,254 $ 346 $ (70 ) $ (112 )

(1) Carrying values relate only to those assets that had fair value adjustments during the quarter ended June 30, 2013. These amounts do not include assets that had fair value adjustments during the six months ended June 30, 2013, unless the assets also had a fair value adjustment during the quarter ended June 30, 2013.
(2) Losses are recorded within Other expenses in the condensed consolidated statements of income except for fair value adjustments related to Loans and losses related to Other investments, which are included in Other revenues.
(3) Non-recurring changes in the fair value of loans held for investment or held for sale were calculated using recently executed transactions; market price quotations; valuation models that incorporate market observable inputs where possible, such as comparable loan or debt prices and credit default swap spread levels adjusted for any basis difference between cash and derivative instruments; or default recovery analysis where such transactions and quotations are unobservable.
(4) Losses recorded were determined primarily using discounted cash flow models.

There were no significant liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis during the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013.

Financial Instruments Not Measured at Fair Value.

The tables below present the carrying value, fair value and fair value hierarchy category of certain financial instruments that are not measured at fair value in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. The tables below exclude certain financial instruments such as equity method investments and all non-financial assets and liabilities such as the value of the long-term relationships with our deposit customers.

LOGO 34


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The carrying value of cash and cash equivalents, including Interest bearing deposits with banks, and other short-term financial instruments such as Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell; Securities borrowed; Securities sold under agreements to repurchase; Securities loaned; certain Customer and other receivables and Customer and other payables arising in the ordinary course of business; certain Deposits; Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings; and Other secured financings approximate fair value because of the relatively short period of time between their origination and expected maturity.

For longer-dated Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell, Securities borrowed, Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, Securities loaned and Other secured financings, fair value is determined using a standard cash flow discounting methodology. The inputs to the valuation include contractual cash flows and collateral funding spreads, which are estimated using various benchmarks and interest rate yield curves.

For consumer and residential real estate loans and lending commitments where position-specific external price data are not observable, the fair value is based on the credit risks of the borrower using a probability of default and loss given default method, discounted at the estimated external cost of funding level. The fair value of corporate loans and lending commitments is determined using recently executed transactions, market price quotations (where observable), implied yields from comparable debt, and market observable credit default swap spread levels along with proprietary valuation models and default recovery analysis where such transactions and quotations are unobservable.

The fair value of long-term borrowings is generally determined based on transactional data or third-party pricing for identical or comparable instruments, when available. Where position-specific external prices are not observable, fair value is determined based on current interest rates and credit spreads for debt instruments with similar terms and maturity.

35 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Financial Instruments Not Measured at Fair Value at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

At June 30, 2014.

At June 30, 2014 Fair Value Measurements Using:
Carrying
Value
Fair Value Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
(dollars in millions)

Financial Assets:

Cash and due from banks

$ 18,863 $ 18,863 $ 18,863 $ $

Interest bearing deposits with banks

22,022 22,022 22,022

Cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements

44,713 44,713 44,713

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

108,092 108,097 107,874 223

Securities borrowed

147,466 147,460 147,455 5

Customer and other receivables(1)

49,888 49,688 44,718 4,970

Loans(2)

55,260 56,072 14,577 41,495

Financial Liabilities:

Deposits

$ 117,695 $ 117,747 $ $ 117,747 $

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings

468 468 468

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

110,806 110,909 105,931 4,978

Securities loaned

30,808 30,833 29,831 1,002

Other secured financings

8,951 8,973 5,471 3,502

Customer and other payables(1)

175,183 175,183 175,183

Long-term borrowings

114,264 118,869 118,271 598

(1) Accrued interest, fees and dividend receivables and payables where carrying value approximates fair value have been excluded.
(2) Includes all loans measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis.

The fair value of the Company’s unfunded lending commitments, primarily related to corporate lending in the Institutional Securities business segment, that are not carried at fair value at June 30, 2014 was $828 million, of which $652 million and $176 million would be categorized in Level 2 and Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy, respectively. The carrying value of these commitments, if fully funded, would be $75.3 billion.

LOGO 36


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

At December 31, 2013.

At December 31, 2013 Fair Value Measurements Using:
Carrying
Value
Fair Value Quoted
Prices in
Active
Markets
for
Identical
Assets

(Level 1)
Significant
Observable
Inputs

(Level 2)
Significant
Unobservable
Inputs

(Level 3)
(dollars in millions)

Financial Assets:

Cash and due from banks

$ 16,602 $ 16,602 $ 16,602 $ $

Interest bearing deposits with banks

43,281 43,281 43,281

Cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements

39,203 39,203 39,203

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

117,264 117,263 116,584 679

Securities borrowed

129,707 129,705 129,374 331

Customer and other receivables(1)

53,112 53,031 47,525 5,506

Loans(2)

42,874 42,765 11,288 31,477

Financial Liabilities:

Deposits

$ 112,194 $ 112,273 $ $ 112,273 $

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings

795 795 787 8

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

145,115 145,157 138,161 6,996

Securities loaned

32,799 32,826 31,731 1,095

Other secured financings

9,009 9,034 5,845 3,189

Customer and other payables(1)

154,654 154,654 154,654

Long-term borrowings

117,938 123,133 122,099 1,034

(1) Accrued interest, fees and dividend receivables and payables where carrying value approximates fair value have been excluded.
(2) Includes all loans measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis.

The fair value of the Company’s unfunded lending commitments, primarily related to corporate lending in the Institutional Securities business segment, that are not carried at fair value at December 31, 2013 was $853 million, of which $669 million and $184 million would be categorized in Level 2 and Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy, respectively. The carrying value of these commitments, if fully funded, would be $75.4 billion.

37 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

5. Available for Sale Securities.

The following tables present information about the Company’s available for sale securities (“AFS Securities”):

At June 30, 2014
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Other-than-
Temporary
Impairment
Fair
Value
(dollars in millions)

Available for sale debt securities:

U.S. government and agency securities:

U.S. Treasury securities

$ 34,727 $ 78 $ 61 $ $ 34,744

U.S. agency securities(1)

16,046 69 98 16,017

Total U.S. government and agency securities

50,773 147 159 50,761

Corporate and other debt:

Commercial mortgage-backed securities:

Agency

2,387 75 2,312

Non-Agency

1,472 10 4 1,478

Auto loan asset-backed securities

2,080 2 1 2,081

Corporate bonds

3,533 13 18 3,528

Collateralized loan obligations

1,087 15 1,072

FFELP student loan asset-backed securities(2)

4,201 25 3 4,223

Total corporate and other debt

14,760 50 116 14,694

Total available for sale debt securities

65,533 197 275 65,455

Available for sale equity securities

15 4 19

Total

$ 65,548 $ 201 $ 275 $ $ 65,474

At December 31, 2013
Amortized
Cost
Gross
Unrealized
Gains
Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Other-than-
Temporary
Impairment
Fair
Value
(dollars in millions)

Available for sale debt securities:

U.S. government and agency securities:

U.S. Treasury securities

$ 24,486 $ 51 $ 139 $ $ 24,398

U.S. agency securities

15,813 26 234 15,605

Total U.S. government and agency securities

40,299 77 373 40,003

Corporate and other debt:

Commercial mortgage-backed securities:

Agency

2,482 84 2,398

Non-Agency

1,333 1 18 1,316

Auto loan asset-backed securities

2,041 2 1 2,042

Corporate bonds

3,415 3 61 3,357

Collateralized loan obligations

1,087 20 1,067

FFELP student loan asset-backed securities(2)

3,230 12 8 3,234

Total corporate and other debt

13,588 18 192 13,414

Total available for sale debt securities

53,887 95 565 53,417

Available for sale equity securities

15 2 13

Total

$ 53,902 $ 95 $ 567 $ $ 53,430

FFELP—Federal Family Education Loan Program

(1) U.S. agency securities are composed of three main categories consisting of agency-issued debt, agency mortgage pass-through pool securities and collateralized mortgage obligations.
(2) Amounts are backed by a guarantee from the U.S. Department of Education of at least 95% of the principal balance and interest on such loans.

LOGO 38


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The tables below present the fair value of investments in AFS Securities that are in an unrealized loss position:

Less than 12 Months 12 Months or Longer Total

At June 30, 2014

Fair Value Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair Value Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair Value Gross
Unrealized
Losses
(dollars in millions)

Available for sale debt securities:

U.S. government and agency securities:

U.S. Treasury securities

$ 4,702 $ 2 $ 5,914 $ 59 $ 10,616 $ 61

U.S. agency securities

1,342 2 5,011 96 6,353 98

Total U.S. government and agency securities

6,044 4 10,925 155 16,969 159

Corporate and other debt:

Commercial mortgage-backed securities:

Agency

9 1,975 75 1,984 75

Non-Agency

58 559 4 617 4

Auto loan asset-backed securities

553 1 553 1

Corporate bonds

413 2 1,351 16 1,764 18

Collateralized loan obligations

1,072 15 1,072 15

FFELP student loan asset-backed securities

273 520 3 793 3

Total corporate and other debt

1,306 3 5,477 113 6,783 116

Total available for sale debt securities

7,350 7 16,402 268 23,752 275

Total

$ 7,350 $ 7 $ 16,402 $ 268 $ 23,752 $ 275

Less than 12 Months 12 Months or Longer Total

At December 31, 2013

Fair Value Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair Value Gross
Unrealized
Losses
Fair Value Gross
Unrealized
Losses
(dollars in millions)

Available for sale debt securities:

U.S. government and agency securities:

U.S. Treasury securities

$ 13,266 $ 139 $ $ $ 13,266 $ 139

U.S. agency securities

8,438 211 651 23 9,089 234

Total U.S. government and agency securities

21,704 350 651 23 22,355 373

Corporate and other debt:

Commercial mortgage-backed securities:

Agency

958 15 1,270 69 2,228 84

Non-Agency

841 16 86 2 927 18

Auto loan asset-backed securities

557 1 85 642 1

Corporate bonds

2,350 52 383 9 2,733 61

Collateralized loan obligations

1,067 20 1,067 20

FFELP student loan asset-backed securities

1,388 7 76 1 1,464 8

Total corporate and other debt

7,161 111 1,900 81 9,061 192

Total available for sale debt securities

28,865 461 2,551 104 31,416 565

Available for sale equity securities

13 2 13 2

Total

$ 28,878 $ 463 $ 2,551 $ 104 $ 31,429 $ 567

Gross unrealized gains and losses are recorded in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss), net of tax (“AOCI”).

As discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K, AFS Securities with a current fair value less than their amortized cost are analyzed as part of the Company’s ongoing assessment of temporary

39 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

versus other-than-temporarily impaired at the individual security level. The unrealized losses reported above on available for sale debt securities are primarily due to rising long-term interest rates since those securities were purchased. While the securities in an unrealized loss position greater than twelve months have increased in 2014, the risk of credit loss is considered minimal because all of the Company’s agency securities as well as the Company’s asset-backed securities (“ABS”), CMBS and CLOs are highly rated and the Company’s corporate bonds are all investment grade. The Company does not intend to sell these securities and is not likely to be required to sell these securities prior to recovery of the amortized cost basis. The Company does not expect to experience a credit loss on these securities based on consideration of the relevant information (as discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K), including for U.S. government and agency securities, the existence of the explicit and implicit guarantee provided by the U.S. government. The Company believes that the debt securities with an unrealized loss position were not other-than-temporarily impaired at December 31, 2013 and June 30, 2014. For more information, see the Other-than-temporary impairment discussion in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K.

The following table presents the amortized cost and fair value of available for sale debt securities by contractual maturity dates at June 30, 2014:

At June 30, 2014

Amortized
Cost
Fair Value Annualized
Average Yield
(dollars in millions)

U.S. government and agency securities:

U.S. Treasury securities:

After 1 year through 5 years

33,592 33,598 0.7 %

After 5 years through 10 years

1,135 1,146 2.2 %

Total

34,727 34,744

U.S. agency securities:

After 1 year through 5 years

498 499 1.4 %

After 5 years through 10 years

1,986 1,997 1.2 %

After 10 years

13,562 13,521 1.4 %

Total

16,046 16,017

Total U.S. government and agency securities

50,773 50,761 0.9 %

Corporate and other debt:

Commercial mortgage-backed securities:

Agency:

After 1 year through 5 years

746 743 0.9 %

After 5 years through 10 years

371 367 1.0 %

After 10 years

1,270 1,202 1.5 %

Total

2,387 2,312

Non-Agency:

After 10 years

1,472 1,478 1.6 %

Total

1,472 1,478

Auto loan asset-backed securities:

Due within 1 year

7 7 0.8 %

After 1 year through 5 years

1,974 1,975 0.8 %

After 5 years through 10 years

99 99 1.3 %

Total

2,080 2,081

Corporate bonds:

Due within 1 year

162 162 0.9 %

After 1 year through 5 years

2,858 2,856 1.3 %

After 5 years through 10 years

513 510 2.6 %

Total

3,533 3,528

Collateralized loan obligations:

After 10 years

1,087 1,072 1.4 %

Total

1,087 1,072

LOGO 40


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

At June 30, 2014

Amortized
Cost
Fair Value Annualized
Average Yield
(dollars in millions)

FFELP student loan asset-backed securities:

After 1 year through 5 years

121 121 0.7 %

After 5 years through 10 years

692 692 0.8 %

After 10 years

3,388 3,410 0.9 %

Total

4,201 4,223

Total corporate and other debt

14,760 14,694 1.2 %

Total available for sale debt securities

$ 65,533 $ 65,455 1.0 %

See Note 7 for additional information on securities issued by VIEs, including U.S. agency mortgage-backed securities, non-agency CMBS, auto loan asset-backed securities, CLO and FFELP student loan asset-backed securities.

The following table presents information pertaining to sales of AFS Securities during the quarters and six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013:

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Gross realized gains

$ 10 $ 35 $ 17 $ 41

Gross realized losses

$ $ 1 $ 1 $ 3

Gross realized gains and losses are recognized in Other revenues in the condensed consolidated statements of income.

6. Collateralized Transactions.

The Company enters into reverse repurchase agreements, repurchase agreements, securities borrowed and securities loaned transactions to, among other things, acquire securities to cover short positions and settle other securities obligations, to accommodate customers’ needs and to finance the Company’s inventory positions. The Company manages credit exposure arising from such transactions by, in appropriate circumstances, entering into master netting agreements and collateral agreements with counterparties that provide the Company, in the event of a counterparty default (such as bankruptcy or a counterparty’s failure to pay or perform), with the right to net a counterparty’s rights and obligations under such agreement and liquidate and set off collateral held by the Company against the net amount owed by the counterparty. The Company’s policy is generally to take possession of securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed, and to receive securities and cash posted as collateral (with rights of rehypothecation), although in certain cases, the Company may agree for such collateral to be posted to a third-party custodian under a tri-party arrangement that enables the Company to take control of such collateral in the event of a counterparty default. The Company also monitors the fair value of the underlying securities as compared with the related receivable or payable, including accrued interest, and, as necessary, requests additional collateral as provided under the applicable agreement to ensure such transactions are adequately collateralized.

41 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The following tables present information about the offsetting of these instruments and related collateral amounts. For information related to offsetting of derivatives, see Note 10.

At June 30, 2014
Gross
Amounts(1)
Amounts Offset
in the
Condensed
Consolidated
Statements of
Financial
Condition(2)
Net Amounts
Presented

in the
Condensed
Consolidated
Statements of
Financial
Condition
Financial
Instruments Not
Offset in the
Condensed
Consolidated
Statements of
Financial
Condition(3)
Net Exposure
(dollars in millions)

Assets

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

$ 161,761 $ (52,805 ) $ 108,956 $ (104,989 ) $ 3,967

Securities borrowed

154,219 (6,753 ) 147,466 (134,911 ) 12,555

Liabilities

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

$ 164,225 $ (52,805 ) $ 111,420 $ (85,821 ) $ 25,599

Securities loaned

37,561 (6,753 ) 30,808 (29,188 ) 1,620

(1) Amounts include $3.9 billion of Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell, $8.9 billion of Securities borrowed, $25.4 billion of Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and $0.3 billion of Securities loaned, which are either not subject to master netting agreements or collateral agreements or are subject to such agreements but the Company has not determined the agreements to be legally enforceable.
(2) Amounts relate to master netting agreements and collateral agreements, which have been determined by the Company to be legally enforceable in the event of default and where certain other criteria are met in accordance with applicable offsetting accounting guidance.
(3) Amounts relate to master netting agreements and collateral agreements, which have been determined by the Company to be legally enforceable in the event of default but where certain other criteria are not met in accordance with applicable offsetting accounting guidance.

At December 31, 2013
Gross
Amounts(1)
Amounts Offset
in the
Condensed
Consolidated
Statements of
Financial
Condition(2)
Net Amounts
Presented

in the
Condensed
Consolidated
Statements
of Financial
Condition
Financial
Instruments Not
Offset in the
Condensed
Consolidated
Statements of
Financial
Condition(3)
Net Exposure
(dollars in millions)

Assets

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell

$ 183,015 $ (64,885 ) $ 118,130 $ (106,828 ) $ 11,302

Securities borrowed

137,082 (7,375 ) 129,707 (113,339 ) 16,368

Liabilities

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase

$ 210,561 $ (64,885 ) $ 145,676 $ (111,599 ) $ 34,077

Securities loaned

40,174 (7,375 ) 32,799 (32,543 ) 256

(1) Amounts include $11.1 billion of Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell, $13.2 billion of Securities borrowed and $33.3 billion of Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, which are either not subject to master netting agreements or collateral agreements or are subject to such agreements but the Company has not determined the agreements to be legally enforceable.

LOGO 42


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(2) Amounts relate to master netting agreements and collateral agreements, which have been determined by the Company to be legally enforceable in the event of default and where certain other criteria are met in accordance with applicable offsetting accounting guidance.
(3) Amounts relate to master netting agreements and collateral agreements, which have been determined by the Company to be legally enforceable in the event of default but where certain other criteria are not met in accordance with applicable offsetting accounting guidance.

The Company also engages in margin lending to clients that allows the client to borrow against the value of qualifying securities and is included within Customer and other receivables in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition. Under these agreements and transactions, the Company either receives or provides collateral, including U.S. government and agency securities, other sovereign government obligations, corporate and other debt, and corporate equities. Customer receivables generated from margin lending activity are collateralized by customer-owned securities held by the Company. The Company monitors required margin levels and established credit limits daily and, pursuant to such guidelines, requires customers to deposit additional collateral, or reduce positions, when necessary. Margin loans are extended on a demand basis and are not committed facilities. Factors considered in the review of margin loans are the amount of the loan, the intended purpose, the degree of leverage being employed in the account, and overall evaluation of the portfolio to ensure proper diversification or, in the case of concentrated positions, appropriate liquidity of the underlying collateral or potential hedging strategies to reduce risk. Additionally, transactions relating to concentrated or restricted positions require a review of any legal impediments to liquidation of the underlying collateral. Underlying collateral for margin loans is reviewed with respect to the liquidity of the proposed collateral positions, valuation of securities, historic trading range, volatility analysis and an evaluation of industry concentrations. For these transactions, adherence to the Company’s collateral policies significantly limits the Company’s credit exposure in the event of customer default. The Company may request additional margin collateral from customers, if appropriate, and, if necessary, may sell securities that have not been paid for or purchase securities sold but not delivered from customers. At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, there were approximately $28.3 billion and $29.2 billion, respectively, of customer margin loans outstanding.

Other secured financings include the liabilities related to transfers of financial assets that are accounted for as financings rather than sales, consolidated VIEs where the Company is deemed to be the primary beneficiary, and certain equity-linked notes and other secured borrowings. These liabilities are generally payable from the cash flows of the related assets accounted for as Trading assets (see Notes 7 and 9).

The Company pledges its trading assets to collateralize repurchase agreements and other secured financings. Pledged financial instruments that can be sold or repledged by the secured party are identified as Trading assets (pledged to various parties) in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. The carrying value and classification of Trading assets by the Company that have been loaned or pledged to counterparties where those counterparties do not have the right to sell or repledge the collateral were as follows:

At
June 30,
2014
At
December 31,
2013
(dollars in millions)

Trading assets:

U.S. government and agency securities

$ 27,181 $ 21,589

Other sovereign government obligations

6,713 5,748

Corporate and other debt

7,564 7,388

Corporate equities

9,700 8,713

Total

$ 51,158 $ 43,438

43 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The Company receives collateral in the form of securities in connection with reverse repurchase agreements, securities borrowed and derivative transactions, customer margin loans and securities-based lending. In many cases, the Company is permitted to sell or repledge these securities held as collateral and use the securities to secure repurchase agreements, to enter into securities lending and derivative transactions or for delivery to counterparties to cover short positions. The Company additionally receives securities as collateral in connection with certain securities-for-securities transactions in which the Company is the lender. In instances where the Company is permitted to sell or repledge these securities, the Company reports the fair value of the collateral received and the related obligation to return the collateral in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the total fair value of financial instruments received as collateral where the Company is permitted to sell or repledge the securities was $558 billion and $533 billion, respectively, and the fair value of the portion that had been sold or repledged was $446 billion and $381 billion, respectively.

At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, cash and securities deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements were as follows:

At
June 30,
2014
At
December 31,
2013
(dollars in millions)

Cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements

$ 44,713 $ 39,203

Securities(1)

17,119 15,586

Total

$ 61,832 $ 54,789

(1) Securities deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements are sourced from Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell and Trading assets in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.

7. Variable Interest Entities and Securitization Activities.

The Company is involved with various special purpose entities (“SPE”) in the normal course of business. In most cases, these entities are deemed to be VIEs.

The Company applies accounting guidance for consolidation of VIEs to certain entities in which equity investors do not have the characteristics of a controlling financial interest. Except for certain asset management entities, the primary beneficiary of a VIE is the party that both (1) has the power to direct the activities of a VIE that most significantly affect the VIE’s economic performance and (2) has an obligation to absorb losses or the right to receive benefits that in either case could potentially be significant to the VIE. The Company consolidates entities of which it is the primary beneficiary.

The Company’s variable interests in VIEs include debt and equity interests, commitments, guarantees, derivative instruments and certain fees. The Company’s involvement with VIEs arises primarily from:

Interests purchased in connection with market-making activities, securities held in its AFS Securities portfolio and retained interests held as a result of securitization activities, including re-securitization transactions.

Guarantees issued and residual interests retained in connection with municipal bond securitizations.

Servicing of residential and commercial mortgage loans held by VIEs.

LOGO 44


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Loans made to and investments in VIEs that hold debt, equity, real estate or other assets.

Derivatives entered into with VIEs.

Structuring of credit-linked notes (“CLN”) or other asset-repackaged notes designed to meet the investment objectives of clients.

Other structured transactions designed to provide tax-efficient yields to the Company or its clients.

The Company determines whether it is the primary beneficiary of a VIE upon its initial involvement with the VIE and reassesses whether it is the primary beneficiary on an ongoing basis as long as it has any continuing involvement with the VIE. This determination is based upon an analysis of the design of the VIE, including the VIE’s structure and activities, the power to make significant economic decisions held by the Company and by other parties, and the variable interests owned by the Company and other parties.

The power to make the most significant economic decisions may take a number of different forms in different types of VIEs. The Company considers servicing or collateral management decisions as representing the power to make the most significant economic decisions in transactions such as securitizations or CDOs. As a result, the Company does not consolidate securitizations or CDOs for which it does not act as the servicer or collateral manager unless it holds certain other rights to replace the servicer or collateral manager or to require the liquidation of the entity. If the Company serves as servicer or collateral manager, or has certain other rights described in the previous sentence, the Company analyzes the interests in the VIE that it holds and consolidates only those VIEs for which it holds a potentially significant interest of the VIE.

The structure of securitization vehicles and CDOs is driven by several parties, including loan seller(s) in securitization transactions, the collateral manager in a CDO, one or more rating agencies, a financial guarantor in some transactions and the underwriter(s) of the transactions, who serve to reflect specific investor demand. In addition, subordinate investors, such as the “B-piece” buyer ( i.e., investors in most subordinated bond classes) in commercial mortgage-backed securitizations or equity investors in CDOs, can influence whether specific loans are excluded from a CMBS transaction or investment criteria in a CDO.

For many transactions, such as re-securitization transactions, CLNs and other asset-repackaged notes, there are no significant economic decisions made on an ongoing basis. In these cases, the Company focuses its analysis on decisions made prior to the initial closing of the transaction and at the termination of the transaction. Based upon factors, which include an analysis of the nature of the assets, including whether the assets were issued in a transaction sponsored by the Company and the extent of the information available to the Company and to investors, the number, nature and involvement of investors, other rights held by the Company and investors, the standardization of the legal documentation and the level of the continuing involvement by the Company, including the amount and type of interests owned by the Company and by other investors, the Company concluded in most of these transactions that decisions made prior to the initial closing were shared between the Company and the initial investors. The Company focused its control decision on any right held by the Company or investors related to the termination of the VIE. Most re-securitization transactions, CLNs and other asset-repackaged notes have no such termination rights.

Except for consolidated VIEs included in other structured financings and managed real estate partnerships in the tables below, the Company accounts for the assets held by the entities primarily in Trading assets and the liabilities of the entities as Other secured financings in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. For consolidated VIEs included in other structured financings, the Company accounts for the assets held by the entities primarily in Premises, equipment and software costs, and Other assets in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. For consolidated VIEs included in managed real estate

45 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

partnerships, the Company accounts for the assets held by the entities primarily in Trading assets in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. Except for consolidated VIEs included in other structured financings, the assets and liabilities are measured at fair value, with changes in fair value reflected in earnings.

The assets owned by many consolidated VIEs cannot be removed unilaterally by the Company and are not generally available to the Company. The related liabilities issued by many consolidated VIEs are non-recourse to the Company. In certain other consolidated VIEs, the Company has the unilateral right to remove assets or provides additional recourse through derivatives such as total return swaps, guarantees or other forms of involvement.

As part of the Company’s Institutional Securities business segment’s securitization and related activities, the Company has provided, or otherwise agreed to be responsible for, representations and warranties regarding certain assets transferred in securitization transactions sponsored by the Company (see Note 11).

The following tables present information at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 about VIEs that the Company consolidates. Consolidated VIE assets and liabilities are presented after intercompany eliminations and include assets financed on a non-recourse basis:

At June 30, 2014
Mortgage and
Asset-Backed
Securitizations
Managed
Real Estate
Partnerships(1)
Other
Structured
Financings
Other
(dollars in millions)

VIE assets

$ 611 $ 262 $ 971 $ 1,409

VIE liabilities

$ 355 $ 5 $ 81 $

(1) On April 1, 2014, the Company deconsolidated approximately $1.6 billion in total assets that were related to certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund sponsored by the Company.

At December 31, 2013
Mortgage and
Asset-Backed
Securitizations
Managed
Real Estate
Partnerships
Other
Structured
Financings
Other
(dollars in millions)

VIE assets

$ 643 $ 2,313 $ 1,202 $ 1,294

VIE liabilities

$ 368 $ 42 $ 67 $ 175

In general, the Company’s exposure to loss in consolidated VIEs is limited to losses that would be absorbed on the VIE’s assets recognized in its financial statements, net of losses absorbed by third-party holders of the VIE’s liabilities. At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, managed real estate partnerships reflected nonredeemable noncontrolling interests in the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements of $219 million and $1,771 million, respectively. The Company also had additional maximum exposure to losses of approximately $123 million and $101 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. This additional exposure related primarily to certain derivatives ( e.g. , instead of purchasing senior securities, the Company has sold credit protection to synthetic CDOs through credit derivatives that are typically related to the most senior tranche of the CDO) and commitments, guarantees and other forms of involvement.

The following tables present information about certain non-consolidated VIEs in which the Company had variable interests at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013. The tables include all VIEs in which the Company has determined that its maximum exposure to loss is greater than specific thresholds or meets certain other

LOGO 46


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

criteria. Most of the VIEs included in the tables below are sponsored by unrelated parties; the Company’s involvement generally is the result of the Company’s secondary market-making activities and securities held in its AFS Securities portfolio (see Note 5):

At June 30, 2014
Mortgage and
Asset-Backed
Securitizations
Collateralized
Debt
Obligations
Municipal
Tender
Option
Bonds
Other
Structured
Financings
Other
(dollars in millions)

VIE assets that the Company does not consolidate (unpaid principal balance)(1)

$ 187,500 $ 26,151 $ 3,091 $ 1,996 $ 17,250

Maximum exposure to loss:

Debt and equity interests(2)

$ 15,558 $ 2,890 $ 11 $ 1,125 $ 5,013

Derivative and other contracts

13 2 1,990 163

Commitments, guarantees and other

1,046 1,327 637 471

Total maximum exposure to loss

$ 16,617 $ 4,219 $ 2,001 $ 1,762 $ 5,647

Carrying value of exposure to loss—Assets:

Debt and equity interests(2)

$ 15,558 $ 2,890 $ 11 $ 713 $ 5,013

Derivative and other contracts

13 2 4 61

Total carrying value of exposure to loss—Assets

$ 15,571 $ 2,892 $ 15 $ 713 $ 5,074

Carrying value of exposure to loss—Liabilities:

Derivative and other contracts

$ $ $ $ $ 63

Commitments, guarantees and other

6

Total carrying value of exposure to loss—Liabilities

$ $ $ $ 6 $ 63

(1) Mortgage and asset-backed securitizations include VIE assets as follows: $28.9 billion of residential mortgages; $75.9 billion of commercial mortgages; $29.7 billion of U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligations; and $53.0 billion of other consumer or commercial loans.
(2) Mortgage and asset-backed securitizations include VIE debt and equity interests as follows: $1.4 billion of residential mortgages; $2.2 billion of commercial mortgages; $5.1 billion of U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligations; and $6.8 billion of other consumer or commercial loans.

47 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

At December 31, 2013
Mortgage and
Asset-Backed
Securitizations
Collateralized
Debt
Obligations
Municipal
Tender
Option
Bonds
Other
Structured
Financings
Other
(dollars in millions)

VIE assets that the Company does not consolidate
(unpaid principal balance)(1)

$ 177,153 $ 29,513 $ 3,079 $ 1,874 $ 10,119

Maximum exposure to loss:

Debt and equity interests(2)

$ 13,514 $ 2,498 $ 31 $ 1,142 $ 3,693

Derivative and other contracts

15 23 1,935 146

Commitments, guarantees and other

272 649 527

Total maximum exposure to loss

$ 13,529 $ 2,793 $ 1,966 $ 1,791 $ 4,366

Carrying value of exposure to loss—Assets:

Debt and equity interests(2)

$ 13,514 $ 2,498 $ 31 $ 731 $ 3,693

Derivative and other contracts

15 3 4 53

Total carrying value of exposure to loss—Assets

$ 13,529 $ 2,501 $ 35 $ 731 $ 3,746

Carrying value of exposure to loss—Liabilities:

Derivative and other contracts

$ $ 2 $ $ $ 57

Commitments, guarantees and other

7

Total carrying value of exposure to loss—Liabilities

$ $ 2 $ $ 7 $ 57

(1) Mortgage and asset-backed securitizations include VIE assets as follows: $16.9 billion of residential mortgages; $78.4 billion of commercial mortgages; $31.5 billion of U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligations; and $50.4 billion of other consumer or commercial loans.
(2) Mortgage and asset-backed securitizations include VIE debt and equity interests as follows: $1.3 billion of residential mortgages; $2.0 billion of commercial mortgages; $5.3 billion of U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligations; and $4.9 billion of other consumer or commercial loans.

The Company’s maximum exposure to loss often differs from the carrying value of the variable interests held by the Company. The maximum exposure to loss is dependent on the nature of the Company’s variable interest in the VIEs and is limited to the notional amounts of certain liquidity facilities, other credit support, total return swaps, written put options, and the fair value of certain other derivatives and investments the Company has made in the VIEs. Liabilities issued by VIEs generally are non-recourse to the Company. Where notional amounts are utilized in quantifying maximum exposure related to derivatives, such amounts do not reflect fair value writedowns already recorded by the Company.

The Company’s maximum exposure to loss does not include the offsetting benefit of any financial instruments that the Company may utilize to hedge these risks associated with the Company’s variable interests. In addition, the Company’s maximum exposure to loss is not reduced by the amount of collateral held as part of a transaction with the VIE or any party to the VIE directly against a specific exposure to loss.

Securitization transactions generally involve VIEs. Primarily as a result of its secondary market-making activities, the Company owned additional securities issued by securitization SPEs for which the maximum exposure to loss is less than specific thresholds. These additional securities totaled $12.8 billion at June 30, 2014. These securities were either retained in connection with transfers of assets by the Company, acquired in connection with secondary market-making activities or held in the Company’s AFS Securities portfolio (see Note

LOGO 48


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

5). Securities issued by securitization SPEs consisted of $1.0 billion of securities backed primarily by residential mortgage loans, $8.3 billion of securities backed by U.S. agency collateralized mortgage obligations, $1.1 billion of securities backed by commercial mortgage loans, $0.5 billion of securities backed by CDOs or CLOs and $1.9 billion backed by other consumer loans, such as credit card receivables, automobile loans and student loans. The Company’s primary risk exposure is to the securities issued by the SPE owned by the Company, with the risk highest on the most subordinate class of beneficial interests. These securities generally are included in Trading assets—Corporate and other debt or AFS Securities and are measured at fair value (see Note 4). The Company does not provide additional support in these transactions through contractual facilities, such as liquidity facilities, guarantees or similar derivatives. The Company’s maximum exposure to loss generally equals the fair value of the securities owned.

The Company’s transactions with VIEs primarily include securitizations, municipal tender option bond trusts, credit protection purchased through CLNs, other structured financings, collateralized loan and debt obligations, equity-linked notes, managed real estate partnerships and asset management investment funds. The Company’s continuing involvement in VIEs that it does not consolidate can include ownership of retained interests in Company-sponsored transactions, interests purchased in the secondary market (both for Company-sponsored transactions and transactions sponsored by third parties), derivatives with securitization SPEs (primarily interest rate derivatives in commercial mortgage and residential mortgage securitizations and credit derivatives in which the Company has purchased protection in synthetic CDOs), and as servicer in residential mortgage securitizations in the U.S. and Europe and commercial mortgage securitizations in Europe. Such activities are further described in Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K.

Transfers of Assets with Continuing Involvement.

The following tables present information at June 30, 2014 regarding transactions with SPEs in which the Company, acting as principal, transferred financial assets with continuing involvement and received sales treatment:

At June 30, 2014
Residential
Mortgage
Loans
Commercial
Mortgage
Loans
U.S. Agency
Collateralized
Mortgage
Obligations
Credit-
Linked
Notes  and

Other
(dollars in millions)

SPE assets (unpaid principal balance)(1)

$ 26,895 $ 50,484 $ 18,772 $ 10,765

Retained interests (fair value):

Investment grade

$ 1 $ 26 $ 723 $

Non-investment grade

75 38 1,146

Total retained interests (fair value)

$ 76 $ 64 $ 723 $ 1,146

Interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value):

Investment grade

$ 11 $ 41 $ 66 $ 350

Non-investment grade

55 28 62

Total interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value)

$ 66 $ 69 $ 66 $ 412

Derivative assets (fair value)

$ 1 $ 621 $ $ 169

Derivative liabilities (fair value)

$ $ $ $ 185

(1) Amounts include assets transferred by unrelated transferors.

49 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

At June 30, 2014
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Total
(dollars in millions)

Retained interests (fair value):

Investment grade

$ $ 750 $ $ 750

Non-investment grade

87 1,172 1,259

Total retained interests (fair value)

$ $ 837 $ 1,172 $ 2,009

Interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value):

Investment grade

$ $ 466 $ 2 $ 468

Non-investment grade

109 36 145

Total interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value)

$ $ 575 $ 38 $ 613

Derivative assets (fair value)

$ $ 649 $ 142 $ 791

Derivative liabilities (fair value)

$ $ 179 $ 6 $ 185

The following tables present information at December 31, 2013 regarding transactions with SPEs in which the Company, acting as principal, transferred assets with continuing involvement and received sales treatment:

At December 31, 2013
Residential
Mortgage
Loans
Commercial
Mortgage
Loans
U.S. Agency
Collateralized
Mortgage
Obligations
Credit-
Linked
Notes
and Other
(dollars in millions)

SPE assets (unpaid principal balance)(1)

$ 29,723 $ 60,698 $ 19,155 $ 11,736

Retained interests (fair value):

Investment grade

$ 1 $ 102 $ 524 $

Non-investment grade

136 95 1,319

Total retained interests (fair value)

$ 137 $ 197 $ 524 $ 1,319

Interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value):

Investment grade

$ 14 $ 170 $ 21 $ 350

Non-investment grade

41 97 68

Total interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value)

$ 55 $ 267 $ 21 $ 418

Derivative assets (fair value)

$ 1 $ 672 $ $ 121

Derivative liabilities (fair value)

$ $ 1 $ $ 120

(1) Amounts include assets transferred by unrelated transferors.

At December 31, 2013
Level 1 Level 2 Level 3 Total
(dollars in millions)

Retained interests (fair value):

Investment grade

$ $ 626 $ 1 $ 627

Non-investment grade

164 1,386 1,550

Total retained interests (fair value)

$ $ 790 $ 1,387 $ 2,177

Interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value):

Investment grade

$ $ 547 $ 8 $ 555

Non-investment grade

182 24 206

Total interests purchased in the secondary market (fair value)

$ $ 729 $ 32 $ 761

Derivative assets (fair value)

$ $ 615 $ 179 $ 794

Derivative liabilities (fair value)

$ $ 110 $ 11 $ 121

LOGO 50


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Transferred assets are carried at fair value prior to securitization, and any changes in fair value are recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of income. The Company may act as underwriter of the beneficial interests issued by securitization vehicles. Investment banking underwriting net revenues are recognized in connection with these transactions. The Company may retain interests in the securitized financial assets as one or more tranches of the securitization. These retained interests are included in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value. Any changes in the fair value of such retained interests are recognized in the condensed consolidated statements of income.

In addition, in connection with its underwriting of CLO transactions for unaffiliated sponsors, in the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company sold to those SPEs, corporate loans with an unpaid principal balance of $1.1 billion and $1.6 billion, respectively.

Net gains on sale of assets in securitization transactions at the time of the sale were not material in the quarters and six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013.

During the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company received proceeds from new securitization transactions of $9.6 billion and $13.0 billion, respectively. During the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company received proceeds from cash flows from retained interests in securitization transactions of $1.5 billion and $2.2 billion, respectively.

The Company has provided, or otherwise agreed to be responsible for, representations and warranties regarding certain assets transferred in securitization transactions sponsored by the Company (see Note 11).

Failed Sales.

In order to be treated as a sale of assets for accounting purposes, a transaction must meet all of the criteria stipulated in the accounting guidance for the transfer of financial assets. If the transfer fails to meet these criteria, that transfer of financial assets is treated as a failed sale. In such cases, the Company continues to recognize the assets in Trading assets, and the Company recognizes the associated liabilities in Other secured financings in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition (see Note 9).

The assets transferred in many transactions accounted for as failed sales cannot be removed unilaterally by the Company and are not generally available to the Company. The related liabilities are non-recourse to the Company. In certain other failed sale transactions, the Company has the right to remove assets or provide additional recourse through derivatives such as total return swaps, guarantees or other forms of involvement.

The following table presents information about the carrying value (equal to fair value) of assets and liabilities resulting from transfers of financial assets treated by the Company as secured financings:

At June 30, 2014 At December 31, 2013
Carrying Value of Carrying Value of
Assets Liabilities Assets Liabilities
(dollars in millions)

Credit-linked notes

$ 47 $ 37 $ 48 $ 41

Equity-linked transactions

33 28 40 35

Other

269 269 157 156

Mortgage Servicing Activities.

The Company services residential mortgage loans in the U.S. owned by SPEs sponsored by the Company. The Company generally holds retained interests in Company-sponsored SPEs. As of the quarter ended March 31, 2014, the Company no longer services residential and commercial mortgage loans in Europe.

51 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The Company provides no credit support as part of its servicing activities. The Company is required to make servicing advances to the extent that it believes that such advances will be reimbursed. Reimbursement of servicing advances is a senior obligation of the SPE, senior to the most senior beneficial interests outstanding. Outstanding advances are included in Other assets and are recorded at cost, net of allowances. There were no allowances at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013. Advances at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 totaled approximately $11 million and $110 million, respectively.

The following tables present information about the Company’s mortgage servicing activities for SPEs to which the Company transferred loans at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013:

At June 30, 2014
Residential
Mortgage
Unconsolidated
SPEs
Residential
Mortgage
Consolidated
SPEs
Commercial
Mortgage
Unconsolidated
SPEs
(dollars in millions)

Assets serviced (unpaid principal balance)

$ $ 488 $

Amounts past due 90 days or greater
(unpaid principal balance)(1)

$ $ 28 $

Percentage of amounts past due 90 days or greater(1)

5.6 %

Credit losses

$ $ 1 $

(1) Amounts include loans that are at least 90 days contractually delinquent, loans for which the borrower has filed for bankruptcy, loans in foreclosure and real estate owned.

At December 31, 2013
Residential
Mortgage
Unconsolidated
SPEs
Residential
Mortgage
Consolidated
SPEs
Commercial
Mortgage
Unconsolidated
SPEs
(dollars in millions)

Assets serviced (unpaid principal balance)

$ 785 $ 775 $ 4,114

Amounts past due 90 days or greater
(unpaid principal balance)(1)

$ 66 $ 44 $

Percentage of amounts past due 90 days or greater(1)

8.5 % 5.6 %

Credit losses

$ 1 $ 17 $

(1) Amounts include loans that are at least 90 days contractually delinquent, loans for which the borrower has filed for bankruptcy, loans in foreclosure and real estate owned.

8. Financing Receivables and Allowance for Credit Losses.

Loans.

The Company’s loans held for investment are recorded at amortized cost, and its loans held for sale are recorded at lower of cost or fair value in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.

LOGO 52


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The Company’s outstanding loans at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 included the following:

June 30, 2014 December 31, 2013

Loans by Product Type

Loans Held
For
Investment
Loans Held
For Sale
Total Loans Loans Held
For
Investment
Loans Held
For Sale
Total Loans
(dollars in millions)

Corporate loans

$ 18,777 $ 5,491 $ 24,268 $ 13,263 $ 6,168 $ 19,431

Consumer loans

14,306 14,306 11,577 11,577

Residential real estate loans

12,624 93 12,717 10,006 112 10,118

Wholesale real estate loans

3,061 1,046 4,107 1,855 49 1,904

Total loans, gross of allowance for loan losses

48,768 6,630 55,398 36,701 6,329 43,030

Allowance for loan losses

(138 ) (138 ) (156 ) (156 )

Total loans, net of allowance for loan losses(1)(2)

$ 48,630 $ 6,630 $ 55,260 $ 36,545 $ 6,329 $ 42,874

(1) Amounts include loans that are made to non-U.S. borrowers of $7,053 million and $4,729 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.
(2) See Note 11 for further information related to unfunded lending commitments.

The above table does not include loans and lending commitments held at fair value that were recorded as Trading assets of $13,727 million and $12,612 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. At June 30, 2014, loans and lending commitments held at fair value that were recorded as Trading assets consisted of $9,588 million of Corporate loans, $1,873 million of Residential real estate loans and $2,266 million of Wholesale real estate loans. At December 31, 2013, loans and lending commitments held at fair value that were recorded as Trading assets consisted of $9,774 million of Corporate loans, $1,434 million of Residential real estate loans and $1,404 million of Wholesale real estate loans. See Note 4 for further information regarding loans and lending commitments held at fair value that are recorded as Trading assets in the Company’s condensed consolidated statement of financial condition.

Credit Quality.

The Company’s Credit Risk Management department evaluates new obligors before credit transactions are initially approved, and at least annually thereafter for corporate and wholesale real estate loans. For corporate loans, credit evaluations typically involve the evaluation of financial statements, assessment of leverage, liquidity, capital strength, asset composition and quality, market capitalization and access to capital markets, cash flow projections and debt service requirements, and the adequacy of collateral, if applicable. Credit Risk Management will also evaluate strategy, market position, industry dynamics, obligor’s management and other factors that could affect the obligor’s risk profile. For wholesale real estate loans, the credit evaluation is focused on property and transaction metrics including property type, loan-to-value ratio, occupancy levels, debt service ratio, prevailing capitalization rates, and market dynamics. For residential real estate and consumer loans, the initial credit evaluation typically includes, but is not limited to, review of the obligor’s income, net worth, liquidity, collateral, loan-to-value ratio, and credit bureau information. Subsequent credit monitoring for residential real estate loans is performed at the portfolio level. Consumer loan collateral values are monitored on an ongoing basis.

For a description of the Company’s loan portfolio and credit quality indicators utilized in its credit monitoring process, see Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K.

53 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The following tables present credit quality indicators for the Company’s loans held for investment, gross of allowance for loan losses, by product type, at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

June 30, 2014

Loans by Credit Quality Indicators

Corporate Consumer Residential
Real  Estate
Wholesale
Real  Estate
Total
(dollars in millions)

Pass

$ 18,589 $ 14,306 $ 12,602 $ 3,061 $ 48,558

Special Mention

99 99

Substandard

82 22 104

Doubtful

7 7

Loss

Total loans

$ 18,777 $ 14,306 $ 12,624 $ 3,061 $ 48,768

December 31, 2013

Loans by Credit Quality Indicators

Corporate Consumer Residential
Real  Estate
Wholesale
Real  Estate
Total
(dollars in millions)

Pass

$ 12,893 $ 11,577 $ 9,992 $ 1,829 $ 36,291

Special Mention

189 16 205

Substandard

174 14 188

Doubtful

7 10 17

Loss

Total loans

$ 13,263 $ 11,577 $ 10,006 $ 1,855 $ 36,701

Allowance for Loan Losses and Impaired Loans.

The allowance for loan losses estimates probable losses related to loans specifically identified for impairment in addition to the probable losses inherent in the held for investment loan portfolio.

There are two components of the allowance for loan losses: the inherent allowance component and the specific allowance component.

The inherent allowance component of the allowance for loan losses is used to estimate the probable losses inherent in the loan portfolio and includes non-homogeneous loans that have not been identified as impaired and portfolios of smaller balance homogeneous loans. The Company maintains methodologies by loan product for calculating an allowance for loan losses that estimates the inherent losses in the loan portfolio. Qualitative and environmental factors such as economic and business conditions, nature and volume of the portfolio and lending terms, and volume and severity of past due loans may also be considered in the calculations. The allowance for loan losses is maintained at a level reasonable to ensure that it can adequately absorb the estimated probable losses inherent in the portfolio.

The specific allowance component of the allowance for loan losses is used to estimate probable losses for non-homogeneous exposures, including loans modified in a Troubled Debt Restructuring (“TDR”), which have been specifically identified for impairment analysis by the Company and determined to be impaired. As of June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Company’s TDRs were not significant. For further information on allowance for loan losses, see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K.

LOGO 54


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The tables below provide details on impaired loans, past due loans and allowances for the Company’s held for investment loans:

June 30, 2014

Loans by Product Type

Corporate Consumer Residential
Real  Estate
Wholesale
Real  Estate
Total
(dollars in millions)

Impaired loans with allowance

$ 5 $ $ $ $ 5

Impaired loans without allowance(1)

6 10 16

Impaired loans unpaid principal balance

11 10 21

Past due 90 days loans and on nonaccrual

7 12 19

December 31, 2013

Loans by Product Type

Corporate Consumer Residential
Real  Estate
Wholesale
Real  Estate
Total
(dollars in millions)

Impaired loans with allowance

$ 63 $ $ $ 10 $ 73

Impaired loans without allowance(1)

6 11 17

Impaired loans unpaid principal balance

69 11 10 90

Past due 90 days loans and on nonaccrual

7 11 10 28

June 30, 2014

Loans by Region

Americas EMEA Asia-Pacific Total
(dollars in millions)

Impaired loans

$ 21 $ $ $ 21

Past due 90 days loans and on nonaccrual

19 19

Allowance for loan losses

107 25 6 138

December 31, 2013

Loans by Region

Americas EMEA Asia-Pacific Total
(dollars in millions)

Impaired loans

$ 90 $ $ $ 90

Past due 90 days loans and on nonaccrual

28 28

Allowance for loan losses

123 28 5 156

EMEA—Europe, Middle East and Africa.

(1) At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, no allowance was outstanding for these loans as the fair value of the collateral held exceeded or equaled the carrying value.

55 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The table below summarizes information about the allowance for loan losses, loans by impairment methodology, the allowance for lending-related commitments and lending-related commitments by impairment methodology.

Corporate Consumer Residential
Real Estate
Wholesale
Real Estate
Total
(dollars in millions)

Allowance for loan losses:

Balance at December 31, 2013

$ 137 $ 1 $ 4 $ 14 $ 156

Gross charge-offs

(3 ) (3 )

Gross recoveries

Net charge-offs

(3 ) (3 )

Provision (release) for loan losses(1)

(20 ) 1 2 2 (15 )

Balance at June 30, 2014

$ 117 $ 2 $ 6 $ 13 $ 138

Allowance for loan losses by impairment methodology:

Inherent

$ 115 $ 2 $ 6 $ 13 $ 136

Specific

2 2

Total allowance for loan losses at June 30, 2014

$ 117 $ 2 $ 6 $ 13 $ 138

Loans evaluated by impairment methodology(2):

Inherent

$ 18,766 $ 14,306 $ 12,614 $ 3,061 $ 48,747

Specific

11 10 21

Total loans evaluated at June 30, 2014

$ 18,777 $ 14,306 $ 12,624 $ 3,061 $ 48,768

Allowance for lending-related commitments:

Balance at December 31, 2013

$ 125 $ $ $ 2 $ 127

Provision for lending-related commitments(3)

30 30

Balance at June 30, 2014

$ 155 $ $ $ 2 $ 157

Allowance for lending-related commitments by impairment methodology:

Inherent

$ 155 $ $ $ 2 $ 157

Specific

Total allowance for lending-related commitments at June 30, 2014

$ 155 $ $ $ 2 $ 157

Lending-related commitments evaluated by impairment methodology(2):

Inherent

$ 69,331 $ 3,274 $ 249 $ 252 $ 73,106

Specific

Total lending-related commitments evaluated at June 30, 2014

$ 69,331 $ 3,274 $ 249 $ 252 $ 73,106

(1) The Company recorded $14 million of provision for loan losses within Other revenues for the quarter ended June 30, 2014.
(2) Balances are gross of the allowance.
(3) The Company recorded $11 million of provision for lending-related commitments within Other non-interest expenses for the quarter ended June 30, 2014.

LOGO 56


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Corporate Consumer Residential
Real Estate
Wholesale
Real Estate
Total
(dollars in millions)

Allowance for loan losses:

Balance at December 31, 2012

$ 96 $ 3 $ 5 $ 2 $ 106

Gross charge-offs

(12 ) (1 ) (2 ) (15 )

Gross recoveries

Net charge-offs

(12 ) (1 ) (2 ) (15 )

Provision (release) for loan losses(1)

31 (2 ) 5 34

Balance at June 30, 2013

$ 115 $ 1 $ 4 $ 5 $ 125

Allowance for loan losses by impairment methodology:

Inherent

$ 113 $ 1 $ 4 $ 4 $ 122

Specific

2 1 3

Total allowance for loan losses at June 30, 2013

$ 115 $ 1 $ 4 $ 5 $ 125

Loans evaluated by impairment methodology(2):

Inherent

$ 11,154 $ 9,452 $ 7,594 $ 853 $ 29,053

Specific

16 8 10 34

Total loan evaluated at June 30, 2013

$ 11,170 $ 9,452 $ 7,602 $ 863 $ 29,087

Allowance for lending-related commitments:

Balance at December 31, 2012

$ 90 $ $ $ 1 $ 91

Provision for lending-related commitments(3)

29 29

Other

(10 ) (10 )

Balance at June 30, 2013

$ 109 $ $ $ 1 $ 110

Allowance for lending-related commitments by impairment methodology:

Inherent

$ 109 $ $ $ 1 $ 110

Specific

Total allowance for lending-related commitments at June 30, 2013

$ 109 $ $ $ 1 $ 110

Lending-related commitments evaluated by impairment methodology(2):

Inherent

$ 52,245 $ 1,657 $ 2,093 $ 258 $ 56,253

Specific

Total lending-related commitments evaluated at June 30, 2013

$ 52,245 $ 1,657 $ 2,093 $ 258 $ 56,253

(1) The Company recorded $7 million of provision for loan losses within Other revenues for the quarter ended June 30, 2013.
(2) Balances are gross of the allowance.
(3) The Company recorded $17 million of provision for lending-related commitments within Other non-interest expenses for the quarter ended June 30, 2013.

57 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Employee Loans.

Employee loans are granted primarily in conjunction with a program established in the Wealth Management business segment to retain and recruit certain employees. These loans are recorded in Customer and other receivables in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. These loans are full recourse, generally require periodic payments and have repayment terms ranging from one to 12 years. The Company establishes a reserve for loan amounts it does not consider recoverable, which is recorded in Compensation and benefits expense. At June 30, 2014, the Company had $5,116 million of employee loans, net of an allowance of approximately $128 million. At December 31, 2013, the Company had $5,487 million of employee loans, net of an allowance of approximately $109 million.

The Company has also granted loans to other employees primarily in conjunction with certain after-tax leveraged investment arrangements. At June 30, 2014, the balance of these loans was $54 million, net of an allowance of approximately $46 million. At December 31, 2013, the balance of these loans was $100 million, net of an allowance of approximately $51 million. The Company establishes a reserve for non-recourse loan amounts not recoverable from employees, which is recorded in Other expense.

Collateralized Transactions.

In certain instances, the Company enters into reverse repurchase agreements and securities borrowed transactions to acquire securities to cover short positions, to settle other securities obligations and to accommodate clients’ needs. The Company also engages in margin lending to broker-dealer clients that allows the client to borrow against the value of the qualifying securities and is included within Customer and other receivables in the condensed consolidated statement of financial condition (see Note 6).

Servicing Advances.

As part of its servicing activities, the Company may make servicing advances to the extent that it believes that such advances will be reimbursed (see Note 7).

9. Long-Term Borrowings and Other Secured Financings.

The Company’s long-term borrowings included the following components:

At June 30,
2014
At December 31,
2013
(dollars in millions)

Senior debt

$ 138,760 $ 139,451

Subordinated debt

5,847 9,275

Junior subordinated debentures

4,876 4,849

Total

$ 149,483 $ 153,575

During the six months ended June 30, 2014, the Company issued and reissued notes with a principal amount of approximately $14.8 billion. This amount included the Company’s issuances of $1.5 billion in senior debt on May 22, 2014, $3.0 billion in senior debt on April 28, 2014, $2.1 billion in senior debt on March 31, 2014 and $2.8 billion in senior debt on January 24, 2014. During the six months ended June 30, 2014, approximately $21.3 billion in aggregate long-term borrowings matured or were retired.

LOGO 58


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The weighted average maturity of the Company’s long-term borrowings, based upon stated maturity dates, was approximately 5.6 years and 5.4 years at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.

Other Secured Financings.

Other secured financings include the liabilities related to transfers of financial assets that are accounted for as financings rather than sales, consolidated VIEs where the Company is deemed to be the primary beneficiary, pledged commodities, certain equity-linked notes and other secured borrowings. See Note 7 for further information on other secured financings related to VIEs and securitization activities.

The Company’s other secured financings consisted of the following:

At June 30,
2014
At December 31,
2013
(dollars in millions)

Secured financings with original maturities greater than one year

$ 10,153 $ 9,750

Secured financings with original maturities one year or less

3,520 4,233

Failed sales(1)

334 232

Total(2)

$ 14,007 $ 14,215

(1) For more information on failed sales, see Note 7.
(2) Amounts include $5,056 million and $5,206 million at fair value at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively.

10. Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities.

The Company trades, makes markets and takes proprietary positions globally in listed futures, OTC swaps, forwards, options and other derivatives referencing, among other things, interest rates, currencies, investment grade and non-investment grade corporate credits, loans, bonds, U.S. and other sovereign securities, emerging market bonds and loans, credit indices, asset-backed security indices, property indices, mortgage-related and other asset-backed securities, and real estate loan products. The Company uses these instruments for trading, foreign currency exposure management, and asset and liability management.

The Company manages its trading positions by employing a variety of risk mitigation strategies. These strategies include diversification of risk exposures and hedging. Hedging activities consist of the purchase or sale of positions in related securities and financial instruments, including a variety of derivative products ( e.g. , futures, forwards, swaps and options). The Company manages the market risk associated with its trading activities on a Company-wide basis, on a worldwide trading division level and on an individual product basis.

In connection with its derivative activities, the Company generally enters into master netting agreements and collateral agreements with its counterparties. These agreements provide the Company with the right, in the event of a default by the counterparty (such as bankruptcy or a failure to pay or perform), to net a counterparty’s rights and obligations under the agreement and to liquidate and set off collateral against any net amount owed by the counterparty. However, in certain circumstances: the Company may not have such an agreement in place; the relevant insolvency regime (which is based on the type of counterparty entity and the jurisdiction of organization of the counterparty) may not support the enforceability of the agreement; or the Company may not have sought legal advice to support the enforceability of the agreement. In cases where the Company has not determined an agreement to be enforceable, the related amounts are not offset in the tabular disclosures below. The Company’s policy is generally to receive securities and cash posted as collateral (with rights of rehypothecation), irrespective of the enforceability determination regarding the master netting and collateral agreement. In certain cases, the

59 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Company may agree for such collateral to be posted to a third-party custodian under a control agreement that enables the Company to take control of such collateral in the event of a counterparty default. The enforceability of the master netting agreement is taken into account in the Company’s risk management practices and application of counterparty credit limits. The following tables present information about the offsetting of derivative instruments and related collateral amounts. See information related to offsetting of certain collateralized transactions in Note 6.

At June 30, 2014
Gross
Amounts(1)
Amounts Offset
in the Condensed
Consolidated
Statements of
Financial
Condition(2)
Net Amounts
Presented in the
Condensed
Consolidated
Statements of
Financial
Condition
Amounts Not Offset in the
Condensed Consolidated
Statements of Financial
Condition(3)
Net
Exposure
Financial
Instruments
Collateral
Other
Cash
Collateral
(dollars in millions)

Derivative assets

Bilateral OTC

$ 375,992 $ (350,827 ) $ 25,165 $ (6,872 ) $ (61 ) $ 18,232

Cleared OTC(4)

193,045 (190,651 ) 2,394 (9 ) 2,385

Exchange traded

33,736 (29,329 ) 4,407 4,407

Total derivative assets

$ 602,773 $ (570,807 ) $ 31,966 $ (6,881 ) $ (61 ) $ 25,024

Derivative liabilities

Bilateral OTC

$ 360,015 $ (333,307 ) $ 26,708 $ (6,629 ) $ (81 ) $ 19,998

Cleared OTC(4)

190,452 (188,449 ) 2,003 (7 ) 1,996

Exchange traded

36,042 (29,329 ) 6,713 (680 ) 6,033

Total derivative liabilities

$ 586,509 $ (551,085 ) $ 35,424 $ (7,309 ) $ (88 ) $ 28,027

(1) Amounts include $6.5 billion of derivative assets and $6.6 billion of derivative liabilities, which are either not subject to master netting agreements or collateral agreements or are subject to such agreements but the Company has not determined the agreements to be legally enforceable. See also “Fair Value and Notional of Derivative Instruments” for additional disclosure about gross fair values and notionals for derivative instruments by risk type.
(2) Amounts relate to master netting agreements and collateral agreements, which have been determined by the Company to be legally enforceable in the event of default and where certain other criteria are met in accordance with applicable offsetting accounting guidance.
(3) Amounts relate to master netting agreements and collateral agreements, which have been determined by the Company to be legally enforceable in the event of default but where certain other criteria are not met in accordance with applicable offsetting accounting guidance.
(4) Amounts include OTC derivatives that are centrally cleared in accordance with certain regulatory requirements.

LOGO 60


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

At December 31, 2013
Gross
Amounts(1)
Amounts Offset
in the Condensed
Consolidated
Statements of
Financial
Condition(2)
Net Amounts
Presented in the
Condensed
Consolidated
Statements of
Financial
Condition
Amounts Not Offset in the
Condensed Consolidated
Statements of Financial
Condition(3)
Net
Exposure
Financial
Instruments
Collateral
Other
Cash
Collateral
(dollars in millions)

Derivative assets

Bilateral OTC

$ 404,352 $ (378,459 ) $ 25,893 $ (8,785 ) $ (132 ) $ 16,976

Cleared OTC(4)

267,057 (266,419 ) 638 638

Exchange traded

31,609 (25,673 ) 5,936 5,936

Total derivative assets

$ 703,018 $ (670,551 ) $ 32,467 $ (8,785 ) $ (132 ) $ 23,550

Derivative liabilities

Bilateral OTC

$ 386,199 $ (361,059 ) $ 25,140 $ (5,365 ) $ (136 ) $ 19,639

Cleared OTC(4)

266,559 (265,378 ) 1,181 (372 ) 809

Exchange traded

33,113 (25,673 ) 7,440 (651 ) 6,789

Total derivative liabilities

$ 685,871 $ (652,110 ) $ 33,761 $ (6,016 ) $ (508 ) $ 27,237

(1) Amounts include $8.7 billion of derivative assets and $7.3 billion of derivative liabilities, which are either not subject to master netting agreements or collateral agreements or are subject to such agreements but the Company has not determined the agreements to be legally enforceable. See also “Fair Value and Notional of Derivative Instruments” for additional disclosure about gross fair values and notionals for derivative instruments by risk type.
(2) Amounts relate to master netting agreements and collateral agreements, which have been determined by the Company to be legally enforceable in the event of default and where certain other criteria are met in accordance with applicable offsetting accounting guidance.
(3) Amounts relate to master netting agreements and collateral agreements, which have been determined by the Company to be legally enforceable in the event of default but where certain other criteria are not met in accordance with applicable offsetting accounting guidance.
(4) Amounts include OTC derivatives that are centrally cleared in accordance with certain regulatory requirements.

The Company incurs credit risk as a dealer in OTC derivatives. Credit risk with respect to derivative instruments arises from the failure of a counterparty to perform according to the terms of the contract. The Company’s exposure to credit risk at any point in time is represented by the fair value of the derivative contracts reported as assets. The fair value of a derivative represents the amount at which the derivative could be exchanged in an orderly transaction between market participants and is further described in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K and Note 4.

61 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The tables below present a summary by counterparty credit rating and remaining contract maturity of the fair value of OTC derivatives in a gain position at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. Fair value is presented in the final column, net of collateral received (principally cash and U.S. government and agency securities):

OTC Derivative Products—Trading Assets at June 30, 2014(1)

Years to Maturity Cross-Maturity
and
Cash Collateral

Netting(3)
Net  Exposure
Post-Cash
Collateral
Net Exposure
Post-Collateral

Credit Rating(2)

Less
than 1
1-3 3-5 Over 5
(dollars in millions)

AAA

$ 344 $ 393 $ 653 $ 4,571 $ (4,232 ) $ 1,729 $ 1,693

AA

1,289 2,293 2,963 10,220 (10,871 ) 5,894 4,141

A

7,151 9,669 8,721 19,663 (37,360 ) 7,844 5,791

BBB

2,911 3,364 3,556 14,091 (15,646 ) 8,276 6,024

Non-investment grade

2,140 1,998 998 3,238 (4,619 ) 3,755 2,968

Total

$ 13,835 $ 17,717 $ 16,891 $ 51,783 $ (72,728 ) $ 27,498 $ 20,617

(1) Fair values shown represent the Company’s net exposure to counterparties related to the Company’s OTC derivative products. Amounts include centrally cleared OTC derivatives. The table does not include exchange-traded derivatives and the effect of any related hedges utilized by the Company.
(2) Obligor credit ratings are determined by the Company’s Credit Risk Management Department.
(3) Amounts represent the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity categories. Receivable and payable balances with the same counterparty in the same maturity category are netted within such maturity category, where appropriate. Cash collateral received is netted on a counterparty basis, provided legal right of offset exists.

OTC Derivative Products—Trading Assets at December 31, 2013(1)

Years to Maturity Cross-Maturity
and
Cash Collateral
Netting(3)
Net Exposure
Post-Cash
Collateral
Net Exposure
Post-Collateral

Credit Rating(2)

Less
than 1
1-3 3-5 Over 5
(dollars in millions)

AAA

$ 300 $ 752 $ 1,073 $ 3,664 $ (3,721 ) $ 2,068 $ 1,673

AA

2,687 3,145 3,377 9,791 (13,515 ) 5,485 3,927

A

7,382 8,428 9,643 17,184 (35,644 ) 6,993 4,970

BBB

2,617 3,916 3,228 13,693 (16,191 ) 7,263 4,870

Non-investment grade

2,053 2,980 1,372 2,922 (4,737 ) 4,590 2,174

Total

$ 15,039 $ 19,221 $ 18,693 $ 47,254 $ (73,808 ) $ 26,399 $ 17,614

(1) Fair values shown represent the Company’s net exposure to counterparties related to the Company’s OTC derivative products. Amounts include centrally cleared OTC derivatives. The table does not include exchange-traded derivatives and the effect of any related hedges utilized by the Company.
(2) Obligor credit ratings are determined by the Company’s Credit Risk Management Department.
(3) Amounts represent the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity categories. Receivable and payable balances with the same counterparty in the same maturity category are netted within such maturity category, where appropriate. Cash collateral received is netted on a counterparty basis, provided legal right of offset exists.

LOGO 62


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Hedge Accounting.

The Company applies hedge accounting using various derivative financial instruments to hedge interest rate and foreign exchange risk arising from assets and liabilities not held at fair value as part of asset and liability management and foreign currency exposure management.

The Company’s hedges are designated and qualify for accounting purposes as one of the following types of hedges: hedges of exposure to changes in fair value of assets and liabilities being hedged (fair value hedges) and hedges of net investments in foreign operations whose functional currency is different from the reporting currency of the parent company (net investment hedges).

For all hedges where hedge accounting is being applied, effectiveness testing and other procedures to ensure the ongoing validity of the hedges are performed at least monthly.

Fair Value Hedges—Interest Rate Risk. The Company’s designated fair value hedges consisted primarily of interest rate swaps designated as fair value hedges of changes in the benchmark interest rate of fixed rate senior long-term borrowings. The Company uses regression analysis to perform an ongoing prospective and retrospective assessment of the effectiveness of these hedging relationships ( i.e. , the Company applies the “long-haul” method of hedge accounting). A hedging relationship is deemed effective if the fair values of the hedging instrument (derivative) and the hedged item (debt liability) change inversely within a range of 80% to 125%. The Company considers the impact of valuation adjustments related to the Company’s own credit spreads and counterparty credit spreads to determine whether they would cause the hedging relationship to be ineffective.

For qualifying fair value hedges of benchmark interest rates, the changes in the fair value of the derivative and the changes in the fair value of the hedged liability provide offset of one another and, together with any resulting ineffectiveness, are recorded in Interest expense. When a derivative is de-designated as a hedge, any basis adjustment remaining on the hedged liability is amortized to Interest expense over the remaining life of the liability using the effective interest method.

Net Investment Hedges. The Company may utilize forward foreign exchange contracts to manage the currency exposure relating to its net investments in non-U.S. dollar functional currency operations. No hedge ineffectiveness is recognized in earnings since the notional amounts of the hedging instruments equal the portion of the investments being hedged and the currencies being exchanged are the functional currencies of the parent and investee. The gain or loss from revaluing hedges of net investments in foreign operations at the spot rate is deferred and reported within AOCI. The forward points on the hedging instruments are recorded in Interest income.

63 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Fair Value and Notional of Derivative Instruments. The following tables summarize the fair value of derivative instruments designated as accounting hedges and the fair value of derivative instruments not designated as accounting hedges by type of derivative contract and the platform on which these instruments are traded or cleared on a gross basis. Fair values of derivative contracts in an asset position are included in Trading assets, and fair values of derivative contracts in a liability position are reflected in Trading liabilities in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition (see Note 4):

Derivative Assets
At June 30, 2014
Fair Value Notional
Bilateral
OTC
Cleared
OTC(1)
Exchange
Traded
Total Bilateral
OTC
Cleared
OTC(1)
Exchange
Traded
Total
(dollars in millions)

Derivatives designated as accounting hedges:

Interest rate contracts

$ 4,585 $ 584 $ $ 5,169 $ 51,265 $ 16,018 $ $ 67,283

Foreign exchange contracts

36 1 37 2,669 87 2,756

Total derivatives designated as accounting hedges

4,621 585 5,206 53,934 16,105 70,039

Derivatives not designated as accounting hedges(2):

Interest rate contracts

258,493 188,224 323 447,040 5,667,930 11,243,252 1,107,468 18,018,650

Credit contracts

30,265 4,084 34,349 995,043 176,754 1,171,797

Foreign exchange contracts

41,543 152 10 41,705 1,855,437 12,366 5,281 1,873,084

Equity contracts

25,934 30,234 56,168 315,020 475,564 790,584

Commodity contracts

14,909 3,169 18,078 123,282 144,224 267,506

Other

227 227 3,596 3,596

Total derivatives not designated as accounting hedges

371,371 192,460 33,736 597,567 8,960,308 11,432,372 1,732,537 22,125,217

Total derivatives

$ 375,992 $ 193,045 $ 33,736 $ 602,773 $ 9,014,242 $ 11,448,477 $ 1,732,537 $ 22,195,256

Cash collateral netting

(51,903 ) (3,599 ) (55,502 )

Counterparty netting

(298,924 ) (187,052 ) (29,329 ) (515,305 )

Total derivative assets

$ 25,165 $ 2,394 $ 4,407 $ 31,966 $ 9,014,242 $ 11,448,477 $ 1,732,537 $ 22,195,256

LOGO 64


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Derivative Liabilities
At June 30, 2014
Fair Value Notional
Bilateral
OTC
Cleared
OTC(1)
Exchange
Traded
Total Bilateral
OTC
Cleared
OTC(1)
Exchange
Traded
Total
(dollars in millions)

Derivatives designated as accounting hedges:

Interest rate contracts

$ 361 $ 242 $ $ 603 $ 2,681 $ 9,380 $ $ 12,061

Foreign exchange contracts

217 24 241 9,839 634 10,473

Total derivatives designated as accounting hedges

578 266 844 12,520 10,014 22,534

Derivatives not designated as accounting hedges(2):

Interest rate contracts

242,963 186,699 248 429,910 5,445,251 11,010,879 1,553,499 18,009,629

Credit contracts

30,061 3,329 33,390 922,310 137,642 1,059,952

Foreign exchange contracts

42,188 158 4 42,350 1,914,763 10,779 8,673 1,934,215

Equity contracts

30,650 31,999 62,649 342,015 475,985 818,000

Commodity contracts

13,515 3,791 17,306 118,521 124,839 243,360

Other

60 60 4,896 4,896

Total derivatives not designated as accounting hedges

359,437 190,186 36,042 585,665 8,747,756 11,159,300 2,162,996 22,070,052

Total derivatives

$ 360,015 $ 190,452 $ 36,042 $ 586,509 $ 8,760,276 $ 11,169,314 $ 2,162,996 $ 22,092,586

Cash collateral netting

(34,383 ) (1,397 ) (35,780 )

Counterparty netting

(298,924 ) (187,052 ) (29,329 ) (515,305 )

Total derivative liabilities

$ 26,708 $ 2,003 $ 6,713 $ 35,424 $ 8,760,276 $ 11,169,314 $ 2,162,996 $ 22,092,586

(1) Amounts include OTC derivatives that are centrally cleared in accordance with certain regulatory requirements.
(2) Notional amounts include gross notionals related to open long and short futures contracts of $524 billion and $1,073 billion, respectively. The unsettled fair value on these futures contracts (excluded from the table above) of $627 million and $64 million is included in Customer and other receivables and Customer and other payables, respectively, on the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.

65 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Derivative Assets
At December 31, 2013
Fair Value Notional
Bilateral
OTC
Cleared
OTC(1)
Exchange
Traded
Total Bilateral
OTC
Cleared
OTC(1)
Exchange
Traded
Total
(dollars in millions)

Derivatives designated as accounting hedges:

Interest rate contracts

$ 4,729 $ 287 $ $ 5,016 $ 54,696 $ 14,685 $ $ 69,381

Foreign exchange contracts

236 236 6,694 6,694

Total derivatives designated as accounting hedges

4,965 287 5,252 61,390 14,685 76,075

Derivatives not designated as accounting hedges(2):

Interest rate contracts

262,697 261,348 291 524,336 6,206,450 11,854,610 856,137 18,917,197

Credit contracts

39,054 5,292 44,346 1,244,004 240,781 1,484,785

Foreign exchange contracts

61,383 130 52 61,565 1,818,429 9,634 9,783 1,837,846

Equity contracts

26,104 28,001 54,105 294,524 437,842 732,366

Commodity contracts

10,106 3,265 13,371 144,981 139,433 284,414

Other

43 43 3,198 3,198

Total derivatives not designated as accounting hedges

399,387 266,770 31,609 697,766 9,711,586 12,105,025 1,443,195 23,259,806

Total derivatives

$ 404,352 $ 267,057 $ 31,609 $ 703,018 $ 9,772,976 $ 12,119,710 $ 1,443,195 $ 23,335,881

Cash collateral netting

(48,540 ) (3,462 ) (52,002 )

Counterparty netting

(329,919 ) (262,957 ) (25,673 ) (618,549 )

Total derivative assets

$ 25,893 $ 638 $ 5,936 $ 32,467 $ 9,772,976 $ 12,119,710 $ 1,443,195 $ 23,335,881

LOGO 66


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Derivative Liabilities
At December 31, 2013
Fair Value Notional
Bilateral
OTC
Cleared
OTC(1)
Exchange
Traded
Total Bilateral
OTC
Cleared
OTC(1)
Exchange
Traded
Total
(dollars in millions)

Derivatives designated as accounting hedges:

Interest rate contracts

$ 570 $ 614 $ $ 1,184 $ 2,642 $ 12,667 $ $ 15,309

Foreign exchange contracts

258 5 263 5,970 503 6,473

Total derivatives designated as accounting hedges

828 619 1,447 8,612 13,170 21,782

Derivatives not designated as accounting hedges(2):

Interest rate contracts

244,906 261,011 228 506,145 6,035,757 11,954,325 1,067,894 19,057,976

Credit contracts

37,835 4,791 42,626 1,099,483 213,900 1,313,383

Foreign exchange contracts

61,635 138 23 61,796 1,897,400 10,505 3,106 1,911,011

Equity contracts

31,483 29,412 60,895 341,232 464,622 805,854

Commodity contracts

9,436 3,450 12,886 138,784 120,556 259,340

Other

76 76 4,659 4,659

Total derivatives not designated as accounting hedges

385,371 265,940 33,113 684,424 9,517,315 12,178,730 1,656,178 23,352,223

Total derivatives

$ 386,199 $ 266,559 $ 33,113 $ 685,871 $ 9,525,927 $ 12,191,900 $ 1,656,178 $ 23,374,005

Cash collateral netting

(31,139 ) (2,422 ) (33,561 )

Counterparty netting

(329,920 ) (262,956 ) (25,673 ) (618,549 )

Total derivative liabilities

$ 25,140 $ 1,181 $ 7,440 $ 33,761 $ 9,525,927 $ 12,191,900 $ 1,656,178 $ 23,374,005

(1) Amounts include OTC derivatives that are centrally cleared in accordance with certain regulatory requirements.
(2) Notional amounts include gross notionals related to open long and short futures contracts of $426 billion and $729 billion, respectively. The unsettled fair value on these futures contracts (excluded from the table above) of $879 million and $27 million is included in Customer and other receivables and Customer and other payables, respectively, on the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.

The following tables summarize the gains or losses reported on derivative instruments designated and qualifying as accounting hedges for the quarters ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

Derivatives Designated as Fair Value Hedges.

The following table presents gains (losses) reported on derivative instruments and the related hedge item as well as the hedge ineffectiveness included in Interest expense in the condensed consolidated statements of income from interest rate contracts:

Gains (Losses) Recognized
Three Months  Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,

Product Type

2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Derivatives

$ 621 $ (2,247 ) $ 931 $ (3,119 )

Borrowings

(320 ) 2,629 (328 ) 3,791

Total

$ 301 $ 382 $ 603 $ 672

67 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Derivatives Designated as Net Investment Hedges .

Gains (Losses) Recognized in OCI (effective  portion)
Three Months Ended Six Months Ended
June 30, June 30,

Product Type

2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Foreign exchange contracts(1)

$ (109 ) $ 230 $ (176 ) $ 539

Total

$ (109 ) $ 230 $ (176 ) $ 539

(1) Losses of $52 million and $97 million were recognized in income related to amounts excluded from hedge effectiveness testing during the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively. Losses of $36 million and $68 million were recognized in income related to amounts excluded from hedge effectiveness testing during the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, respectively.

The table below summarizes gains (losses) on derivative instruments not designated as accounting hedges for the quarters and six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively:

Gains (Losses) Recognized in Income(1)(2)
Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,

Product Type

2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Interest rate contracts

$ (679 ) $ (65 ) $ (2,033 ) $ 75

Credit contracts

(354 ) 253 (197 ) 174

Foreign exchange contracts

567 1,485 1,591 2,036

Equity contracts

(1,918 ) (301 ) (2,077 ) (3,361 )

Commodity contracts

(53 ) 880 472 1,303

Other contracts

49 (42 ) 145 (44 )

Total derivative instruments

$ (2,388 ) $ 2,210 $ (2,099 ) $ 183

(1) Gains (losses) on derivative contracts not designated as hedges are primarily included in Trading revenues in the condensed consolidated statements of income.
(2) Gains (losses) associated with certain derivative contracts that have physically settled are excluded from the table above. Gains (losses) on these contracts are reflected with the associated cash instruments, which are also included in Trading revenues in the condensed consolidated statements of income.

The Company also has certain embedded derivatives that have been bifurcated from the related structured borrowings. Such derivatives are classified in Long-term borrowings and had a net fair value of $3 million and $32 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, and a notional value of $2,137 million and $2,140 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. The Company recognized losses of $18 million and $28 million related to changes in the fair value of its bifurcated embedded derivatives for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively. The gains and losses recognized by the Company related to changes in the fair value of its bifurcated embedded derivatives for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013 were not material.

At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the amount of payables associated with cash collateral received that was netted against derivative assets was $55.5 billion and $52.0 billion, respectively, and the amount of receivables in respect of cash collateral paid that was netted against derivative liabilities was $35.8 billion and $33.6 billion, respectively. Cash collateral receivables and payables of $12 million and $43 million, respectively, at June 30, 2014 and $10 million and $13 million, respectively, at December 31, 2013, were not offset against certain contracts that did not meet the definition of a derivative.

LOGO 68


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Credit-Risk-Related Contingencies.

In connection with certain OTC trading agreements, the Company may be required to provide additional collateral or immediately settle any outstanding liability balances with certain counterparties in the event of a credit ratings downgrade. At June 30, 2014, the aggregate fair value of OTC derivative contracts that contain credit-risk-related contingent features that are in a net liability position totaled $20,081 million, for which the Company has posted collateral of $18,678 million, in the normal course of business. The additional collateral or termination payments which may be called in the event of a future credit rating downgrade vary by contract and can be based on ratings by either or both of Moody’s Investor Services, Inc. (“Moody’s”) and Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services (“S&P”). At June 30, 2014, for such OTC trading agreements, the future potential collateral amounts and termination payments that could be called or required by counterparties or exchange and clearing organizations in the event of one-notch or two-notch downgrade scenarios based on the relevant contractual downgrade triggers were $1,471 million and an incremental $2,795 million, respectively. Of these amounts, $2,954 million at June 30, 2014 related to bilateral arrangements between the Company and other parties where upon the downgrade of one party, the downgraded party must deliver collateral to the other party. These bilateral downgrade arrangements are a risk management tool used extensively by the Company as credit exposures are reduced if counterparties are downgraded.

Credit Derivatives and Other Credit Contracts.

The Company enters into credit derivatives, principally through credit default swaps, under which it receives or provides protection against the risk of default on a set of debt obligations issued by a specified reference entity or entities. A majority of the Company’s counterparties are banks, broker-dealers, insurance and other financial institutions, and monoline insurers.

The tables below summarize the notional and fair value of protection sold and protection purchased through credit default swaps at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013:

At June 30, 2014
Maximum Potential Payout/Notional
Protection Sold Protection Purchased
Notional Fair Value
(Asset)/Liability
Notional Fair Value
(Asset)/Liability
(dollars in millions)

Single name credit default swaps

$ 648,859 $ (10,923 ) $ 615,380 $ 9,916

Index and basket credit default swaps

351,597 (3,298 ) 268,988 2,577

Tranched index and basket credit default swaps

118,391 (3,580 ) 228,534 4,349

Total

$ 1,118,847 $ (17,801 ) $ 1,112,902 $ 16,842

At December 31, 2013
Maximum Potential Payout/Notional
Protection Sold Protection Purchased
Notional Fair Value
(Asset)/Liability
Notional Fair Value
(Asset)/Liability
(dollars in millions)

Single name credit default swaps

$ 799,838 $ (9,349 ) $ 758,536 $ 8,564

Index and basket credit default swaps

454,355 (3,756 ) 361,961 2,827

Tranched index and basket credit default swaps

146,597 (3,889 ) 276,881 3,883

Total

$ 1,400,790 $ (16,994 ) $ 1,397,378 $ 15,274

69 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The table below summarizes the credit ratings and maturities of protection sold through credit default swaps and other credit contracts at June 30, 2014:

Protection Sold
Maximum Potential Payout/Notional Fair Value
(Asset)/
Liability(1)(2)
Years to Maturity

Credit Ratings of the Reference Obligation

Less than 1 1-3 3-5 Over 5 Total
(dollars in millions)

Single name credit default swaps:

AAA

$ 1,971 $ 10,826 $ 8,984 $ 1,066 $ 22,847 $ (140 )

AA

8,494 25,308 20,454 4,356 58,612 (850 )

A

31,078 54,880 31,923 4,126 122,007 (2,598 )

BBB

67,458 124,313 82,750 18,451 292,972 (4,973 )

Non-investment grade

37,875 69,616 39,851 5,079 152,421 (2,362 )

Total

146,876 284,943 183,962 33,078 648,859 (10,923 )

Index and basket credit default swaps(3):

AAA

24,880 29,124 13,897 2,193 70,094 (1,209 )

AA

2,421 5,761 4,162 3,752 16,096 (436 )

A

1,105 2,011 10,446 31 13,593 (352 )

BBB

43,058 58,434 100,581 7,328 209,401 (3,903 )

Non-investment grade

33,875 94,508 22,163 10,258 160,804 (978 )

Total

105,339 189,838 151,249 23,562 469,988 (6,878 )

Total credit default swaps sold

$ 252,215 $ 474,781 $ 335,211 $ 56,640 $ 1,118,847 $ (17,801 )

Other credit contracts(4)(5)

$ 51 $ 520 $ 441 $ 631 $ 1,643 $ (479 )

Total credit derivatives and other credit contracts

$ 252,266 $ 475,301 $ 335,652 $ 57,271 $ 1,120,490 $ (18,280 )

(1) Fair value amounts are shown on a gross basis prior to cash collateral or counterparty netting.
(2) Fair value amounts of certain credit default swaps where the Company sold protection have an asset carrying value because credit spreads of the underlying reference entity or entities tightened during the terms of the contracts.
(3) Credit ratings are calculated internally.
(4) Other credit contracts include CLNs, CDOs and credit default swaps that are considered hybrid instruments.
(5) Fair value amount shown represents the fair value of the hybrid instruments.

LOGO 70


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The table below summarizes the credit ratings and maturities of protection sold through credit default swaps and other credit contracts at December 31, 2013:

Protection Sold
Maximum Potential Payout/Notional Fair Value
(Asset)/
Liability(1)(2)
Years to Maturity

Credit Ratings of the Reference Obligation

Less than 1 1-3 3-5 Over 5 Total
(dollars in millions)

Single name credit default swaps:

AAA

$ 1,546 $ 8,661 $ 12,128 $ 1,282 $ 23,617 $ (145 )

AA

9,443 24,158 25,310 4,317 63,228 (845 )

A

45,663 53,755 44,428 4,666 148,512 (2,704 )

BBB

103,143 122,382 112,950 20,491 358,966 (4,294 )

Non-investment grade

60,254 77,393 61,088 6,780 205,515 (1,361 )

Total

220,049 286,349 255,904 37,536 799,838 (9,349 )

Index and basket credit default swaps(3):

AAA

14,890 40,522 30,613 2,184 88,209 (1,679 )

AA

3,751 4,127 4,593 6,006 18,477 (275 )

A

2,064 2,263 11,633 36 15,996 (418 )

BBB

5,974 29,709 74,982 3,847 114,512 (2,220 )

Non-investment grade

67,108 157,149 122,516 16,985 363,758 (3,053 )

Total

93,787 233,770 244,337 29,058 600,952 (7,645 )

Total credit default swaps sold

$ 313,836 $ 520,119 $ 500,241 $ 66,594 $ 1,400,790 $ (16,994 )

Other credit contracts(4)(5)

$ 75 $ 441 $ 529 $ 816 $ 1,861 $ (457 )

Total credit derivatives and other credit contracts

$ 313,911 $ 520,560 $ 500,770 $ 67,410 $ 1,402,651 $ (17,451 )

(1) Fair value amounts are shown on a gross basis prior to cash collateral or counterparty netting.
(2) Fair value amounts of certain credit default swaps where the Company sold protection have an asset carrying value because credit spreads of the underlying reference entity or entities tightened during the terms of the contracts.
(3) Credit ratings are calculated internally.
(4) Other credit contracts include CLNs, CDOs and credit default swaps that are considered hybrid instruments.
(5) Fair value amount shown represents the fair value of the hybrid instruments.

Single Name Credit Default Swaps. A credit default swap protects the buyer against the loss of principal on a bond or loan in case of a default by the issuer. The protection buyer pays a periodic premium (generally quarterly) over the life of the contract and is protected for the period. The Company in turn will have to perform under a credit default swap if a credit event as defined under the contract occurs. Typical credit events include bankruptcy, dissolution or insolvency of the referenced entity, failure to pay and restructuring of the obligations of the referenced entity. In order to provide an indication of the current payment status or performance risk of the credit default swaps, the external credit ratings of the underlying reference entity of the credit default swaps are disclosed.

Index and Basket Credit Default Swaps. Index and basket credit default swaps are credit default swaps that reference multiple names through underlying baskets or portfolios of single name credit default swaps. Generally, in the event of a default on one of the underlying names, the Company will have to pay a pro rata

71 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

portion of the total notional amount of the credit default index or basket contract. In order to provide an indication of the current payment status or performance risk of these credit default swaps, the weighted average external credit ratings of the underlying reference entities comprising the basket or index were calculated and disclosed.

The Company also enters into index and basket credit default swaps where the credit protection provided is based upon the application of tranching techniques. In tranched transactions, the credit risk of an index or basket is separated into various portions of the capital structure, with different levels of subordination. The most junior tranches cover initial defaults, and once losses exceed the notional of the tranche, they are passed on to the next most senior tranche in the capital structure.

When external credit ratings are not available, credit ratings were determined based upon an internal methodology.

Credit Protection Sold through CLNs and CDOs. The Company has invested in CLNs and CDOs, which are hybrid instruments containing embedded derivatives, in which credit protection has been sold to the issuer of the note. If there is a credit event of a reference entity underlying the instrument, the principal balance of the note may not be repaid in full to the Company.

Purchased Credit Protection with Identical Underlying Reference Obligations. For single name credit default swaps and non-tranched index and basket credit default swaps, the Company has purchased protection with a notional amount of approximately $880 billion and $1,116 billion at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, compared with a notional amount of approximately $994 billion and $1,252 billion at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, of credit protection sold with identical underlying reference obligations. In order to identify purchased protection with the same underlying reference obligations, the notional amount for individual reference obligations within non-tranched indices and baskets was determined on a pro rata basis and matched off against single name and non-tranched index and basket credit default swaps where credit protection was sold with identical underlying reference obligations.

The purchase of credit protection does not represent the sole manner in which the Company risk manages its exposure to credit derivatives. The Company manages its exposure to these derivative contracts through a variety of risk mitigation strategies, which include managing the credit and correlation risk across single name, non-tranched indices and baskets, tranched indices and baskets, and cash positions. Aggregate market risk limits have been established for credit derivatives, and market risk measures are routinely monitored against these limits. The Company may also recover amounts on the underlying reference obligation delivered to the Company under credit default swaps where credit protection was sold.

LOGO 72


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

11. Commitments, Guarantees and Contingencies.

Commitments.

The Company’s commitments associated with outstanding letters of credit and other financial guarantees obtained to satisfy collateral requirements, investment activities, corporate lending and financing arrangements, and mortgage lending at June 30, 2014 are summarized below by period of expiration. Since commitments associated with these instruments may expire unused, the amounts shown do not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements:

Years to Maturity
Less
than 1
1-3 3-5 Over 5 Total at
June 30, 2014
(dollars in millions)

Letters of credit and other financial guarantees obtained to satisfy collateral requirements

$ 372 $ 1 $ $ 2 $ 375

Investment activities

519 69 31 425 1,044

Primary lending commitments—investment grade(1)

17,936 13,637 36,263 572 68,408

Primary lending commitments—non-investment grade(1)

808 5,131 13,610 4,542 24,091

Secondary lending commitments(2)

50 41 37 181 309

Commitments for secured lending transactions

2,185 419 25 9 2,638

Forward starting reverse repurchase agreements and securities borrowing agreements(3)(4)

57,860 57,860

Commercial and residential mortgage-related commitments

4 92 394 301 791

Underwriting commitments

872 872

Other lending commitments

3,524 826 224 179 4,753

Total

$ 84,130 $ 20,216 $ 50,584 $ 6,211 $ 161,141

(1) This amount includes $54.1 billion of investment grade and $13 billion of non-investment grade unfunded commitments accounted for as held for investment and $10.4 billion of investment grade and $9.5 billion of non-investment grade unfunded commitments accounted for as held for sale at June 30, 2014. The remainder of these lending commitments is carried at fair value.
(2) These commitments are recorded at fair value within Trading assets and Trading liabilities in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition (see Note 4).
(3) The Company enters into forward starting reverse repurchase and securities borrowing agreements (agreements that have a trade date at or prior to June 30, 2014 and settle subsequent to period-end) that are primarily secured by collateral from U.S. government agency securities and other sovereign government obligations. These agreements primarily settle within three business days and of the total amount at June 30, 2014, $55.2 billion settled within three business days.
(4) The Company also has a contingent obligation to provide financing to a clearinghouse through which it clears certain transactions. The financing is required only upon the default of a clearinghouse member. The financing takes the form of a reverse repurchase facility, with a maximum amount of approximately $0.6 billion.

For further description of these commitments, refer to Note 13 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K.

The Company sponsors several non-consolidated investment funds for third-party investors where the Company typically acts as general partner of, and investment advisor to, these funds and typically commits to invest a minority of the capital of such funds, with subscribing third-party investors contributing the majority. The Company’s employees, including its senior officers, as well as the Company’s Directors, may participate on the same terms and conditions as other investors in certain of these funds that the Company forms primarily for

73 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

client investment, except that the Company may waive or lower applicable fees and charges for its employees. The Company has contractual capital commitments, guarantees, lending facilities and counterparty arrangements with respect to these investment funds.

Guarantees.

The table below summarizes certain information regarding the Company’s obligations under guarantee arrangements at June 30, 2014:

Maximum Potential Payout/Notional Carrying
Amount
(Asset)/
Liability
Collateral/
Recourse
Years to Maturity

Type of Guarantee

Less than 1 1-3 3-5 Over 5 Total
(dollars in millions)

Credit derivative contracts(1)

$ 252,215 $ 474,781 $ 335,211 $ 56,640 $ 1,118,847 $ (17,801 ) $

Other credit contracts

51 520 441 631 1,643 (479 )

Non-credit derivative contracts(1)

1,330,774 872,496 320,305 544,009 3,067,584 52,489

Standby letters of credit and other financial guarantees issued(2)

848 729 1,135 5,747 8,459 (246 ) 7,133

Market value guarantees

9 80 82 530 701 6 93

Liquidity facilities

2,383 2,383 (4 ) 3,314

Whole loan sales representations and warranties

23,677 23,677 34

Securitization representations and warranties

65,941 65,941 81

General partner guarantees

63 18 75 305 461 73

(1) Carrying amounts of derivative contracts are shown on a gross basis prior to cash collateral or counterparty netting. For further information on derivative contracts, see Note 10.
(2) Approximately $2.0 billion of standby letters of credit are also reflected in the “Commitments” table above in primary and secondary lending commitments. Standby letters of credit are recorded at fair value within Trading assets or Trading liabilities in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.

For further description of these guarantees, refer to Note 13 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K.

The Company has obligations under certain guarantee arrangements, including contracts and indemnification agreements that contingently require a guarantor to make payments to the guaranteed party based on changes in an underlying measure (such as an interest or foreign exchange rate, security or commodity price, an index or the occurrence or non-occurrence of a specified event) related to an asset, liability or equity security of a guaranteed party. Also included as guarantees are contracts that contingently require the guarantor to make payments to the guaranteed party based on another entity’s failure to perform under an agreement, as well as indirect guarantees of the indebtedness of others. The Company’s use of guarantees is described below by type of guarantee:

Other Guarantees and Indemnities.

In the normal course of business, the Company provides guarantees and indemnifications in a variety of commercial transactions. These provisions generally are standard contractual terms. Certain of these guarantees and indemnifications are described below.

Trust Preferred Securities .    The Company has established Morgan Stanley Capital Trusts for the limited purpose of issuing trust preferred securities to third parties and lending the proceeds to the Company in

LOGO 74


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

exchange for junior subordinated debentures. The Company has directly guaranteed the repayment of the trust preferred securities to the holders thereof to the extent that the Company has made payments to a Morgan Stanley Capital Trust on the junior subordinated debentures. In the event that the Company does not make payments to a Morgan Stanley Capital Trust, holders of such series of trust preferred securities would not be able to rely upon the guarantee for payment of those amounts. The Company has not recorded any liability in the condensed consolidated financial statements for these guarantees and believes that the occurrence of any events ( i.e. , non-performance on the part of the paying agent) that would trigger payments under these contracts is remote. See Note 11 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K for details on the Company’s junior subordinated debentures.

Indemnities .    The Company provides standard indemnities to counterparties for certain contingent exposures and taxes, including U.S. and foreign withholding taxes, on interest and other payments made on derivatives, securities and stock lending transactions, certain annuity products and other financial arrangements. These indemnity payments could be required based on a change in the tax laws or a change in interpretation of applicable tax rulings or a change in factual circumstances. Certain contracts contain provisions that enable the Company to terminate the agreement upon the occurrence of such events. The maximum potential amount of future payments that the Company could be required to make under these indemnifications cannot be estimated.

Exchange/Clearinghouse Member Guarantees .    The Company is a member of various U.S. and non-U.S. exchanges and clearinghouses that trade and clear securities and/or derivative contracts. Associated with its membership, the Company may be required to pay a proportionate share of the financial obligations of another member who may default on its obligations to the exchange or the clearinghouse. While the rules governing different exchange or clearinghouse memberships vary, in general the Company’s guarantee obligations would arise only if the exchange or clearinghouse had previously exhausted its resources. The maximum potential payout under these membership agreements cannot be estimated. The Company has not recorded any contingent liability in the condensed consolidated financial statements for these agreements and believes that any potential requirement to make payments under these agreements is remote.

Merger and Acquisition Guarantees .    The Company may, from time to time, in its role as investment banking advisor be required to provide guarantees in connection with certain European merger and acquisition transactions. If required by the regulating authorities, the Company provides a guarantee that the acquirer in the merger and acquisition transaction has or will have sufficient funds to complete the transaction and would then be required to make the acquisition payments in the event the acquirer’s funds are insufficient at the completion date of the transaction. These arrangements generally cover the time frame from the transaction offer date to its closing date and, therefore, are generally short term in nature. The maximum potential amount of future payments that the Company could be required to make cannot be estimated. The Company believes the likelihood of any payment by the Company under these arrangements is remote given the level of the Company’s due diligence associated with its role as investment banking advisor.

In the ordinary course of business, the Company guarantees the debt and/or certain trading obligations (including obligations associated with derivatives, foreign exchange contracts and the settlement of physical commodities) of certain subsidiaries. These guarantees generally are entity or product specific and are required by investors or trading counterparties. The activities of the subsidiaries covered by these guarantees (including any related debt or trading obligations) are included in the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements.

Contingencies.

Legal .    In the normal course of business, the Company has been named, from time to time, as a defendant in various legal actions, including arbitrations, class actions and other litigation, arising in connection with its

75 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

activities as a global diversified financial services institution. Certain of the actual or threatened legal actions include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages or claims for indeterminate amounts of damages. In some cases, the entities that would otherwise be the primary defendants in such cases are bankrupt or are in financial distress. These actions have included, but are not limited to, residential mortgage and credit crisis related matters. Over the last several years, the level of litigation and investigatory activity (both formal and informal) by governmental and self-regulatory agencies has increased materially in the financial services industry. As a result, the Company expects that it may become the subject of increased claims for damages and other relief and, while the Company has identified below any individual proceedings where the Company believes a material loss to be reasonably possible and reasonably estimable, there can be no assurance that material losses will not be incurred from claims that have not yet been asserted or are not yet determined to be probable or possible and reasonably estimable losses.

The Company contests liability and/or the amount of damages as appropriate in each pending matter. Where available information indicates that it is probable a liability had been incurred at the date of the condensed consolidated financial statements and the Company can reasonably estimate the amount of that loss, the Company accrues the estimated loss by a charge to income. The Company expects future litigation accruals in general to continue to be elevated and the changes in accruals from period to period may fluctuate significantly, given the current environment regarding government investigations and private litigation affecting global financial services firms, including the Company.

In many proceedings and investigations, however, it is inherently difficult to determine whether any loss is probable or even possible or to estimate the amount of any loss. In addition, even where loss is possible or an exposure to loss exists in excess of the liability already accrued with respect to a previously recognized loss contingency, it is not always possible to reasonably estimate the size of the possible loss or range of loss.

During July 2014, the Company agreed in principle to settle three litigation matters asserting claims on behalf of certain classes of investors. These matters are In re Morgan Stanley Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates Litigation , In re IndyMac Mortgage-Backed Securities Litigation and Ge Dandong, et al. v. Pinnacle Performance Ltd. , all of which are pending in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York (the “SDNY”). The Company has accrued the full cost of these settlements as of June 30, 2014. However, the agreements in principle have not yet been memorialized in formal settlement agreements, and the settlements will be subject to certain contingencies including court approval.

For certain legal proceedings and investigations, the Company cannot reasonably estimate such losses, particularly for proceedings and investigations where the factual record is being developed or contested or where plaintiffs or governmental entities seek substantial or indeterminate damages, restitution, disgorgement or penalties. Numerous issues may need to be resolved, including through potentially lengthy discovery and determination of important factual matters, determination of issues related to class certification and the calculation of damages or other relief, and by addressing novel or unsettled legal questions relevant to the proceedings or investigations in question, before a loss or additional loss or range of loss or additional loss can be reasonably estimated for a proceeding or investigation.

For certain other legal proceedings and investigations, the Company can estimate reasonably possible losses, additional losses, ranges of loss or ranges of additional loss in excess of amounts accrued, but does not believe, based on current knowledge and after consultation with counsel, that such losses will have a material adverse effect on the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements as a whole, other than the matters referred to in the following paragraphs.

LOGO 76


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

On March 15, 2010, the Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco filed two complaints against the Company and other defendants in the Superior Court of the State of California. These actions are styled Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco v. Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, et al. , and Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco v. Deutsche Bank Securities Inc. et al. , respectively. Amended complaints filed on June 10, 2010 allege that defendants made untrue statements and material omissions in connection with the sale to plaintiff of a number of mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The amount of certificates allegedly sold to plaintiff by the Company in these cases was approximately $704 million and $276 million, respectively. The complaints raise claims under both the federal securities laws and California law and seek, among other things, to rescind the plaintiff’s purchase of such certificates. On August 11, 2011, plaintiff’s Securities Act of 1933 claims were dismissed with prejudice. The defendants filed answers to the amended complaints on October 7, 2011. On February 9, 2012, defendants’ demurrers with respect to all other claims were overruled. On December 20, 2013, plaintiff’s negligent misrepresentation claims were dismissed with prejudice. A bellwether trial is currently scheduled to begin in January 2015. The Company is not a defendant in connection with the securitizations at issue in that trial. On May 23, 2014, plaintiff and the defendants in the bellwether trial filed motions for summary adjudication. At June 25, 2014, the current unpaid balance of the mortgage pass-through certificates at issue in these cases was approximately $301 million, and the certificates had incurred actual losses of approximately $6 million. Based on currently available information, the Company believes it could incur a loss for this action up to the difference between the $301 million unpaid balance of these certificates (plus any losses incurred) and their fair market value at the time of a judgment against the Company, or upon sale, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs. The Company may be entitled to be indemnified for some of these losses and to an offset for interest received by the plaintiff prior to a judgment.

On July 15, 2010, China Development Industrial Bank (“CDIB”) filed a complaint against the Company, styled China Development Industrial Bank v. Morgan Stanley & Co. Incorporated et al ., which is pending in the Supreme Court of the State of New York, New York County (“Supreme Court of NY”). The complaint relates to a $275 million credit default swap referencing the super senior portion of the STACK 2006-1 CDO. The complaint asserts claims for common law fraud, fraudulent inducement and fraudulent concealment and alleges that the Company misrepresented the risks of the STACK 2006-1 CDO to CDIB, and that the Company knew that the assets backing the CDO were of poor quality when it entered into the credit default swap with CDIB. The complaint seeks compensatory damages related to the approximately $228 million that CDIB alleges it has already lost under the credit default swap, rescission of CDIB’s obligation to pay an additional $12 million, punitive damages, equitable relief, fees and costs. On February 28, 2011, the court denied the Company’s motion to dismiss the complaint. Based on currently available information, the Company believes it could incur a loss of up to approximately $240 million plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs.

On October 15, 2010, the Federal Home Loan Bank of Chicago filed a complaint against the Company and other defendants in the Circuit Court of the State of Illinois styled Federal Home Loan Bank of Chicago v. Bank of America Funding Corporation et al . The complaint alleges that defendants made untrue statements and material omissions in the sale to plaintiff of a number of mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly sold to plaintiff by the Company in this action was approximately $203 million. The complaint raises claims under Illinois law and seeks, among other things, to rescind the plaintiff’s purchase of such certificates. On March 24, 2011, the court granted plaintiff leave to file an amended complaint. The Company filed its answer on December 21, 2012. On December 13, 2013, the court entered an order dismissing all claims related to one of the securitizations at issue. At June 25, 2014, the current unpaid balance of the mortgage pass-through certificates at issue in this action was approximately $56 million and the certificates had not yet incurred actual losses. Based on currently available information, the Company believes it could incur a loss in this action up to the difference between the $56 million unpaid balance of these certificates (plus any losses incurred) and their fair market value at the time of a

77 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

judgment against the Company, or upon sale, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs. The Company may be entitled to be indemnified for some of these losses and to an offset for interest received by the plaintiff prior to a judgment.

On July 18, 2011, the Western and Southern Life Insurance Company and certain affiliated companies filed a complaint against the Company and other defendants in the Court of Common Pleas in Ohio, styled Western and Southern Life Insurance Company, et al. v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc., et al . An amended complaint was filed on April 2, 2012 and alleges that defendants made untrue statements and material omissions in the sale to plaintiffs of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The amount of the certificates allegedly sold to plaintiffs by the Company was approximately $153 million. The amended complaint raises claims under the Ohio Securities Act, federal securities laws, and common law and seeks, among other things, to rescind the plaintiffs’ purchases of such certificates. The Company filed its answer on August 17, 2012. Trial is currently scheduled to begin in July 2015. At June 25, 2014, the current unpaid balance of the mortgage pass-through certificates at issue in this action was approximately $113 million, and the certificates had incurred actual losses of approximately $2 million. Based on currently available information, the Company believes it could incur a loss in this action up to the difference between the $113 million unpaid balance of these certificates (plus any losses incurred) and their fair market value at the time of a judgment against the Company, or upon sale, plus post-judgment interest, fees and costs. The Company may be entitled to an offset for interest received by the plaintiff prior to a judgment.

On April 25, 2012, The Prudential Insurance Company of America and certain affiliates filed a complaint against the Company and certain affiliates in the Superior Court of the State of New Jersey styled The Prudential Insurance Company of America, et al. v. Morgan Stanley, et al. The complaint alleges that defendants made untrue statements and material omissions in connection with the sale to plaintiffs of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly sponsored, underwritten and/or sold by the Company is approximately $1 billion. The complaint raises claims under the New Jersey Uniform Securities Law, as well as common law claims of negligent misrepresentation, fraud and tortious interference with contract and seeks, among other things, compensatory damages, punitive damages, rescission and rescissionary damages associated with plaintiffs’ purchases of such certificates. On October 16, 2012, plaintiffs filed an amended complaint which, among other things, increases the total amount of the certificates at issue by approximately $80 million, adds causes of action for fraudulent inducement, equitable fraud, aiding and abetting fraud, and violations of the New Jersey RICO statute, and includes a claim for treble damages. On March 15, 2013, the court denied the defendants’ motion to dismiss the amended complaint. On April 26, 2013, the defendants filed an answer to the amended complaint. On June 5, 2014, the defendants filed a renewed motion to dismiss the amended complaint. At June 25, 2014, the current unpaid balance of the mortgage pass-through certificates at issue in this action was approximately $623 million, and the certificates had not yet incurred actual losses. Based on currently available information, the Company believes it could incur a loss in this action up to the difference between the $623 million unpaid balance of these certificates (plus any losses incurred) and their fair market value at the time of a judgment against the Company, or upon sale, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs. The Company may be entitled to be indemnified for some of these losses and to an offset for interest received by the plaintiff prior to a judgment.

On April 20, 2011, the Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston filed a complaint against the Company and other defendants in the Superior Court of the Commonwealth of Massachusetts styled Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston v. Ally Financial, Inc. F/K/A GMAC LLC et al . An amended complaint was filed on June 19, 2012 and alleges that defendants made untrue statements and material omissions in the sale to plaintiff of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly issued by the Company or sold to plaintiff by the Company was approximately $385

LOGO 78


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

million. The amended complaint raises claims under the Massachusetts Uniform Securities Act, the Massachusetts Consumer Protection Act and common law and seeks, among other things, to rescind the plaintiff’s purchase of such certificates. On May 26, 2011, defendants removed the case to the United States District Court for the District of Massachusetts. On October 11, 2012, defendants filed motions to dismiss the amended complaint, which was granted in part and denied in part on September 30, 2013. The defendants filed an answer to the amended complaint on December 16, 2013. On July 16, 2014, plaintiff voluntarily dismissed its claims against the Company with respect to one of the securitizations at issue. At June 25, 2014, the current unpaid balance of the mortgage pass-through certificates at issue in this action was approximately $67 million, and the certificates had not yet incurred actual losses. Based on currently available information, the Company believes it could incur a loss in this action up to the difference between the $67 million unpaid balance of these certificates (plus any losses incurred) and their fair market value at the time of a judgment against the Company, or upon sale, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs. The Company may be entitled to be indemnified for some of these losses and to an offset for interest received by the plaintiff prior to a judgment.

On August 8, 2012, U.S. Bank, in its capacity as Trustee, filed a complaint on behalf of Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-14SL, Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 2006-14SL, Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2007-4SL and Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates, Series 2007-4SL against the Company. The complaint is styled Morgan Stanley Mortgage Loan Trust 2006-14SL, et al. v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC, as successor in interest to Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Inc . and is pending in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint asserts claims for breach of contract and alleges, among other things, that the loans in the trusts, which had original principal balances of approximately $354 million and $305 million respectively, breached various representations and warranties. On October 9, 2012, the Company filed a motion to dismiss the complaint. On August 16, 2013, the court granted in part and denied in part the Company’s motion to dismiss the complaint. On September 17, 2013, the Company filed its answer to the complaint. On September 26, 2013, and October 7, 2013, the Company and the plaintiffs, respectively, filed notices of appeal with respect to the court’s August 16, 2013 decision. The plaintiff is seeking, among other relief, rescission of the mortgage loan purchase agreements underlying the transactions, specific performance and unspecified damages and interest. Based on currently available information, the Company believes that it could incur a loss in this action of up to approximately $527 million, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs.

On February 14, 2013, Bank Hapoalim B.M. filed a complaint against the Company and certain affiliates in the Supreme Court of NY, styled Bank Hapoalim B.M. v. Morgan Stanley et al. The complaint alleges that defendants made material misrepresentations and omissions in the sale to plaintiff of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly sponsored, underwritten and/or sold by the Company to plaintiff was approximately $141 million. The complaint alleges causes of action against the Company for common law fraud, fraudulent concealment, aiding and abetting fraud, and negligent misrepresentation, and seeks, among other things, compensatory and punitive damages. On April 22, 2014, the defendants’ motion to dismiss was denied in substantial part. At June 25, 2014, the current unpaid balance of the mortgage pass-through certificates at issue in this action was approximately $75 million, and the certificates had not yet incurred actual losses. Based on currently available information, the Company believes it could incur a loss in this action up to the difference between the $75 million unpaid balance of these certificates (plus any losses incurred) and their fair market value at the time of a judgment against the Company, or upon sale, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs.

On May 3, 2013, plaintiffs in Deutsche Zentral-Genossenschaftsbank AG et al. v. Morgan Stanley et al. filed a complaint against the Company, certain affiliates, and other defendants in the Supreme Court of NY. The complaint alleges that defendants made material misrepresentations and omissions in the sale to plaintiffs of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans.

79 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The total amount of certificates allegedly sponsored, underwritten and/or sold by the Company to plaintiff was approximately $694 million. The complaint alleges causes of action against the Company for common law fraud, fraudulent concealment, aiding and abetting fraud, negligent misrepresentation, and rescission and seeks, among other things, compensatory and punitive damages. On June 10, 2014, the court denied defendants’ motion to dismiss. On July 10, 2014, the Company filed a renewed motion to dismiss with respect to two certificates at issue in the case. At June 25, 2014, the current unpaid balance of the mortgage pass-through certificates at issue in this action was approximately $284 million, and the certificates had incurred actual losses of approximately $52 million. Based on currently available information, the Company believes it could incur a loss in this action up to the difference between the $284 million unpaid balance of these certificates (plus any losses incurred) and their fair market value at the time of a judgment against the Company, or upon sale, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs. The Company may be entitled to be indemnified for some of these losses.

On September 23, 2013, plaintiffs in National Credit Union Administration Board v. Morgan Stanley & Co. Inc., et al. filed a complaint against the Company and certain affiliates in the SDNY. The complaint alleges that defendants made untrue statements of material fact or omitted to state material facts in the sale to plaintiffs of certain mortgage pass-through certificates issued by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly sponsored, underwritten and/or sold by the Company to plaintiffs was approximately $417 million. The complaint alleges causes of action against the Company for violations of Section 11 and Section 12(a)(2) of the Securities Act of 1933, violations of the Texas Securities Act, and violations of the Illinois Securities Law of 1953 and seeks, among other things, rescissory and compensatory damages. The defendants filed a motion to dismiss the complaint on November 13, 2013. On January 22, 2014, the court granted defendants’ motion to dismiss with respect to claims arising under the Securities Act of 1933 and denied defendants’ motion to dismiss with respect to claims arising under Texas Securities Act and the Illinois Securities Law of 1953. On April 28, 2014, the court granted in part and denied in part plaintiff’s motion to strike certain of the defendants’ affirmative defenses. On July 11, 2014, the defendants filed a motion for reconsideration of the court’s order on the motion to dismiss the complaint or, in the alternative, for certification of interlocutory appeal and a stay of all proceedings. At June 25, 2014, the current unpaid balance of the mortgage pass-through certificates at issue in this action was approximately $215 million, and the certificates had incurred actual losses of approximately $26 million. Based on currently available information, the Company believes it could incur a loss in this action up to the difference between the $215 million unpaid balance of these certificates (plus any losses incurred) and their fair market value at the time of a judgment against the Company, or upon sale, plus pre- and post-judgment interest, fees and costs. The Company may be entitled to be indemnified for some of these losses and to an offset for interest received by the plaintiff prior to a judgment.

12. Regulatory Requirements.

Morgan Stanley .    The Company is a financial holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, and is subject to the regulation and oversight of the Federal Reserve. The Federal Reserve establishes capital requirements for the Company, including well-capitalized standards, and evaluates the Company’s compliance with such capital requirements. The Office of the Comptroller of the Currency establishes similar capital requirements and standards for the Company’s U.S. bank operating subsidiaries MSBNA and MSPBNA (“U.S. Banks”).

Minimum Capital Ratio Requirements. In 2014, as a result of the U.S. Basel III phase-in provisions, the Company is subject to a minimum Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 4.0%, a minimum Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 5.5%, and a minimum Total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0%. The Company is also subject to a minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio, defined as the ratio of Tier 1 capital to average total on-balance sheet assets (subject to certain adjustments), of 4.0%. Beginning on January 1, 2018, the Company will also be subject

LOGO 80


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

to a minimum supplementary leverage ratio of 3%, and must maintain a buffer of greater than 2% (for a total of greater than 5%) to avoid restrictions on the Company’s ability to make capital distributions and to pay discretionary bonuses to executive officers.

Under U.S. Basel III, the Company is subject, on a fully phased-in basis, to a minimum Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 4.5%, a minimum Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio of 6.0%, a minimum Total risk-based capital ratio of 8.0% and a minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio of 4.0%. The Company will also be subject to a 2.5% Common Equity Tier 1 capital conservation buffer and, if deployed by banking regulators, up to a 2.5% Common Equity Tier 1 countercyclical buffer on a fully phased-in basis by 2019. The capital conservation buffer and, if deployed, the countercyclical buffer apply to each of the Common Equity Tier 1, Tier 1 and Total Capital ratios. Failure to maintain such buffers will result in restrictions on the Company’s ability to make capital distributions, including the payment of dividends and the repurchase of the Company’s common stock, and to pay discretionary bonuses to the Company’s executive officers.

Calculation of Risk-based Capital Ratios. On February 21, 2014, the Federal Reserve and the OCC approved the Company’s and the Company’s U.S. Banks’ completion of the parallel run process under the Advanced Approach framework. As Advanced Approach banking organizations, the Company and the Company’s U.S. Banks are required to compute risk-based capital ratios using both (i) a Standardized Approach, represented as U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5 for calendar year 2014 and beginning in 2015, the U.S. Basel III Standardized Approach for calculating credit and market risk-weighted assets (“RWAs”); and (ii) after completing the parallel run process, an advanced internal ratings-based approach for calculating credit RWAs and advanced measurement approaches for calculating operational RWAs, as supplemented by advanced market RWAs calculated under U.S. Basel III (the “Advanced Approach”).

To implement a provision of the Dodd-Frank Act, U.S. Basel III subjects Advanced Approach banking organizations, such as the Company and the Company’s U.S. Banks, to a permanent “capital floor.” The capital floor is based on the lower of the capital ratios calculated under either the Advanced Approach or a Standardized Approach, represented as U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5 for calendar year 2014 and, beginning on January 1, 2015, the U.S. Basel III Standardized Approach.

The Company’s Regulatory Capital and Capital Ratios. The methods for calculating each of the Company’s risk-based capital ratios will change as U.S. Basel III’s revisions to the numerator and denominator are phased-in and as the Company begins calculating RWAs using the Advanced Approach and the Standardized Approach. These ongoing methodological changes may result in differences in the Company’s reported capital ratios from one reporting period to the next that are independent of changes to the Company’s capital base, asset composition, off-balance sheet exposures or risk profile. Beginning with the second quarter of 2014, the Company and its U.S. Banks’ risk-based capital ratios for regulatory purposes are the lower of each ratio calculated using RWAs under U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5 and the Advanced Approach. At June 30, 2014, the Company’s risk-based capital ratios were lower under the Advanced Approach transitional rules; however, the risk-based capital ratios for the Company’s U.S. Banks were lower under U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5.

81 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The following table presents the Company’s capital measures at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013.

At June 30, 2014 At December 31, 2013
U.S. Basel III
Transitional/

Advanced Approach
U.S. Basel I(1)
Balance Ratio Balance Ratio
(dollars in millions)

Common Equity Tier 1 capital and Tier 1 common capital

$ 58,144 13.9 % $ 49,917 12.8 %

Tier 1 capital

64,533 15.4 % 61,007 15.7 %

Total capital

72,787 17.4 % 66,000 16.9 %

RWAs

418,054 389,675

Adjusted average assets(2)

824,662 805,838

Tier 1 leverage

7.8 % 7.6 %

(1) The standards applicable in 2013 included U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5. The Company’s Total capital, Tier 1 capital, Tier 1 common capital and Tier 1 leverage ratios and RWAs at December 31, 2013 were calculated under this framework.
(2) Average total on-balance sheet assets subject to certain adjustments in accordance with U.S. Basel I rules for the quarter ended December 31, 2013 and U.S. Basel III rules for the quarter ended June 30, 2014.

The Company’s U.S. Banks. The Company’s U.S. Banks are subject to various regulatory capital requirements as administered by U.S. federal banking agencies. Failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material effect on the Company’s U.S. Banks’ financial statements. Under capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action, the Company’s U.S. Banks must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of the Company’s U.S. Banks’ assets, liabilities and certain off-balance sheet items as calculated under regulatory accounting practices.

At June 30, 2014, the Company’s U.S. Banks had met all capital adequacy requirements to which they are subject to and exceeded all regulatory mandated and targeted minimum regulatory capital requirements to be well-capitalized. There are no conditions or events that management believes have changed the Company’s U.S. Banks’ category.

The table below sets forth the capital information for the Company’s U.S. Banks.

At June 30, 2014 At December 31, 2013
U.S. Basel III
Transitional/

Basel I + 2.5 Approach
U.S. Basel I(1)(2)
Balance Ratio Balance Ratio
(dollars in millions)

Common Equity Tier 1 capital (to RWAs):

MSBNA

$ 11,604 13.0 % N/A N/A

MSPBNA

$ 2,226 22.0 % N/A N/A

Tier 1 capital (to RWAs):

MSBNA

$ 11,604 13.0 % $ 11,086 14.6 %

MSPBNA

$ 2,226 22.0 % $ 2,177 26.5 %

Total capital (to RWAs):

MSBNA

$ 13,279 14.8 % $ 12,749 16.8 %

MSPBNA

$ 2,244 22.1 % $ 2,184 26.6 %

Tier 1 leverage:

MSBNA

$ 11,604 10.5 % $ 11,086 10.8 %

MSPBNA

$ 2,226 10.2 % $ 2,177 9.7 %

LOGO 82


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

N/A—Not Applicable

(1) The standards applicable in 2013 included U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5. The Company’s U.S. Banks’ Total capital, Tier 1 capital and Tier 1 leverage ratios and RWAs at December 31, 2013 were calculated under this framework.
(2) The December 31, 2013 ratios of MSBNA have been restated to reflect certain amendments to its regulatory reports.

Under regulatory capital requirements adopted by the U.S. federal banking agencies, U.S. depository institutions, in order to be considered well-capitalized, must maintain a capital ratio of Common Equity Tier 1 capital to RWAs of 6.5%, a capital ratio of Tier 1 capital to RWAs of 8%, a ratio of total capital to RWAs of 10%, and a ratio of Tier 1 capital to average total assets (leverage ratio) of 5%. Each U.S. depository institution subsidiary of the Company must be well-capitalized in order for the Company to continue to qualify as a financial holding company and to continue to engage in the broadest range of financial activities permitted for financial holding companies. At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the Company’s U.S. Banks maintained capital at levels in excess of the universally mandated well-capitalized levels. The Company’s U.S. Banks maintain capital at levels sufficiently in excess of the “well-capitalized” requirements to address any additional capital needs and requirements identified by the federal banking regulators.

MS&Co. and Other Broker-Dealers. MS&Co. is a registered broker-dealer and registered futures commission merchant and, accordingly, is subject to the minimum net capital requirements of the SEC, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. (“FINRA”) and the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (the “CFTC”). MS&Co. has consistently operated with capital in excess of its regulatory capital requirements. MS&Co.’s net capital totaled $9,108 million and $7,201 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, which exceeded the amount required by $7,463 million and $5,627 million, respectively. MS&Co. is required to hold tentative net capital in excess of $1 billion and net capital in excess of $500 million in accordance with the market and credit risk standards of Appendix E of SEC Rule 15c3-1. MS&Co. is also required to notify the SEC in the event that its tentative net capital is less than $5 billion. At June 30, 2014, MS&Co. had tentative net capital in excess of the minimum and the notification requirements.

MSSB LLC is a registered broker-dealer and registered futures commission merchant and, accordingly, is subject to the minimum net capital requirements of the SEC, FINRA and the CFTC. MSSB LLC has consistently operated with capital in excess of its regulatory capital requirements. MSSB LLC’s net capital totaled $4,511 million and $3,489 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, which exceeded the amount required by $4,336 million and $3,308 million, respectively.

MSIP, a London-based broker-dealer subsidiary, is subject to the capital requirements of the Prudential Regulation Authority, and MSMS, a Tokyo-based broker-dealer subsidiary, is subject to the capital requirements of the Financial Services Agency. MSIP and MSMS have consistently operated with capital in excess of their respective regulatory capital requirements.

Other Regulated Subsidiaries. Certain other U.S. and non-U.S. subsidiaries are subject to various securities, commodities and banking regulations, and capital adequacy requirements promulgated by the regulatory and exchange authorities of the countries in which they operate. These subsidiaries have consistently operated with capital in excess of their local capital adequacy requirements.

Morgan Stanley Derivative Products Inc. (“MSDP”), a derivative products subsidiary rated A3 by Moody’s and AA- by S&P, maintains certain operating restrictions that have been reviewed by Moody’s and S&P. MSDP is operated such that creditors of the Company should not expect to have any claims on the assets of MSDP, unless and until the obligations to its own creditors are satisfied in full. Creditors of MSDP should not expect to have any claims on the assets of the Company or any of its affiliates, other than the respective assets of MSDP.

83 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

13. Total Equity

Morgan Stanley Shareholders’ Equity.

At June 30, 2014, the Company had approximately $0.8 billion remaining under its current share repurchase program out of the $6 billion authorized by the Board of Directors in December 2006. The share repurchase program is for capital management purposes and considers, among other things, business segment capital needs as well as equity-based compensation and benefit plan requirements. Share repurchases under the Company’s existing authorized program will be exercised from time to time at prices the Company deems appropriate subject to various factors, including the Company’s capital position and market conditions. The share repurchases may be effected through open market purchases or privately negotiated transactions, including through Rule 10b5-1 plans, and may be suspended at any time. Share repurchases by the Company are subject to regulatory approval (see “Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds” in Part II, Item 2).

During the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, the Company did not repurchase common stock as part of its share repurchase program. In July 2013, the Company received no objection from the Federal Reserve to repurchase through March 31, 2014 up to $500 million of the Company’s outstanding common stock under rules relating to annual capital distributions. In March 2014, the Company received no objection from the Federal Reserve to the Company’s 2014 capital plan, which included a share repurchase of up to $1 billion of the Company’s outstanding common stock beginning in the second quarter of 2014 through the end of the first quarter of 2015, as well as an increase in the Company’s quarterly common stock dividend to $0.10 per share from $0.05 per share, beginning with the dividend declared on April 17, 2014. During the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, the Company repurchased approximately $284 million and $434 million, respectively, of the Company’s outstanding common stock as part of its share repurchase program.

Series E Preferred Stock. On September 30, 2013, the Company issued 34,500,000 Depositary Shares, for an aggregate price of $862 million. Each Depositary Share represents a 1/1,000th interest in a share of perpetual Series E Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, $0.01 par value (“Series E Preferred Stock”). The Series E Preferred Stock is redeemable at the Company’s option, (i) in whole or in part, from time to time, on any dividend payment date on or after October 15, 2023 or (ii) in whole but not in part at any time within 90 days following a regulatory capital treatment event (as described in the terms of that series), in each case at a redemption price of $25,000 per share (equivalent to $25.00 per Depository Share). The Series E Preferred Stock also has a preference over the Company’s common stock upon liquidation. The Series E Preferred Stock offering (net of related issuance costs) resulted in proceeds of approximately $854 million.

Series F Preferred Stock .    On December 10, 2013, the Company issued 34,000,000 Depositary Shares, for an aggregate price of $850 million. Each Depositary Share represents a 1/1,000th interest in a share of perpetual Series F Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, $0.01 par value (“Series F Preferred Stock”). The Series F Preferred Stock is redeemable at the Company’s option, (i) in whole or in part, from time to time, on any dividend payment date on or after January 15, 2024 or (ii) in whole but not in part at any time within 90 days following a regulatory capital treatment event (as described in the terms of that series), in each case at a redemption price of $25,000 per share (equivalent to $25.00 per Depositary Share). The Series F Preferred Stock also has a preference over the Company’s common stock upon liquidation. The Series F Preferred Stock offering (net of related issuance costs) resulted in proceeds of approximately $842 million.

Series G Preferred Stock. On April 29, 2014, the Company issued 20,000,000 Depositary Shares, for an aggregate price of $500 million. Each Depositary Share represents a 1/1,000th interest in a share of perpetual 6.625% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series G, $0.01 par value (“Series G Preferred Stock”). The Series G Preferred Stock is redeemable at the Company’s option, (i) in whole or in part, from time to time, on any

LOGO 84


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

dividend payment date on or after July 15, 2019 or (ii) in whole but not in part at any time within 90 days following a regulatory capital treatment event (as described in the terms of that series), in each case at a redemption price of $25,000 per share (equivalent to $25.00 per Depositary Share). The Series G Preferred Stock also has a preference over the Company’s common stock upon liquidation. The Series G Preferred Stock offering (net of related issuance costs) resulted in proceeds of approximately $494 million.

Series H Preferred Stock. On April 29, 2014, the Company issued 1,300,000 Depositary Shares, for an aggregate price of $1,300 million. Each Depositary Share represents a 1/25th interest in a share of perpetual Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series H, $0.01 par value (“Series H Preferred Stock”). The Series H Preferred Stock is redeemable at the Company’s option, (i) in whole or in part, from time to time, on any dividend payment date on or after July 15, 2019 or (ii) in whole but not in part at any time within 90 days following a regulatory capital treatment event (as described in the terms of that series), in each case at a redemption price of $25,000 per share (equivalent to $1,000 per Depositary Share). The Series H Preferred Stock also has a preference over the Company’s common stock upon liquidation. The Series H Preferred Stock offering (net of related issuance costs) resulted in proceeds of approximately $1,294 million.

Accumulated Other Comprehensive Income (Loss).

The following table presents changes in AOCI by component, net of noncontrolling interests, in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 (dollars in millions):

Foreign
Currency
Translation
Adjustments
Net Change
in

Cash Flow
Hedges
Change in
Net Unrealized
Gains (Losses) on

AFS Securities
Pension,
Postretirement
and Other Related
Adjustments
Total

Balance at March 31, 2014

$ (218 ) $ $ (208 ) $ (542 ) $ (968 )

Other comprehensive income before reclassifications

68 168 2 238

Amounts reclassified from AOCI

1 (6 ) 2 (3 )

Net other comprehensive income during the period

68 1 162 4 235

Balance at June 30, 2014

$ (150 ) $ 1 $ (46 ) $ (538 ) $ (733 )

The Company had no significant reclassifications out of AOCI for the quarter ended June 30, 2014.

The following table presents changes in AOCI by component, net of noncontrolling interests, in the quarter ended June 30, 2013 (dollars in millions):

Foreign
Currency
Translation
Adjustments
Net Change
in

Cash Flow
Hedges
Change in
Net Unrealized
Gains (Losses) on
AFS Securities
Pension,
Postretirement
and Other Related
Adjustments
Total

Balance at March 31, 2013

$ (276 ) $ (4 ) $ 124 $ (538 ) $ (694 )

Other comprehensive income (loss) before reclassifications

(144 ) (322 ) 5 (461 )

Amounts reclassified from AOCI

1 (20 ) 5 (14 )

Net other comprehensive income (loss) during the period

(144 ) 1 (342 ) 10 (475 )

Balance at June 30, 2013

$ (420 ) $ (3 ) $ (218 ) $ (528 ) $ (1,169 )

85 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

The Company had no significant reclassifications out of AOCI for the quarter ended June 30, 2013.

The following table presents changes in AOCI by component, net of noncontrolling interests, in the six months ended June 30, 2014 (dollars in millions):

Foreign
Currency
Translation
Adjustments
Net Change
in
Cash Flow
Hedges
Change in
Net Unrealized
Gains (Losses) on
AFS Securities
Pension,
Postretirement
and Other Related
Adjustments
Total

Balance at December 31, 2013

$ (266 ) $ (1 ) $ (282 ) $ (544 ) $ (1,093 )

Other comprehensive income before reclassifications

116 246 2 364

Amounts reclassified from AOCI

2 (10 ) 4 (4 )

Net other comprehensive income during the period

116 2 236 6 360

Balance at June 30, 2014

$ (150 ) $ 1 $ (46 ) $ (538 ) $ (733 )

The Company had no significant reclassifications out of AOCI for the six months ended June 30, 2014.

The following table presents changes in AOCI by component, net of noncontrolling interests, in the six months ended June 30, 2013 (dollars in millions):

Foreign
Currency
Translation
Adjustments
Net Change
in
Cash Flow
Hedges
Change in
Net Unrealized
Gains (Losses) on
AFS Securities
Pension,
Postretirement
and Other Related
Adjustments
Total

Balance at December 31, 2012

$ (123 ) $ (5 ) $ 151 $ (539 ) $ (516 )

Other comprehensive loss before reclassifications

(297 ) (347 ) 2 (642 )

Amounts reclassified from AOCI

2 (22 ) 9 (11 )

Net other comprehensive income (loss) during the period

(297 ) 2 (369 ) 11 (653 )

Balance at June 30, 2013

$ (420 ) $ (3 ) $ (218 ) $ (528 ) $ (1,169 )

The Company had no significant reclassifications out of AOCI for the six months ended June 30, 2013.

Nonredeemable Noncontrolling Interests.

The reduction in nonredeemable noncontrolling interests from December 31, 2013 primarily reflects a decrease of $1.6 billion related to the deconsolidation of certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund sponsored by the Company and distributions of $166 million related to MSMS.

LOGO 86


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

14. Earnings per Common Share.

Basic earnings per common share (“EPS”) is computed by dividing earnings (loss) applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding for the period. Common shares outstanding include common stock and vested restricted stock units (“RSUs”) where recipients have satisfied either the explicit vesting terms or retirement eligibility requirements. Diluted EPS reflects the assumed conversion of all dilutive securities. The Company calculates EPS using the two-class method and determines whether instruments granted in share-based payment transactions are participating securities (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K). The following table presents the calculation of basic and diluted EPS (in millions, except for per share data):

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013

Basic EPS:

Income from continuing operations

$ 1,918 $ 1,222 $ 3,463 $ 2,472

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(1 ) (31 ) 38 (50 )

Net income

1,917 1,191 3,501 2,422

Net income applicable to redeemable noncontrolling interests

100 222

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

18 111 97 258

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

1,899 980 3,404 1,942

Less: Preferred dividends (Series A Preferred Stock)

(11 ) (11 ) (22 ) (22 )

Less: Preferred dividends (Series C Preferred Stock)

(13 ) (13 ) (26 ) (26 )

Less: Preferred dividends (Series E Preferred Stock)

(16 ) (31 )

Less: Preferred dividends (Series F Preferred Stock)

(14 ) (29 )

Less: Preferred dividends (Series G Preferred Stock)

(7 ) (7 )

Less: Preferred dividends (Series H Preferred Stock)

(15 ) (15 )

Less: Wealth Management JV redemption value adjustment (see Note 3)

(151 ) (151 )

Less: Allocation of (earnings) loss to participating RSUs(1):

From continuing operations

(3 ) (2 ) (5 ) (4 )

Earnings applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders

$ 1,820 $ 803 $ 3,269 $ 1,739

Weighted average common shares outstanding

1,928 1,908 1,926 1,904

Earnings per basic common share:

Income from continuing operations

$ 0.94 $ 0.44 $ 1.68 $ 0.94

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(0.02 ) 0.02 (0.03 )

Earnings per basic common share

$ 0.94 $ 0.42 $ 1.70 $ 0.91

Diluted EPS:

Earnings applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders

$ 1,820 $ 803 $ 3,269 $ 1,739

Weighted average common shares outstanding

1,928 1,908 1,926 1,904

Effect of dilutive securities:

Stock options and RSUs(1)

41 43 43 42

Weighted average common shares outstanding and common stock equivalents

1,969 1,951 1,969 1,946

Earnings per diluted common share:

Income from continuing operations

$ 0.92 $ 0.43 $ 1.64 $ 0.92

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(0.02 ) 0.02 (0.03 )

Earnings per diluted common share

$ 0.92 $ 0.41 $ 1.66 $ 0.89

87 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

(1) RSUs that are considered participating securities participate in all of the earnings of the Company in the computation of basic EPS, and, therefore, such RSUs are not included as incremental shares in the diluted calculation.

The following securities were considered antidilutive and, therefore, were excluded from the computation of diluted EPS:

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,

Number of Antidilutive Securities Outstanding at End of Period:

2014 2013 2014 2013
(shares in millions)

RSUs and performance-based stock units

3 4 3 4

Stock options

13 36 13 36

Total

16 40 16 40

15. Interest Income and Interest Expense.

Details of Interest income and Interest expense were as follows:

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Interest income(1):

Trading assets(2)

$ 528 $ 613 $ 1,029 $ 1,217

AFS Securities

150 110 288 206

Loans

358 278 730 522

Interest bearing deposits with banks

24 25 59 51

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed(3)(4)

(127 ) (81 ) (136 ) (33 )

Other

317 323 623 649

Total interest income

$ 1,250 $ 1,268 $ 2,593 $ 2,612

Interest expense(1):

Deposits

$ 17 $ 41 $ 30 $ 82

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings

2 5 2 14

Long-term debt

930 917 1,865 1,877

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned(4)(5)

303 371 629 777

Other

(269 ) (270 ) (508 ) (524 )

Total interest expense

$ 983 $ 1,064 $ 2,018 $ 2,226

Net interest

$ 267 $ 204 $ 575 $ 386

(1) Interest income and expense are recorded within the condensed consolidated statements of income depending on the nature of the instrument and related market conventions. When interest is included as a component of the instrument’s fair value, interest is included within Trading revenues or Investments revenues. Otherwise, it is included within Interest income or Interest expense.
(2) Interest expense on Trading liabilities is reported as a reduction to Interest income on Trading assets.
(3) Includes fees paid on securities borrowed.
(4) During the fourth quarter of 2013, the Company identified that certain fees paid on securities borrowed which had been reported within Interest expense should have been reported within Interest income and that certain fees received on securities loaned which had been reported within Interest income should have been reported within Interest expense. The 2013 Form 10-K reflected the adjusted classification on a full year basis. To correct the corresponding 2013 quarterly periods to conform to the Form 10-K presentation, “Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned” and “Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed” were reduced by $147 million and $191 million for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, respectively. This adjustment had no impact on net interest income.
(5) Includes fees received on securities loaned.

LOGO 88


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

16. Employee Benefit Plans.

The Company sponsors various pension plans for the majority of its U.S. and non-U.S. employees. The Company provides certain other postretirement benefits, primarily health care and life insurance, to eligible U.S. employees. The Company also provides certain postemployment benefits to certain former employees or inactive employees prior to retirement.

The components of the Company’s net periodic benefit expense for its pension and other postretirement plans were as follows:

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Service cost, benefits earned during the period

$ 6 $ 7 $ 12 $ 14

Interest cost on projected benefit obligation

40 39 80 78

Expected return on plan assets

(27 ) (29 ) (55 ) (57 )

Net amortization of prior service cost (credit)

(3 ) (3 ) (6 ) (7 )

Net amortization of actuarial loss

6 10 12 20

Net periodic benefit expense

$ 22 $ 24 $ 43 $ 48

17. Income Taxes.

The Company is under continuous examination by the Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”) and other tax authorities in certain countries, such as Japan and the U.K., and in states in which the Company has significant business operations, such as New York. The Company is currently under review by the IRS Appeals Office for the remaining issues covering tax years 1999 – 2005. Also, the Company has substantially completed the IRS field examination for the audit of tax years 2006 – 2008, and is currently at various levels of field examination with respect to audits by New York State and New York City for tax years 2007 – 2009. During 2014, the Company expects to reach a conclusion with the U.K. tax authorities on substantially all issues through tax year 2010, the resolution of which is not expected to have a material impact on the effective tax rate, the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition or the condensed consolidated statements of income.

The Company’s effective tax rate from continuing operations for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 included a discrete net tax benefit of $609 million principally associated with remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of the IRS field examination referred to above. Excluding this discrete net tax benefit, the effective tax rate from continuing operations for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 would have been 32.3% and 33.0%, respectively. Additionally, as a result of this remeasurement, the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits decreased by $1.6 billion to $2.5 billion at June 30, 2014, of which, approximately $0.9 billion (net of federal benefit of state items, competent authority and foreign tax credit offsets) represents the amount of unrecognized tax benefits that, if recognized, would favorably affect the effective tax rate in future periods.

The Company believes that the resolution of tax matters will not have a material effect on the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition of the Company, although a resolution could have a material impact on the Company’s condensed consolidated statements of income for a particular future period and on the Company’s effective income tax rate for any period in which such resolution occurs. The Company has established a liability for unrecognized tax benefits that the Company believes is adequate in relation to the potential for additional assessments. Once established, the Company adjusts unrecognized tax benefits only when more information is available or when an event occurs necessitating a change.

89 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

It is reasonably possible that significant changes in the gross balance of unrecognized tax benefits may occur within the next 12 months related to certain tax authority examinations referred to above. At this time, however, it is not possible to reasonably estimate the expected change to the total amount of unrecognized tax benefits and impact on the effective tax rate over the next 12 months.

The Company’s effective tax rate from continuing operations for the six months ended June 30, 2013 included a discrete tax benefit of $81 million due to the retroactive effective date of the American Taxpayer Relief Act of 2012 (the “Relief Act”). The Relief Act that was enacted on January 2, 2013, among other things, extended with retroactive effect to January 1, 2012 a provision of U.S. tax law that defers the imposition of tax on certain active financial services income of certain foreign subsidiaries earned outside of the U.S. until such income is repatriated to the U.S. as a dividend. Additionally, the Company’s effective tax rate from continuing operations for the six months ended June 30, 2013 included a discrete net tax benefit of $61 million associated with remeasurement of reserves and related interest based on new information regarding the status of certain tax authority examinations. Excluding these discrete net tax benefits, the effective tax rate in the six months ended June 30, 2013 would have been 31.4%.

Investments in Qualified Affordable Housing Projects. In January 2014, the FASB issued an update providing guidance on accounting for investments in flow-through limited liability entities that manage or invest in affordable housing projects that qualify for the low-income housing tax credit. This guidance permits the Company to make an accounting policy election to account for its investments in qualified affordable housing projects using the proportional amortization method if certain conditions are met. Under the proportional amortization method, an entity amortizes the initial cost of the investment in proportion to the tax credits and other tax benefits received and recognizes the investment amortization in the consolidated statement of income as a component of Provision for (benefit from) income taxes. As a practical expedient, an investor is permitted to amortize the initial cost of the investment in proportion to only the tax credits allocated to the investor if the investor reasonably expects that doing so would produce a measurement that is substantially similar. This guidance is effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2015, with earlier application permitted.

The Company made the accounting policy election described above and early-adopted the guidance with an effective date of April 1, 2014. As a result of adopting the guidance, the Company made retrospective adjustments to remove from Other revenues previously recorded losses recognized under the equity method of accounting and record the amortization expense computed under the proportional amortization method to Provision for (benefit from) income taxes for all prior periods presented. The impact of early adoption on retained earnings was immaterial. The Company removed $(18) million from Other revenues and recorded $18 million to Provision for (benefit from) income taxes in the quarter ended March 31, 2014. Also, the Company removed $(18) million and $(37) million from Other revenues and recorded $18 million and $37 million to Provision for (benefit from) income taxes in the quarter ended March 31, 2013 and six months ended June 30, 2013, respectively.

18. Segment and Geographic Information.

Segment Information.

The Company structures its segments primarily based upon the nature of the financial products and services provided to customers and the Company’s management organization. The Company provides a wide range of financial products and services to its customers in each of its business segments: Institutional Securities, Wealth Management and Investment Management. For further discussion of the Company’s business segments, see Note 1.

LOGO 90


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Revenues and expenses directly associated with each respective segment are included in determining its operating results. Other revenues and expenses that are not directly attributable to a particular segment are allocated based upon the Company’s allocation methodologies, generally based on each segment’s respective net revenues, non-interest expenses or other relevant measures.

As a result of revenues and expenses from transactions with other operating segments being treated as transactions with external parties, the Company includes an Intersegment Eliminations category to reconcile the business segment results to the Company’s consolidated results. Intersegment Eliminations also reflect the effect of fees paid by the Institutional Securities business segment to the Wealth Management business segment related to the bank deposit program.

Selected financial information for the Company’s segments is presented below:

Three Months Ended June 30, 2014

Institutional
Securities
Wealth
Management
Investment
Management
Intersegment
Eliminations
Total
(dollars in millions)

Total non-interest revenues

$ 4,554 $ 3,137 $ 700 $ (50 ) $ 8,341

Interest income

758 616 1 (125 ) 1,250

Interest expense

1,064 38 9 (128 ) 983

Net interest

(306 ) 578 (8 ) 3 267

Net revenues(1)

$ 4,248 $ 3,715 $ 692 $ (47 ) $ 8,608

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

$ 961 $ 767 $ 205 $ $ 1,933

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

(344 ) 296 63 15

Income from continuing operations

1,305 471 142 1,918

Discontinued operations(2):

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes

(7 ) 5 (2 )

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

(3 ) 2 (1 )

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(4 ) 3 (1 )

Net income

1,301 471 145 1,917

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

11 7 18

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 1,290 $ 471 $ 138 $ $ 1,899

91 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Three Months Ended June 30, 2013

Institutional
Securities
Wealth
Management
Investment
Management
Intersegment
Eliminations
Total
(dollars in millions)

Total non-interest revenues

$ 4,598 $ 3,085 $ 674 $ (46 ) $ 8,311

Interest income(3)

875 511 3 (121 ) 1,268

Interest expense(3)

1,115 65 4 (120 ) 1,064

Net interest

(240 ) 446 (1 ) (1 ) 204

Net revenues(1)

$ 4,358 $ 3,531 $ 673 $ (47 ) $ 8,515

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

$ 981 $ 655 $ 160 $ $ 1,796

Provision for income taxes

307 229 38 574

Income from continuing operations

674 426 122 1,222

Discontinued operations(2):

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes

(30 ) (14 ) (44 )

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

(10 ) (3 ) (13 )

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(20 ) (11 ) (31 )

Net income (loss)

654 426 122 (11 ) 1,191

Net income applicable to redeemable noncontrolling interests

100 100

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

90 21 111

Net income (loss) applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 564 $ 326 $ 101 $ (11 ) $ 980

Six Months Ended June 30, 2014

Institutional
Securities
Wealth
Management
Investment
Management
Intersegment
Eliminations
Total
(dollars in millions)

Total non-interest revenues

$ 9,406 $ 6,220 $ 1,445 $ (91 ) $ 16,980

Interest income

1,639 1,197 2 (245 ) 2,593

Interest expense

2,170 80 15 (247 ) 2,018

Net interest

(531 ) 1,117 (13 ) 2 575

Net revenues(1)

$ 8,875 $ 7,337 $ 1,432 $ (89 ) $ 17,555

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

$ 2,332 $ 1,458 $ 468 $ $ 4,258

Provision for income taxes

77 564 154 795

Income from continuing operations

2,255 894 314 3,463

Discontinued operations(2):

Income from discontinued operations before income taxes

36 6 42

Provision for income taxes

2 2 4

Income from discontinued operations

34 4 38

Net income

2,289 894 318 3,501

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

36 61 97

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 2,253 $ 894 $ 257 $ $ 3,404

LOGO 92


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Six Months Ended June 30, 2013

Institutional
Securities
Wealth
Management
Investment
Management
Intersegment
Eliminations
Total
(dollars in millions)

Total non-interest revenues

$ 8,924 $ 6,142 $ 1,323 $ (92 ) $ 16,297

Interest income(3)

1,845 999 5 (237 ) 2,612

Interest expense(3)

2,312 140 10 (236 ) 2,226

Net interest

(467 ) 859 (5 ) (1 ) 386

Net revenues(1)

$ 8,457 $ 7,001 $ 1,318 $ (93 ) $ 16,683

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

$ 1,798 $ 1,252 $ 347 $ $ 3,397

Provision for income taxes

386 449 90 925

Income from continuing operations

1,412 803 257 2,472

Discontinued operations(2):

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes

(60 ) (1 ) 1 (14 ) (74 )

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

(21 ) (3 ) (24 )

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(39 ) (1 ) 1 (11 ) (50 )

Net income (loss)

1,373 802 258 (11 ) 2,422

Net income applicable to redeemable noncontrolling interests

1 221 222

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

186 72 258

Net income (loss) applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 1,186 $ 581 $ 186 $ (11 ) $ 1,942

(1) In certain management fee arrangements, the Company is entitled to receive performance-based fees (also referred to as incentive fees) when the return on assets under management exceeds certain benchmark returns or other performance targets. In such arrangements, performance fee revenue is accrued (or reversed) quarterly based on measuring account fund performance to date versus the performance benchmark stated in the investment management agreement. The amount of cumulative performance-based fee revenue at risk of reversing if fund performance falls below stated investment management agreement benchmarks was approximately $592 million at June 30, 2014 and approximately $489 million at December 31, 2013 (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K).
(2) See Note 1 for discussion of discontinued operations.
(3) During the fourth quarter of 2013, the Company identified that certain fees paid on securities borrowed which had been reported within Interest expense should have been reported within Interest income and that certain fees received on securities loaned which had been reported within Interest income should have been reported within Interest expense. The Form 10-K reflected the adjusted classification on a full year basis. To correct the corresponding 2013 quarterly periods to conform to the Form 10-K presentation, Interest income and Interest expense were reduced by $147 million and $191 million for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, respectively. This adjustment had no impact on net interest income.

Total Assets(1)

Institutional
Securities
Wealth
Management
Investment
Management(2)
Total
(dollars in millions)

At June 30, 2014

$ 667,514 $ 153,235 $ 5,819 $ 826,568

At December 31, 2013

$ 668,596 $ 156,711 $ 7,395 $ 832,702

(1) Corporate assets have been fully allocated to the Company’s business segments.
(2) On April 1, 2014, the Company deconsolidated approximately $1.6 billion in total assets that were related to certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund sponsored by the Company (see Note 7).

93 LOGO


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

Geographic Information.

The Company operates in both U.S. and non-U.S. markets. The Company’s non-U.S. business activities are principally conducted and managed through European and Asia-Pacific locations. The net revenues disclosed in the following table reflect the regional view of the Company’s consolidated net revenues on a managed basis, based on the following methodology:

Institutional Securities: advisory and equity underwriting—client location, debt underwriting—revenue recording location, sales and trading—trading desk location.

Wealth Management: wealth management representatives operate in the Americas.

Investment Management: client location, except for Merchant Banking and Real Estate Investing businesses, which are based on asset location.

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,

Net Revenues

2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Americas

$ 6,132 $ 6,028 $ 12,665 $ 11,997

EMEA

1,498 1,132 2,920 2,198

Asia-Pacific

978 1,355 1,970 2,488

Net revenues

$ 8,608 $ 8,515 $ 17,555 $ 16,683

19. Equity Method Investments.

The Company has investments accounted for under the equity method of accounting (see Note 1) of $3,922 million and $4,746 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, included in Other investments in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition. The decrease in these investments was primarily related to the early adoption of the accounting update Accounting for Investments in Qualified Affordable Housing Projects . Investments in qualified affordable housing projects are now accounted for under the proportional amortization method, and no longer the equity method. For further information, see Notes 2 and 17. Income from equity method investments was $20 million and $146 million for the quarters ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and $76 million and $228 million for six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, and is included in Other revenues in the condensed consolidated statements of income. Income from the Company’s equity method investments for the quarters and six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 were primarily related to the Company’s 40% stake in Mitsubishi UFJ Morgan Stanley Securities Co., Ltd. (“MUMSS”), as described below.

Japanese Securities Joint Venture.

The Company holds a 40% voting interest and Mitsubishi UFJ Financial Group, Inc. holds a 60% voting interest in MUMSS. The Company accounts for its interest in MUMSS as an equity method investment within the Institutional Securities business segment. During the quarters ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company recorded income of $34 million and $174 million, respectively, and income of $91 million and $299 million in the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, within Other revenues in the condensed consolidated statements of income, arising from the Company’s 40% stake in MUMSS.

In June 2014 and 2013, MUMSS paid a dividend of approximately $594 million and $287 million, respectively, of which the Company received approximately $238 million and $115 million, respectively, for its proportionate share of MUMSS.

LOGO 94


Table of Contents

MORGAN STANLEY

NOTES TO CONDENSED CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS—(Continued)

20. Subsequent Events.

The Company has evaluated subsequent events for adjustment to or disclosure in the condensed consolidated financial statements through the date of this report and the Company has not identified any recordable or disclosable events, not otherwise reported in these condensed consolidated financial statements or the notes thereto, except for the following:

Common Dividend.

On July 17, 2014, the Company announced that its Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend per common share of $0.10. The dividend is payable on August 15, 2014 to common shareholders of record on July 31, 2014 (see Note 13).

Long-Term Borrowings.

Subsequent to June 30, 2014 and through July 31, 2014, the Company’s long-term borrowings (net of repayments) increased by approximately $2.0 billion. This amount includes the Company’s issuance of $3.0 billion in senior debt on July 23, 2014.

TransMontaigne.

On July 1, 2014, the Company completed the sale of its ownership stake in TransMontaigne Inc., a U.S.-based oil storage, marketing and transportation company, to NGL Energy Partners LP. The gain on sale will be reflected in the third quarter of 2014 and is not expected to be material to the Company’s results of operations.

Legal Matters.

Subsequent to the release of the Company’s earnings on July 17, 2014, legal accruals were increased, which increased Other expenses within the Institutional Securities business segment in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 by $53 million related to agreements in principle to settle certain mortgage­related matters (see “Contingencies—Legal” in Note 11). This decreased diluted EPS and diluted EPS from continuing operations by $0.02 in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014. The settlements were considered to be recognizable subsequent events requiring adjustment to the June 30, 2014 condensed consolidated financial statements under U.S. GAAP.

95 LOGO


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of Morgan Stanley:

We have reviewed the accompanying condensed consolidated statement of financial condition of Morgan Stanley and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as of June 30, 2014, the related condensed consolidated statements of income and comprehensive income for the three-month and six-month periods ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, and the condensed consolidated statements of cash flows and changes in total equity for the six-month periods ended June 30, 2014 and 2013. These condensed consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the management of the Company.

We conducted our reviews in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). A review of interim financial information consists principally of applying analytical procedures and making inquiries of persons responsible for financial and accounting matters. It is substantially less in scope than an audit conducted in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the objective of which is the expression of an opinion regarding the financial statements taken as a whole. Accordingly, we do not express such an opinion.

Based on our review, we are not aware of any material modifications that should be made to such condensed consolidated financial statements for them to be in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America.

We have previously audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated statement of financial condition of the Company as of December 31, 2013, and the consolidated statements of income, comprehensive income, cash flows and changes in total equity for the year then ended (not presented herein) included in the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K; and in our report dated February 25, 2014, we expressed an unqualified opinion on those consolidated financial statements. In our opinion, the information set forth in the accompanying condensed consolidated statement of financial condition as of December 31, 2013 is fairly stated, in all material respects, in relation to the consolidated statement of financial condition from which it has been derived.

/s/ Deloitte & Touche LLP

New York, New York

August 5, 2014

96


Table of Contents
Item 2. Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations.

Introduction.

Morgan Stanley, a financial holding company, is a global financial services firm that maintains significant market positions in each of its business segments—Institutional Securities, Wealth Management and Investment Management. The Company, through its subsidiaries and affiliates, provides a wide variety of products and services to a large and diversified group of clients and customers, including corporations, governments, financial institutions and individuals. Unless the context otherwise requires, the terms “Morgan Stanley” or the “Company” mean Morgan Stanley (the “Parent”) together with its consolidated subsidiaries.

A summary of the activities of each of the Company’s business segments is as follows:

Institutional Securities provides financial advisory and capital-raising services, including: advice on mergers and acquisitions, restructurings, real estate and project finance; corporate lending; sales, trading, financing and market-making activities in equity and fixed income securities and related products, including foreign exchange and commodities; and investment activities.

Wealth Management provides brokerage and investment advisory services to individual investors and small-to-medium sized businesses and institutions covering various investment alternatives; financial and wealth planning services; annuity and other insurance products; credit and other lending products; cash management services; retirement services; and engages in fixed income trading, which primarily facilitates clients’ trading or investments in such securities.

Investment Management provides a broad array of investment strategies that span the risk/return spectrum across geographies, asset classes, and public and private markets to a diverse group of clients across the institutional and intermediary channels as well as high net worth clients.

The results of operations in the past have been, and in the future may continue to be, materially affected by many factors, including: the effect of economic and political conditions and geopolitical events; the effect of market conditions, particularly in the global equity, fixed income, credit and commodities markets, including corporate and mortgage (commercial and residential) lending and commercial real estate markets; the impact of current, pending and future legislation (including the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act (the “Dodd-Frank Act”)), regulation (including capital, leverage and liquidity requirements), policies (including fiscal and monetary) and legal and regulatory actions in the United States of America (“U.S.”) and worldwide; the level and volatility of equity, fixed income, and commodity prices, interest rates, currency values and other market indices; the availability and cost of both credit and capital as well as the credit ratings assigned to the Company’s unsecured short-term and long-term debt; investor, consumer and business sentiment and confidence in the financial markets; the performance of the Company’s acquisitions, divestitures, joint ventures, strategic alliances or other strategic arrangements; the Company’s reputation; inflation, natural disasters and acts of war or terrorism; the actions and initiatives of current and potential competitors as well as governments, regulators and self-regulatory organizations; the effectiveness of the Company’s risk management policies; technological changes and risks, including cybersecurity risks; or a combination of these or other factors. In addition, legislative, legal and regulatory developments related to the Company’s businesses are likely to increase costs, thereby affecting results of operations. These factors also may have an adverse impact on the Company’s ability to achieve its strategic objectives. For a further discussion of these and other important factors that could affect the Company’s business, see “Business—Competition” and “Business—Supervision and Regulation” in Part I, Item 1, “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013 (“Form 10-K”) and “Other Matters” and “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Requirements” herein.

The discussion of the Company’s results of operations below may contain forward-looking statements. These statements, which reflect management’s beliefs and expectations, are subject to risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results to differ materially. For a discussion of the risks and uncertainties that may affect the

97 LOGO


Table of Contents

Company’s future results, see “Forward-Looking Statements” immediately preceding Part I, Item 1, “Business—Competition” and “Business—Supervision and Regulation” in Part I, Item 1, “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of the Form 10-K and “Other Matters” and “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Requirements” herein.

See Note 1 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for a discussion of the Company’s discontinued operations.

Executive Summary.

Financial Information and Statistical Data (dollars in millions, except where noted and per share amounts).

Three Months  Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013

Net revenues:

Institutional Securities

$ 4,248 $ 4,358 $ 8,875 $ 8,457

Wealth Management

3,715 3,531 7,337 7,001

Investment Management

692 673 1,432 1,318

Intersegment Eliminations

(47 ) (47 ) (89 ) (93 )

Consolidated net revenues

$ 8,608 $ 8,515 $ 17,555 $ 16,683

Net income

$ 1,917 $ 1,191 $ 3,501 $ 2,422

Net income applicable to redeemable noncontrolling interests(1)

100 222

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests(1)

18 111 97 258

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 1,899 $ 980 $ 3,404 $ 1,942

Income from continuing operations applicable to Morgan Stanley:

Institutional Securities

$ 1,294 $ 584 $ 2,219 $ 1,225

Wealth Management

471 326 894 582

Investment Management

135 101 253 185

Income from continuing operations applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 1,900 $ 1,011 $ 3,366 $ 1,992

Income (loss) from discontinued operations applicable to Morgan Stanley(2)

(1 ) (31 ) 38 (50 )

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 1,899 $ 980 $ 3,404 $ 1,942

Preferred stock dividend and other

79 177 135 203

Earnings applicable to Morgan Stanley common shareholders

$ 1,820 $ 803 $ 3,269 $ 1,739

Earnings per basic common share:

Income from continuing operations

$ 0.94 $ 0.44 $ 1.68 $ 0.94

Income (loss) from discontinued operations(2)

(0.02 ) 0.02 (0.03 )

Earnings per basic common share(3)

$ 0.94 $ 0.42 $ 1.70 $ 0.91

Earnings per diluted common share:

Income from continuing operations

$ 0.92 $ 0.43 $ 1.64 $ 0.92

Income (loss) from discontinued operations(2)

(0.02 ) 0.02 (0.03 )

Earnings per diluted common share(3)

$ 0.92 $ 0.41 $ 1.66 $ 0.89

Regional net revenues(4):

Americas

$ 6,132 $ 6,028 $ 12,665 $ 11,997

EMEA

1,498 1,132 2,920 2,198

Asia-Pacific

978 1,355 1,970 2,488

Net revenues

$ 8,608 $ 8,515 $ 17,555 $ 16,683

LOGO 98


Table of Contents

Financial Information and Statistical Data (dollars in millions, except where noted and per share amounts)—(Continued).

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013

Average common equity (dollars in billions)(5):

Institutional Securities

$ 33.3 $ 38.3 $ 31.9 $ 39.2

Wealth Management

11.5 13.3 11.4 13.3

Investment Management

3.1 2.8 2.8 2.8

Parent capital

16.7 7.1 17.8 5.9

Consolidated average common equity

$ 64.6 $ 61.5 $ 63.9 $ 61.2

Return on average common equity(6):

Institutional Securities

15.0 % 5.9 % 13.4 % 6.0 %

Wealth Management

15.4 % 5.2 % 14.8 % 6.4 %

Investment Management

17.7 % 14.0 % 18.2 % 13.0 %

Consolidated

11.3 % 5.4 % 10.1 % 5.9 %

Book value per common share(7)

$ 33.46 $ 31.48 $ 33.46 $ 31.48

Average tangible common equity (dollars in billions)(8)

$ 54.8 $ 53.4 $ 54.1 $ 53.3

Return on average tangible common equity(9)

13.3 % 6.3 % 12.0 % 6.7 %

Tangible book value per common share(10)

$ 28.51 $ 26.27 $ 28.51 $ 26.27

Effective income tax rate from continuing operations(11)

0.8 % 32.0 % 18.7 % 27.2 %

Worldwide employees at June 30, 2014 and 2013

56,142 55,610 56,142 55,610

Global Liquidity Reserve held by bank and non-bank legal entities at June 30, 2014 and 2013 (dollars in billions)(12)

$ 192 $ 181 $ 192 $ 181

Average Global Liquidity Reserve (dollars in billions)(12):

Bank legal entities

$ 88 $ 65 $ 89 $ 68

Non-bank legal entities

109 119 109 118

Total average Global Liquidity Reserve

$ 197 $ 184 $ 198 $ 186

U.S. Banks assets at June 30, 2014 and 2013(13)

$ 132,078 $ 97,280 $ 132,078 $ 97,280

Total assets at June 30, 2014 and 2013

$ 826,568 $ 802,691 $ 826,568 $ 802,691

Total deposits at June 30, 2014 and 2013

$ 117,695 $ 81,514 $ 117,695 $ 81,514

Long-term borrowings at June 30, 2014 and 2013

$ 149,483 $ 161,098 $ 149,483 $ 161,098

Maturities of long-term borrowings outstanding at June 30, 2014 and 2013 (next 12 months)

$ 16,594 $ 26,921 $ 16,594 $ 26,921

Capital ratios at June 30, 2014 and 2013(14):

Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio (Advanced/Transitional in 2014)

13.9 % N/A 13.9 % N/A

Tier 1 common capital ratio

N/A 11.8 % N/A 11.8 %

Tier 1 capital ratio (Advanced/Transitional in 2014)

15.4 % 14.1 % 15.4 % 14.1 %

Total capital ratio (Advanced/Transitional in 2014)

17.4 % 14.9 % 17.4 % 14.9 %

Tier 1 leverage ratio (Advanced/Transitional in 2014)(15)

7.8 % 7.1 % 7.8 % 7.1 %

Consolidated assets under management or supervision at June 30, 2014 and 2013 (dollars in billions)(16):

Investment Management(17)

$ 396 $ 347 $ 396 $ 347

Wealth Management

758 625 758 625

Total

$ 1,154 $ 972 $ 1,154 $ 972

99 LOGO


Table of Contents

Financial Information and Statistical Data (dollars in millions, except where noted and per share amounts)—(Continued).

Three Months  Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013

Pre-tax profit margin(18):

Institutional Securities

23 % 23 % 26 % 21 %

Wealth Management

21 % 19 % 20 % 18 %

Investment Management

30 % 24 % 33 % 26 %

Consolidated

23 % 21 % 24 % 20 %

Selected management financial measures, excluding DVA:

Net revenues, excluding DVA(19)

$ 8,521 $ 8,340 $ 17,342 $ 16,825

Income from continuing operations applicable to Morgan Stanley, excluding DVA(19)

$ 1,839 $ 900 $ 3,230 $ 2,082

Income per diluted common share from continuing operations, excluding DVA(19)

$ 0.89 $ 0.37 $ 1.57 $ 0.97

Return on average common equity, excluding DVA(6)

10.7 % 4.6 % 9.5 % 6.1 %

Return on average tangible common equity, excluding DVA(9)

12.6 % 5.3 % 11.2 % 6.9 %

N/A—Not applicable

EMEA—Europe, Middle East and Africa

DVA—Debt Valuation Adjustment represents the change in the fair value of certain of the Company’s long-term and short-term borrowings resulting from the fluctuation in the Company’s credit spreads and other credit factors.

(1) See Notes 2, 3 and 15 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 of the Form 10-K and Notes 3 and 13 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for information on redeemable and nonredeemable noncontrolling interests.
(2) See Note 1 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for information on discontinued operations.
(3) For the calculation of basic and diluted earnings per share (“EPS”), see Note 14 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1.
(4) Regional net revenues reflect the regional view of the Company’s consolidated net revenues, on a managed basis. For further discussion regarding the geographic methodology for net revenues, see Note 18 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1.
(5) The computation of average common equity for each business segment is determined using the Company’s Required Capital framework (“Required Capital Framework”), an internal capital adequacy measure (see “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Requirements—Required Capital” herein). Average common equity for each business segment is a non-generally accepted accounting principle (“non-GAAP”) financial measure that the Company considers to be a useful measure to the Company and investors to assess capital adequacy.
(6) The calculation of each business segment’s return on average common equity uses income from continuing operations applicable to Morgan Stanley less preferred dividends as a percentage of each business segment’s average common equity. The return on average common equity is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company considers to be a useful measure to the Company and investors to assess operating performance. The effective tax rates used in the computation of business segments’ return on average common equity were determined on a separate legal entity basis. To determine the return on consolidated average common equity, excluding the impact of DVA, also a non-GAAP financial measure, both the numerator and the denominator were adjusted to exclude the impact of DVA. The impact of DVA for the quarters ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 was 0.6% and 0.8%, respectively, and the impact of DVA for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 was 0.6% and (0.2)%, respectively.
(7) Book value per common share equals common shareholders’ equity of $65,735 million at June 30, 2014 and $61,673 million at June 30, 2013 divided by common shares outstanding of 1,965 million at June 30, 2014 and 1,959 million at June 30, 2013.
(8) Average tangible common equity is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company considers to be a useful measure that the Company and investors use to assess capital adequacy. For a discussion of tangible common equity, see “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Capital Management” herein.
(9) Return on average tangible common equity is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company considers to be a useful measure that the Company and investors use to assess capital adequacy. The calculation of return on average tangible common equity uses income from continuing operations applicable to Morgan Stanley less preferred dividends as a percentage of average tangible common equity. To determine the return on average tangible common equity, excluding the impact of DVA, also a non-GAAP financial measure, both the numerator and the denominator were adjusted to exclude the impact of DVA. The impact of DVA for the quarters ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 was 0.7% and 1.0%, respectively, and the impact of DVA for the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 was 0.8% and (0.2)%, respectively.
(10) Tangible book value per common share equals tangible common equity of $56,004 million at June 30, 2014 and $51,479 million at June 30, 2013 divided by common shares outstanding of 1,965 million at June 30, 2014 and 1,959 million at June 30, 2013. Tangible book value per common share is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company considers to be a useful measure that the Company and investors use to assess capital adequacy.

LOGO 100


Table of Contents
(11) For a discussion of the effective income tax rate, see “Overview of the Quarter and Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 Financial Results” herein.
(12) Global Liquidity Reserve, which is held within the bank and non-bank legal entities, is comprised of highly liquid and diversified cash and cash equivalents and unencumbered securities. Eligible unencumbered securities include U.S. government securities, U.S. agency securities, U.S. agency mortgage-backed securities, non-U.S. government securities and other highly liquid investment grade securities. For a discussion of Global Liquidity Reserve, see “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Liquidity Risk Management Framework—Global Liquidity Reserve” herein.
(13) Morgan Stanley Bank, N.A. (“MSBNA”) and Morgan Stanley Private Bank, National Association (“MSPBNA”) represent the Company’s U.S. bank operating subsidiaries (“U.S. Banks”).
(14) At June 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company calculated its applicable Total capital, Tier 1 capital, Common Equity Tier 1 capital, Tier 1 common capital and Tier 1 leverage ratios and risk-weighted assets (“RWAs”) in accordance with the capital adequacy standards for financial holding companies adopted by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (the “Federal Reserve”). The standards applicable in 2013 included the U.S. banking regulators’ U.S. Basel I-based rules (“U.S. Basel I”) as supplemented by the U.S. banking regulators’ rules to implement the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision’s market risk capital framework amendment, commonly referred to as “Basel 2.5”. The Company’s Total capital, Tier 1 capital, Tier 1 common capital and Tier 1 leverage ratios and RWAs at June 30, 2013 were calculated under this revised framework. In the second quarter of 2014, the Company calculated the denominator of its risk-based capital ratios using an advanced internal ratings-based approach for calculating credit RWAs and advanced measurement approaches for calculating operational RWAs, as supplemented by advanced market RWAs calculated under U.S. Basel III (the “Advanced Approach”). For a further discussion of Total capital, Tier 1 capital, Common Equity Tier 1 capital and Tier 1 leverage ratios and RWAs, see “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Regulatory Requirements” herein.
(15) Beginning with the first quarter of 2014, Tier 1 leverage ratio equals Tier 1 capital (calculated under U.S. Basel III Transitional rules) divided by adjusted average total assets (which reflects adjustments for disallowed goodwill, transitional intangible assets, deferred tax assets, certain financial equity investments and other adjustments). In 2013, Tier 1 leverage ratio equaled Tier 1 capital (calculated under U.S. Basel I) divided by adjusted average total assets (which reflects adjustments for disallowed goodwill, certain intangible assets, deferred tax assets, and financial and non-financial equity investments).
(16) Revenues and expenses associated with these assets are included in the Company’s Wealth Management and Investment Management business segments.
(17) Amounts exclude the Investment Management business segment’s proportionate share of assets managed by entities in which it owns a minority stake.
(18) Pre-tax profit margin is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company considers to be a useful measure that the Company and investors use to assess operating performance. Percentages represent income from continuing operations before income taxes as a percentage of net revenues.
(19) From time to time, the Company may disclose certain “non-GAAP financial measures” in the course of its earnings releases, earnings conference calls, financial presentations and otherwise. For these purposes, “GAAP” refers to generally accepted accounting principles in the U.S. The U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission defines a “non-GAAP financial measure” as a numerical measure of historical or future financial performance, financial positions, or cash flows that excludes or includes amounts or is subject to adjustments that effectively exclude, or include, amounts from the most directly comparable measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP. Non-GAAP financial measures disclosed by the Company are provided as additional information to investors in order to provide them with further transparency about, or an alternative method for assessing, our financial condition and operating results. These measures are not in accordance with, or a substitute for, GAAP, and may be different from or inconsistent with non-GAAP financial measures used by other companies. Whenever the Company refers to a non-GAAP financial measure, the Company will also generally present the most directly comparable financial measure calculated and presented in accordance with GAAP, along with a reconciliation of the differences between the non-GAAP financial measure and the GAAP financial measure.

Three Months Ended

June 30,

Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013

Reconciliation of Selected Management Financial Measures from a Non-GAAP to a GAAP Basis (dollars in millions, except per share amounts):

Net revenues

Net revenues—non-GAAP

$ 8,521 $ 8,340 $ 17,342 $ 16,825

Impact of DVA

87 175 213 (142 )

Net revenues—GAAP

$ 8,608 $ 8,515 $ 17,555 $ 16,683

Income from continuing operations applicable to Morgan Stanley

Income applicable to Morgan Stanley—non-GAAP

$ 1,839 $ 900 $ 3,230 $ 2,082

Impact of DVA

61 111 136 (90 )

Income applicable to Morgan Stanley—GAAP

$ 1,900 $ 1,011 $ 3,366 $ 1,992

Earnings per diluted common share

Income from continuing operations per diluted common share—non-GAAP

$ 0.89 $ 0.37 $ 1.57 $ 0.97

Impact of DVA

0.03 0.06 0.07 (0.05 )

Income from continuing operations per diluted common share—GAAP

$ 0.92 $ 0.43 $ 1.64 $ 0.92

101 LOGO


Table of Contents

Global Market and Economic Conditions.

During the six months ended June 30, 2014, global market and economic conditions remained on an overall upward trend from 2013 year-end. The U.S. economy continued to show signs of growth during the six months ended June 30, 2014, despite a decline in real gross domestic product in the first quarter of the year. The U.S. employment situation continued to improve as evidenced by the decline in the unemployment rate. Inflation remained at historically low levels. The Eurozone economy continued its moderate recovery from a deep recession, but monetary and credit growth remained subdued. By contrast, the U.K. had a stronger-than-expected recovery and the current quarter marked its strongest calendar quarter in four years. Japan experienced stronger growth despite a drop in consumer spending resulting from a rise in the sales tax. In China, the government continued reforms to change the structure of the Chinese economy with the objective to maintain its current high growth rate. Elsewhere, emerging markets have experienced considerable volatility resulting in part from the Federal Reserve’s reduction of quantitative easing.

In the U.S., the NASDAQ, S&P 500 and Dow Jones Industrial Average indices ended the second quarter of 2014 higher compared with the beginning of the quarter and the year as the U.S. economy rebounded from severe winter weather. U.S. labor market conditions improved as the unemployment rate declined markedly from 6.7% at December 31, 2013 to 6.1% at June 30, 2014. During the quarter ended June 30, 2014, household spending rose moderately and business investment continued to increase. Despite this, the recovery in the housing market remained slow. New single-family housing starts declined slightly in the second quarter of 2014 compared to the prior quarter, while multifamily unit starts increased. Existing home sales and new home sales expanded. On June 17, 2014, the Federal Open Market Committee (“FOMC”) of the Federal Reserve stated that U.S. fiscal policy is restraining economic growth, although the extent of restraint is diminishing. Inflation remained low, with energy prices rising at a faster pace than in the preceding few months. The FOMC continues to keep key interest rates at historically low levels. At June 30, 2014, the federal funds target rate remained between 0.0% and 0.25%, while the discount rate remained at 0.75%. In June 2014, the FOMC announced its tentative plan to end quantitative easing with the final $15 billion reduction in monthly bond purchases in October 2014.

In Europe, major equity market indices were generally higher during the second quarter of 2014 compared with the beginning of the quarter. Euro-area gross domestic product continued to grow modestly in the second quarter of 2014. To further stimulate economic activity, the European Central Bank lowered its benchmark interest rate from 0.25% to a record low 0.15% during the quarter, despite persistently low inflation. The euro-area unemployment rate decreased to 11.5% at June 30, 2014 from 11.8% at December 31, 2013. At June 30, 2014, the Bank of England’s (“BOE”) benchmark interest rate was 0.5%, which was unchanged from December 31, 2013. The BOE also remained committed to an asset purchase program of £375 billon, also unchanged from December 31, 2013.

Major equity market indices in Asia ended the second quarter of 2014 higher compared with the beginning of the quarter, but lower compared with the beginning of the year, with the exception of the BSE Sensex index in India. Japan’s economic growth slowed during the second quarter of 2014 despite a series of economic stimulus packages announced by the Japanese government and the Bank of Japan. In an attempt to rein in public debt, Japan raised its consumption tax from 5% to 8% for the first time in seventeen years. China’s economic growth has increased from the prior quarter, and remains strong compared with the rest of the world. Nonetheless, the Chinese economy still faces downward pressure which the government hopes to counteract through targeted measures to boost growth. The Chinese government’s announced reforms reflect its intention to restructure its economy away from reliance on exports and investments and toward more sustainable growth driven by domestic consumption.

LOGO 102


Table of Contents

Overview of the Quarter and Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 Financial Results.

Consolidated Results .    The Company recorded net income applicable to Morgan Stanley of $1,899 million on net revenues of $8,608 million during the quarter ended June 30, 2014 (“current quarter”) compared with net income applicable to Morgan Stanley of $980 million on net revenues of $8,515 million during the quarter ended June 30, 2013 (“prior year quarter”).

Net revenues in the current quarter included positive revenues due to the impact of DVA of $87 million compared with positive revenues of $175 million in the prior year quarter. Non-interest expenses decreased 1% to $6,675 million in the current quarter compared with $6,719 million in the prior year quarter. Compensation expenses increased 2% to $4,200 million in the current quarter compared with $4,103 million in the prior year quarter. Non-compensation expenses decreased 5% to $2,475 million in the current quarter compared with $2,616 million in the prior year quarter.

Earnings per diluted common share (“diluted EPS”) and diluted EPS from continuing operations were $0.92 and $0.92, respectively, in the current quarter compared with $0.41 and $0.43, respectively, in the prior year quarter. The diluted EPS calculation for the prior year quarter included a negative adjustment of approximately $151 million, or $0.08 per diluted share, related to the purchase of the retail securities joint venture between the Company and Citigroup Inc. (“Citi”) (the “Wealth Management JV”), which was completed in June 2013.

Excluding the impact of DVA, net revenues were $8,521 million and diluted EPS from continuing operations was $0.89 per share in the current quarter compared with $8,340 million and $0.37 per share, respectively, in the prior year quarter.

For the six months ended June 30, 2014, the Company recorded net income applicable to Morgan Stanley of $3,404 million on net revenues of $17,555 million, compared with net income applicable to Morgan Stanley of $1,942 million on net revenues of $16,683 million in the prior year period. Non-interest expenses were $13,297 million in the six months ended June 30, 2014 and $13,286 million in the prior year period. Diluted EPS and diluted EPS from continuing operations were $1.66 and $1.64, respectively, in the six months ended June 30, 2014, compared with $0.89 and $0.92, respectively, in the prior year period.

The Company’s effective tax rate from continuing operations was 0.8% and 18.7% for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively. The results for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 included a discrete net tax benefit of $609 million principally associated with remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of a multi-year tax authority examination. Excluding this discrete net tax benefit, the effective tax rate from continuing operations for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 would have been 32.3% and 33.0%, respectively.

The Company’s effective tax rate from continuing operations was 32.0% and 27.2% for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, respectively. The results for the six months ended June 30, 2013 included a discrete net tax benefit of $142 million due to the retroactive effective date of the American Taxpayer Relief Act of 2012 (the “Relief Act”) and remeasurement of reserves and related interest based on new information regarding the status of certain tax authority examinations. Excluding these discrete net tax benefits, the effective tax rate from continuing operations for the six months ended June 30, 2013 would have been 31.4%. The effective tax rates excluding the discrete net tax benefits for the quarters and six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 are reflective of the geographic mix of earnings.

Institutional Securities .    Income from continuing operations before taxes was $961 million in the current quarter compared with $981 million in the prior year quarter. Net revenues for the current quarter were $4,248 million compared with $4,358 million in the prior year quarter. The results in the current quarter included positive revenues due to the impact of DVA of $87 million compared with positive revenues of $175 million in the prior year quarter. The presentation of net revenues excluding the impact of DVA is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company considers useful for the Company and investors to allow further comparability of period-to-

103 LOGO


Table of Contents

period operating performance. Investment banking revenues for the current quarter increased 33% from the prior year quarter to $1,432 million, reflecting increases across equity and fixed income underwriting and advisory revenues. Equity sales and trading net revenues, excluding the impact of DVA, of $1,789 million decreased 1% from the prior year quarter, primarily reflecting lower revenues in derivatives due to declines in client volumes and volatility, partially offset by a strong performance in prime brokerage. Excluding the impact of DVA, fixed income and commodities sales and trading net revenues of $1,011 million decreased 12% from the prior year quarter. The decrease primarily reflected revenue declines in foreign exchange products on lower levels of volatility, partially offset by higher results in securitized, credit and interest rate products and increased client demand for structured transactions in commodities. Non-interest expenses decreased 3% in the current quarter to $3,287 million, primarily due to lower compensation and benefits expenses and non-compensation expenses.

Wealth Management. Income from continuing operations before taxes was $767 million in the current quarter compared with $655 million in the prior year quarter. Net revenues were $3,715 million in the current quarter compared with $3,531 million in the prior year quarter. Transactional revenues, consisting of Trading, Commissions and fees and Investment banking decreased 5% from the prior year quarter to $991 million. Investment banking revenues decreased 17% from the prior year quarter to $213 million in the current quarter, primarily due to lower levels of underwriting activity in closed-end funds, partially offset by higher revenues from structured products, unit investment trusts and preferred stock underwriting. Trading revenues increased 20% from the prior year quarter to $267 million in the current quarter, primarily due to higher gains related to investments associated with certain employee deferred compensation plans and higher revenues from fixed income trading. Commissions and fees revenues decreased 10% from the prior year quarter to $511 million in the current quarter, primarily due to lower equity, insurance and mutual fund activity. Asset management, distribution and administration fees increased 9% from the prior year quarter to $2,064 million in the current quarter, primarily due to higher fee-based revenues, partially offset by lower revenues from referral fees from the bank deposit program. Net interest increased 30% from the prior year quarter to $578 million in the current quarter, primarily due to higher bank deposit balances and higher lending balances. Total client asset balances were $2,002 billion and total client liability balances were $45 billion at June 30, 2014. Balances in the bank deposit program were $127 billion at both June 30, 2014 and 2013 which included deposits held by Company-affiliated Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (“FDIC”) insured depository institutions of $109 billion at June 30, 2014 and $70 billion at June 30, 2013. Client assets in fee-based accounts were $762 billion, or 38% of total client assets at June 30, 2014. Fee-based client asset flows for the current quarter were $12.5 billion compared with $10.0 billion in the prior year quarter. Non-interest expenses were $2,948 million in the current quarter compared with $2,876 million in the prior year quarter.

Investment Management. Income from continuing operations before taxes was $205 million in the current quarter compared with $160 million in the prior year quarter. Net revenues were $692 million in the current quarter compared with $673 million in the prior year quarter. The increase in net revenues reflected higher net investment gains predominantly within the Company’s Merchant Banking and Traditional Asset Management businesses, partially offset by lower gains on investments in the Real Estate Investing business, driven by the deconsolidation of certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund sponsored by the Company. Non-interest expenses were $487 million in the current quarter compared with $513 million in the prior year quarter.

LOGO 104


Table of Contents

Business Segments.

Substantially all of the Company’s operating revenues and operating expenses are directly attributable to its business segments. Certain revenues and expenses have been allocated to each business segment, generally in proportion to its respective net revenues, non-interest expenses or other relevant measures.

As a result of treating certain intersegment transactions as transactions with external parties, the Company includes an Intersegment Eliminations category to reconcile the business segment results to the Company’s consolidated results. Intersegment Eliminations also reflect the effect of fees paid by the Institutional Securities business segment to the Wealth Management business segment related to the bank deposit program.

Net Revenues .

Trading. Trading revenues include revenues from customers’ purchases and sales of financial instruments in which the Company acts as a market maker as well as gains and losses on the Company’s related positions. Trading revenues include the realized gains and losses from sales of cash instruments and derivative settlements, unrealized gains and losses from ongoing fair value changes of the Company’s positions related to market-making activities, and gains and losses related to investments associated with certain employee deferred compensation plans. In many markets, the realized and unrealized gains and losses from the purchase and sale transactions will include any spreads between bids and offers. Certain fees received on loans carried at fair value and dividends from equity securities are also recorded in this line item since they relate to market-making positions. Commissions received for purchasing and selling listed equity securities and options are recorded separately in the Commissions and fees line item. Other cash and derivative instruments typically do not have fees associated with them, and fees for related services would be recorded in Commissions and fees.

The Company often invests directly, as a principal, in investments or other financial instruments to economically hedge its obligations under its deferred compensation plans. Changes in value of such investments made by the Company are recorded in Trading revenues and Investments revenues. Expenses associated with the related deferred compensation plans are recorded in Compensation and benefits. Compensation expense is calculated based on the notional value of the award granted, adjusted for upward and downward changes in fair value of the referenced investment and is recognized ratably over the prescribed vesting period for the award. Generally, changes in compensation expense resulting from changes in fair value of the referenced investment will be offset by changes in fair value of investments made by the Company. However, there may be a timing difference between the immediate revenue recognition of gains and losses on the Company’s investments and the deferred recognition of the related compensation expense over the vesting period.

As a market maker, the Company stands ready to buy, sell or otherwise transact with customers under a variety of market conditions and provide firm or indicative prices in response to customer requests. The Company’s liquidity obligations can be explicit and obligatory in some cases, and in others, customers expect the Company to be willing to transact with them. In order to most effectively fulfill its market-making function, the Company engages in activities, across all of its trading businesses, that include, but are not limited to: (i) taking positions in anticipation of, and in response to, customer demand to buy or sell and—depending on the liquidity of the relevant market and the size of the position—to hold those positions for a period of time; (ii) managing and assuming basis risk (risk associated with imperfect hedging) between customized customer risks and the standardized products available in the market to hedge those risks; (iii) building, maintaining and rebalancing inventory, through trades with other market participants, and engaging in accumulation activities to accommodate anticipated customer demand; (iv) trading in the market to remain current on pricing and trends; and (v) engaging in other activities to provide efficiency and liquidity for markets. Although not included in Trading revenues, interest income and expense are also impacted by market-making activities as debt securities held by the Company earn interest and securities are loaned, borrowed, sold with agreement to repurchase and purchased with agreement to resell.

105 LOGO


Table of Contents

Investments. The Company’s investments generally are held for long-term appreciation and generally are subject to significant sales restrictions. Estimates of the fair value of the investments may involve significant judgment and may fluctuate significantly over time in light of business, market, economic and financial conditions generally or in relation to specific transactions. In some cases, such investments are required or are a necessary part of offering other products. The revenues recorded are the result of realized gains and losses from sales and unrealized gains and losses from ongoing fair value changes of the Company’s holdings as well as from investments associated with certain employee deferred compensation plans (as mentioned above). Typically, there are no fee revenues from these investments. The sales restrictions on the investments relate primarily to redemption and withdrawal restrictions on investments in real estate funds, hedge funds and private equity funds, which include investments made in connection with certain employee deferred compensation plans (see Note 4 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1). Restrictions on interests in exchanges and clearinghouses generally include a requirement to hold those interests for the period of time that the Company is clearing trades on that exchange or clearinghouse. Additionally, there are certain investments related to assets held by consolidated real estate funds, which are primarily related to holders of noncontrolling interests.

Commissions and Fees. Commission and fee revenues primarily arise from agency transactions in listed and over-the-counter (“OTC”) equity securities, services related to sales and trading activities, and sales of mutual funds, futures, insurance products and options.

Asset Management, Distribution and Administration Fees. Asset management, distribution and administration fees include fees associated with the management and supervision of assets, account services and administration, performance-based fees relating to certain funds, separately managed accounts, shareholder servicing and the distribution of certain open-ended mutual funds.

Asset management, distribution and administration fees in the Wealth Management business segment also include revenues from individual investors electing a fee-based pricing arrangement and fees for investment management. Mutual fund distribution fees in the Wealth Management business segment are based on either the average daily fund net asset balances or average daily aggregate net fund sales and are affected by changes in the overall level and mix of assets under management or supervision.

Asset management fees in the Investment Management business segment arise from investment management services the Company provides to investment vehicles pursuant to various contractual arrangements. The Company receives fees primarily based upon mutual fund daily average net assets or based on monthly or quarterly invested equity for other vehicles. Performance-based fees in the Investment Management business segment are earned on certain funds as a percentage of appreciation earned by those funds and, in certain cases, are based upon the achievement of performance criteria. These fees are normally earned annually and are recognized on a monthly or quarterly basis.

Net Interest. Interest income and Interest expense are a function of the level and mix of total assets and liabilities, including trading assets and trading liabilities; available for sale securities (“AFS Securities”); securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell; securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase; loans; deposits; commercial paper and other short-term borrowings; long-term borrowings; trading strategies; customer activity in the Company’s prime brokerage business; and the prevailing level, term structure and volatility of interest rates. Certain Securities purchased under agreements to resell (“reverse repurchase agreements”) and Securities sold under agreements to repurchase (“repurchase agreements”) and Securities borrowed and Securities loaned transactions may be entered into with different customers using the same underlying securities, thereby generating a spread between the interest revenues on the reverse repurchase agreements or securities borrowed transactions and the interest expense on the repurchase agreements or securities loaned transactions.

LOGO 106


Table of Contents

Compensation Expense .

The Company’s compensation and benefits expense includes accruals for base salaries, formulaic programs, estimated discretionary incentive compensation, amortization of deferred cash and equity awards, changes in fair value of deferred compensation plan referenced investments and other items such as health and welfare benefits. The factors that drive compensation for the Company’s employees vary from quarter to quarter, segment to segment, and within a segment. For certain revenue-producing employees in the Company’s Wealth Management and Investment Management business segments, their compensation is largely paid on the basis of formulaic payouts that link their compensation to revenue. Compensation for certain employees, including revenue-producing employees in the Company’s Institutional Securities business segment, may also include incentive compensation that is determined following the assessment of the Company, business unit and individual performance. Compensation for the Company’s remaining employees is largely fixed in nature ( e.g. , base salary, benefits, etc.).

107 LOGO


Table of Contents

INSTITUTIONAL SECURITIES

INCOME STATEMENT INFORMATION

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Revenues:

Investment banking

$ 1,432 $ 1,078 $ 2,568 $ 2,023

Trading

2,257 2,598 4,964 5,012

Investments

62 51 171 193

Commissions and fees

629 650 1,307 1,258

Asset management, distribution and administration fees

66 69 147 135

Other

108 152 249 303

Total non-interest revenues

4,554 4,598 9,406 8,924

Interest income

758 875 1,639 1,845

Interest expense

1,064 1,115 2,170 2,312

Net interest

(306 ) (240 ) (531 ) (467 )

Net revenues

4,248 4,358 8,875 8,457

Compensation and benefits

1,723 1,764 3,574 3,654

Non-compensation expenses

1,564 1,613 2,969 3,005

Total non-interest expenses

3,287 3,377 6,543 6,659

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

961 981 2,332 1,798

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

(344 ) 307 77 386

Income from continuing operations

1,305 674 2,255 1,412

Discontinued operations:

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes

(7 ) (30 ) 36 (60 )

Provision for (benefit from) income taxes

(3 ) (10 ) 2 (21 )

Income (losses) from discontinued operations

(4 ) (20 ) 34 (39 )

Net income

1,301 654 2,289 1,373

Net income applicable to redeemable noncontrolling interests

1

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

11 90 36 186

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 1,290 $ 564 $ 2,253 $ 1,186

Amounts applicable to Morgan Stanley:

Income from continuing operations

$ 1,294 $ 584 $ 2,219 $ 1,225

Income (losses) from discontinued operations

(4 ) (20 ) 34 (39 )

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 1,290 $ 564 $ 2,253 $ 1,186

LOGO 108


Table of Contents

Investment Banking. Investment banking revenues were as follows:

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Advisory revenues

$ 418 $ 333 $ 754 $ 584

Underwriting revenues:

Equity underwriting revenues

489 327 804 610

Fixed income underwriting revenues

525 418 1,010 829

Total underwriting revenues

1,014 745 1,814 1,439

Total investment banking revenues

$ 1,432 $ 1,078 $ 2,568 $ 2,023

The following table presents the Company’s volumes of announced and completed mergers and acquisitions, equity and equity-related offerings, and fixed income offerings:

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014(1) 2013(1) 2014(1) 2013(1)
(dollars in billions)

Announced mergers and acquisitions(2)

$ 311 $ 94 $ 526 $ 170

Completed mergers and acquisitions(2)

98 142 303 335

Equity and equity-related offerings(3)

18 15 34 29

Fixed income offerings(4)

78 70 144 141

(1) Source: Thomson Reuters, data at July 16, 2014. Announced and completed mergers and acquisitions volumes are based on full credit to each of the advisors in a transaction. Equity and equity-related offerings and fixed income offerings are based on full credit for single book managers and equal credit for joint book managers. Transaction volumes may not be indicative of net revenues in a given period. In addition, transaction volumes for prior periods may vary from amounts previously reported due to the subsequent withdrawal or change in the value of a transaction.
(2) Amounts include transactions of $100 million or more. Announced mergers and acquisitions exclude terminated transactions.
(3) Amounts include Rule 144A and public common stock, convertible and rights offerings.
(4) Amounts include non-convertible preferred stock, mortgage-backed and asset-backed securities and taxable municipal debt. Amounts also include publicly registered and Rule 144A issues. Amounts exclude leveraged loans and self-led issuances.

Investment banking revenues for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 increased 33% from the comparable period in 2013, reflecting increases across equity and fixed income underwriting and advisory revenues. Overall, underwriting revenues of $1,014 million increased 36% from the quarter ended June 30, 2013. Equity underwriting revenues increased 50% to $489 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014, reflecting increased activity in EMEA and the Americas. Fixed income underwriting revenues were $525 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014, an increase of 26% from the comparable period in 2013, reflecting a continued favorable debt underwriting environment. Advisory revenues from merger, acquisition and restructuring transactions (“M&A”) were $418 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014, an increase of 26% from the comparable period of 2013, reflecting higher levels of M&A activity across all regions. Industry-wide announced M&A activity for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 increased compared with the quarter ended June 30, 2013, with increases driven out of EMEA and the Americas as deals sized over $5 billion increased.

Investment banking revenues for the six months ended June 30, 2014 increased 27% from the comparable period in 2013, primarily due to higher revenues from equity and fixed income underwriting transactions reflecting higher equity market volumes in EMEA as well as a continued favorable debt underwriting environment. Advisory revenues were higher resulting from increased M&A activity driven out of the Americas.

Sales and Trading Net Revenues. Sales and trading net revenues are composed of Trading revenues; Commissions and fees; Asset management, distribution and administration fees; and Net interest revenues

109 LOGO


Table of Contents

(expenses). See “Business Segments—Net Revenues” herein for information about the composition of the above-referenced components of sales and trading revenues. In assessing the profitability of its sales and trading activities, the Company views these net revenues in the aggregate. In addition, decisions relating to trading are based on an overall review of aggregate revenues and costs associated with each transaction or series of transactions. This review includes, among other things, an assessment of the potential gain or loss associated with a transaction, including any associated commissions and fees, dividends, the interest income or expense associated with financing or hedging the Company’s positions, and other related expenses. See Note 10 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for further information related to gains (losses) on derivative instruments.

Sales and trading net revenues were as follows:

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013(1) 2014 2013(1)
(dollars in millions)

Trading

$ 2,257 $ 2,598 $ 4,964 $ 5,012

Commissions and fees

629 650 1,307 1,258

Asset management, distribution and administration fees

66 69 147 135

Net interest

(306 ) (240 ) (531 ) (467 )

Total sales and trading net revenues

$ 2,646 $ 3,077 $ 5,887 $ 5,938

(1) All prior-period amounts have been recast to conform to the current year’s presentation. For further information, see Note 1 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1.

Sales and trading net revenues by business were as follows:

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013(1) 2014 2013(1)
(dollars in millions)

Equity

$ 1,826 $ 1,917 $ 3,581 $ 3,429

Fixed income and commodities

1,061 1,214 2,791 2,491

Other(2)

(241 ) (54 ) (485 ) 18

Total sales and trading net revenues

$ 2,646 $ 3,077 $ 5,887 $ 5,938

(1) All prior-period amounts have been recast to conform to the current year’s presentation. For further information, see Note 1 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1.
(2) Other sales and trading net revenues include net losses associated with costs related to the amount of liquidity held (“negative carry”), net gains (losses) on economic hedges related to the Company’s long-term debt and net gains (losses) from certain loans and lending commitments and related hedges associated with the Company’s lending activities.

Total sales and trading net revenues decreased to $2,646 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 from $3,077 million in the comparable period in 2013, reflecting lower revenues in fixed income and commodities, equity sales and trading and other sales and trading net revenues.

LOGO 110


Table of Contents

The following sales and trading net revenues results exclude the impact of DVA (see footnote 2 in the following table). The reconciliation of sales and trading, including equity sales and trading and fixed income and commodities sales and trading net revenues, from a non-GAAP to a GAAP basis is as follows:

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013(1) 2014 2013(1)
(dollars in millions)

Total sales and trading net revenues—non-GAAP(2)

$ 2,559 $ 2,902 $ 5,674 $ 6,080

Impact of DVA

87 175 213 (142 )

Total sales and trading net revenues

$ 2,646 $ 3,077 $ 5,887 $ 5,938

Equity sales and trading net revenues—non-GAAP(2)

$ 1,789 $ 1,803 $ 3,494 $ 3,394

Impact of DVA

37 114 87 35

Equity sales and trading net revenues

$ 1,826 $ 1,917 $ 3,581 $ 3,429

Fixed income and commodities sales and trading net revenues —non-GAAP(2)

$ 1,011 $ 1,153 $ 2,665 $ 2,668

Impact of DVA

50 61 126 (177 )

Fixed income and commodities sales and trading net revenues

$ 1,061 $ 1,214 $ 2,791 $ 2,491

(1) All prior-period amounts have been recast to conform to the current year’s presentation. For further information, see Note 1 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1.
(2) Sales and trading net revenues, including equity and fixed income and commodities sales and trading net revenues that exclude the impact of DVA, are non-GAAP financial measures that the Company considers useful for the Company and investors to allow further comparability of period-to-period operating performance.

Equity. Equity sales and trading net revenues decreased 5% to $1,826 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period in 2013. The results in equity sales and trading net revenues included positive revenue due to the impact of DVA of $37 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 compared with positive revenue of $114 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2013. Equity sales and trading net revenues, excluding the impact of DVA, decreased 1% to $1,789 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period in 2013, reflecting lower revenues in derivatives due to declines in client volumes and volatility, partially offset by a strong performance in prime brokerage.

Changes in the fair value of net derivative contracts attributable to the changes in counterparties’ and the Company’s credit default swap (“CDS”) spreads and other factors did not have a material impact on equity sales and trading net revenues for the quarters and six months ended June 30, 2014 and June 30, 2013, respectively.

Fixed Income and Commodities. Fixed income and commodities sales and trading net revenues decreased 13% to $1,061 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 from $1,214 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2013. Results in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 included positive revenue of $50 million due to the impact of DVA compared with positive revenue of $61 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2013. Fixed income and commodities sales and trading net revenues, excluding the impact of DVA, in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 decreased 12% over the comparable period in 2013. Commodity net revenues, excluding the impact of DVA, increased 15% (inclusive of net revenues in the Company’s global oil merchanting business and TransMontaigne Inc.) primarily reflecting increased client demand for structured transactions (see also “Global Oil Merchanting Business and TransMontaigne” herein). Fixed income product net revenues, excluding the impact of DVA, decreased 17% primarily reflecting revenue declines in foreign exchange products on lower levels of volatility, partially offset by higher results in securitized, credit and interest rate products.

In the quarter ended June 30, 2014, fixed income and commodities sales and trading net revenues reflected gains of $36 million related to changes in the fair value of net derivative contracts attributable to the tightening of

111 LOGO


Table of Contents

counterparties’ CDS spreads and other factors compared with gains of $56 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2013. The Company also recorded losses of $74 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 related to changes in the fair value of net derivative contracts attributable to the tightening of the Company’s CDS spreads and other factors compared with gains of $125 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2013, due to the widening of such spreads and other factors. The gains and losses on CDS spreads and other factors include gains and losses on related hedging instruments.

Other. In addition to the equity and fixed income and commodities sales and trading net revenues discussed above, sales and trading net revenues included other trading revenues, consisting of costs related to negative carry, gains (losses) on economic hedges related to the Company’s long-term borrowings and certain activities associated with the Company’s corporate lending activities.

Other sales and trading negative net revenues were $241 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 compared with negative net revenues of $54 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2013, primarily due to higher losses on economic hedges and other costs related to the Company’s long-term borrowings. In addition, results in the quarters ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 also included net revenues of $58 million and $119 million, respectively, associated with corporate loans and lending commitments.

Sales and Trading Net Revenues in the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014. Total sales and trading revenues decreased 1% in the six months ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period of 2013.

Equity sales and trading net revenues increased 4% to $3,581 million in the six months ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period in 2013. The results in equity sales and trading net revenues included positive revenue in the six months ended June 30, 2014 of $87 million due to the impact of DVA compared with positive revenue of approximately $35 million in the six months ended June 30, 2013. Equity sales and trading net revenues, excluding the impact of DVA, in the six months ended June 30, 2014 increased 3% over the comparable period in 2013, primarily due to higher revenues in the prime brokerage business.

Fixed income and commodities sales and trading net revenues increased 12% to $2,791 million in the six months ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period in 2013. Results in the six months ended June 30, 2014 included positive revenue of $126 million due to the impact of DVA, compared with negative revenue of $177 million in the six months ended June 30, 2013. Fixed income and commodities sales and trading net revenues, excluding the impact of DVA, in the six months ended June 30, 2014 were relatively unchanged from the comparable period in 2013 as higher results in commodity net revenues were offset by lower fixed income product revenues. In the six months ended June 30, 2014, Commodity net revenues, excluding the impact of DVA, increased 146% (inclusive of increased net revenues from the Company’s global oil merchanting business and TransMontaigne Inc.) primarily reflecting broad based strength across energy products, driven by increased client demand and extreme weather in the northeast U.S. early in the year (see “Global Oil Merchanting Business and TransMontaigne” herein). Fixed income product net revenues, excluding the impact of DVA, decreased 19% primarily related to declines in foreign exchange on lower levels of volatility.

In the six months ended June 30, 2014, other sales and trading recognized negative net revenues of $485 million compared with net revenues of $18 million in the six months ended June 30, 2013. Results in both periods included losses related to negative carry and losses on economic hedges and other costs related to the Company’s long-term borrowings. Results in both periods also included net revenues from corporate loans and lending commitments, which were $103 million and $324 million in the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.

Investments. Net investment gains of $62 million and $171 million were recognized in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, compared with net investment gains of $51 million and $193 million in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, respectively. The results in all periods primarily included mark-to-market gains on principal investments and net gains from investments associated with the Company’s deferred compensation and co-investment plans.

LOGO 112


Table of Contents

Other. Other revenues of $108 million and $249 million were recognized in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, compared with other revenues of $152 million and $303 million in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, respectively. The results in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, primarily included income of $34 million and $91 million, respectively, arising from the Company’s 40% stake in Mitsubishi UFJ Morgan Stanley Securities Co., Ltd., compared with income of $174 million and $299 million, in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, respectively (see Note 19 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1). In the first quarter of 2014, Other revenues included the sale of property related to TransMontaigne Inc.

Non-interest Expenses.

Non-interest expenses decreased 3% and 2% in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, compared with the prior year periods. The decrease in both periods was primarily due to lower compensation and benefits expenses and non-compensation expenses. Compensation and benefits expenses decreased 2% in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014. The decrease in the quarter was primarily due to lower estimated discretionary incentive-based compensation, partially offset by an increase in base salaries and an increase in the fair value of deferred compensation plan referenced investments. In the six months ended June 30, 2014, the decrease was primarily due to lower estimated discretionary incentive-based compensation and lower severance expenses, partially offset by an increase in base salaries. Non-compensation expenses decreased 3% and 1% in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, compared with the prior year periods, primarily due to lower litigation expenses.

Discontinued Operations.

On March 27, 2014, the Company completed the sale of Canterm Canadian Terminals Inc. (“CanTerm”), a public storage terminal operator for refined products with two distribution terminals in Canada. The results of CanTerm are reported as discontinued operations within the Institutional Securities business segment for all periods presented.

For a discussion about discontinued operations, see Note 1 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1.

Nonredeemable Noncontrolling Interests.

Nonredeemable noncontrolling interests primarily relate to Mitsubishi UFJ Financial Group, Inc.’s (“MUFG’s”) interest in Morgan Stanley MUFG Securities Co., Ltd. (“MSMS”) (see Note 19 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1).

Global Oil Merchanting Business and TransMontaigne.

On December 20, 2013, the Company and a subsidiary of Rosneft Oil Company (“Rosneft”) entered into a Purchase Agreement pursuant to which the Company will sell the global oil merchanting unit of its commodities division to Rosneft. The transaction is subject to regulatory approvals and other customary conditions and is expected to close in the second half of 2014. At June 30, 2014, this business is held for sale, but it does not meet the criteria for discontinued operations due to potentially significant continuing involvement with transitional services.

On July 1, 2014, the Company completed the sale of its ownership stake in TransMontaigne Inc., a U.S.-based oil storage, marketing and transportation company, to NGL Energy Partners LP. The gain on sale will be reflected in the third quarter of 2014 and is not expected to be material to the Company’s results of operations.

113 LOGO


Table of Contents

WEALTH MANAGEMENT

INCOME STATEMENT INFORMATION

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Revenues:

Investment banking

$ 213 $ 258 $ 394 $ 532

Trading

267 223 542 521

Investments

2 2 6 5

Commissions and fees

511 567 1,051 1,126

Asset management, distribution and administration fees

2,064 1,896 4,085 3,754

Other

80 139 142 204

Total non-interest revenues

3,137 3,085 6,220 6,142

Interest income

616 511 1,197 999

Interest expense

38 65 80 140

Net interest

578 446 1,117 859

Net revenues

3,715 3,531 7,337 7,001

Compensation and benefits

2,186 2,042 4,355 4,107

Non-compensation expenses

762 834 1,524 1,642

Total non-interest expenses

2,948 2,876 5,879 5,749

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

767 655 1,458 1,252

Provision for income taxes

296 229 564 449

Income from continuing operations

471 426 894 803

Discontinued operations:

Income (loss) from discontinued operations before income taxes

(1 )

Provision for income taxes

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(1 )

Net income

471 426 894 802

Net income applicable to redeemable noncontrolling interests

100 221

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 471 $ 326 $ 894 $ 581

Amounts applicable to Morgan Stanley:

Income from continuing operations

$ 471 $ 326 $ 894 $ 582

Income (loss) from discontinued operations

(1 )

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 471 $ 326 $ 894 $ 581

LOGO 114


Table of Contents

Statistical Data (dollars in billions, except where noted).

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013

Annualized revenues per representative (dollars in thousands)(1)

$ 908 $ 866 $ 895 $ 858

Fee-based asset flows(2)

$ 12.5 $ 10.0 $ 31.5 $ 25.3

At
June 30,
2014 2013

Wealth Management representatives at June 30, 2014 and 2013

16,316 16,321

Client assets

$ 2,002 $ 1,778

Client liabilities

$ 45 $ 34

Fee-based client assets(3)

$ 762 $ 629

Fee-based client assets as a percentage of total client assets(3)

38 % 35 %

Bank deposit program at June 30, 2014 and 2013(4)

$ 127 $ 127

Client assets per representative (dollars in millions)(5)

$ 123 $ 109

Retail locations at June 30, 2014 and 2013

636 676

Wealth Management U.S. Bank data(6):

AFS Securities portfolio

$ 56.5 $ 42.8

(1) Annualized revenues per representative for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 equal the Wealth Management business segment’s annualized revenues divided by the average representative headcount for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively.
(2) Fee-based asset flows include dividends, interest and client fees and exclude cash management related activity.
(3) Fee-based client assets represent the amount of assets in client accounts where the basis of payment for services is a fee calculated on those assets.
(4) Balances in the bank deposit program included deposits held by the Company’s U.S. Banks of $109 billion and $70 billion at June 30, 2014 and 2013, respectively, with the remainder held at Citi-affiliated FDIC insured depositories. See Note 3 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for further discussion of the Company’s customer deposits held by Citi.
(5) Client assets per representative equal total period-end client assets divided by period-end representative headcount.
(6) Wealth Management U.S. Bank refers to the Company’s U.S. bank operating subsidiaries MSBNA and MSPBNA.

Wealth Management JV. On June 28, 2013, the Company completed the purchase of the remaining 35% stake in the Wealth Management JV for $4.725 billion. As the 100% owner of the Wealth Management JV, the Company retains all of the related net income previously applicable to the noncontrolling interests in the Wealth Management JV, and benefit from the termination of certain related debt and operating agreements with the Wealth Management JV partner.

Concurrent with the acquisition of the remaining 35% stake in the Wealth Management JV, the deposit sweep agreement between Citi and the Company was terminated. During the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, $5 billion and $10 billion, respectively, of deposits held by Citi relating to customer accounts were transferred to the Company’s depository institutions. At June 30, 2014, approximately $18 billion of additional deposits are scheduled to be transferred to the Company’s depository institutions on an agreed-upon basis through June 2015.

For further information, see Note 3 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1.

115 LOGO


Table of Contents

Net Revenues. The Wealth Management business segment’s net revenues are comprised of Transactional, Asset management, Net interest and Other revenues. Transactional revenues include Investment banking, Trading, and Commissions and fees. Asset management revenues include Asset management, distribution and administration fees, and referral fees related to the bank deposit program. Net interest revenues include interest related to the bank deposit program, interest on AFS Securities, interest on lending activities and other net interest. Other revenues include revenues from AFS Securities, customer account services fees, other miscellaneous revenues and revenues from Investments.

Three Months Ended Six Months Ended
June 30, June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Net revenues:

Transactional

$ 991 $ 1,048 $ 1,987 $ 2,179

Asset management

2,064 1,896 4,085 3,754

Net interest

578 446 1,117 859

Other

82 141 148 209

Net revenues

$ 3,715 $ 3,531 $ 7,337 $ 7,001

Transactional.

Investment Banking. Investment banking revenues decreased 17% to $213 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period of 2013, and decreased 26% to $394 million in the six months ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period of 2013, primarily due to lower levels of underwriting activity in closed-end funds. The decrease in the quarter ended June 30, 2014, was partially offset by higher revenues from structured products, unit investment trusts and preferred stock underwriting.

Trading. Trading revenues increased 20% to $267 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period of 2013, and increased 4% to $542 million in the six months ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period of 2013, primarily due to higher gains related to investments associated with certain employee deferred compensation plans and higher revenues from fixed income trading.

Commissions and Fees. Commissions and fees revenues decreased 10% to $511 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period of 2013, and decreased 7% to $1,051 million in the six months ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period of 2013, primarily due to lower equity, insurance and mutual fund activity.

Asset Management.

Asset Management, Distribution and Administration Fees. Asset management, distribution and administration fees increased 9% to $2,064 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period of 2013, and increased 9% to $4,085 million in the six months ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period of 2013, primarily due to higher fee-based revenues, partially offset by lower revenues from referral fees from the bank deposit program. The referral fees for deposits placed with Citi-affiliated depository institutions declined to $23 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 from $68 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2013. The referral fees for deposits placed with Citi-affiliated depository institutions declined to $51 million in the six months ended June 30, 2014 from $156 million in the six months ended June 30, 2013. The decline in both periods was due to the ongoing transfer of deposits to the Company from Citi.

Balances in the bank deposit program were $127 billion at both June 30, 2014 and 2013 which included deposits held by the Company’s U.S. Banks of $109 billion at June 30, 2014 and $70 billion at June 30, 2013.

LOGO 116


Table of Contents

Client assets in fee-based accounts increased to $762 billion and represented 38% of total client assets at June 30, 2014 compared with $629 billion and 35% at June 30, 2013, respectively. Total client asset balances increased to $2,002 billion at June 30, 2014 from $1,778 billion at June 30, 2013, primarily due to the impact of market appreciation and favorable flows. Fee-based client asset flows for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 were $12.5 billion compared with $10.0 billion in the quarter ended June 30, 2013.

Net Interest.

Net interest increased 30% to $578 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period of 2013, and increased 30% to $1,117 million in the six months ended June 30, 2014 from the comparable period of 2013, primarily due to higher bank deposit balances and higher lending balances. Total client liability balances increased to $45 billion at June 30, 2014 from $34 billion at June 30, 2013, primarily due to higher growth from Portfolio Loan Account (“PLA”) securities-based lending products and residential mortgage loans. The loans and lending commitments in the Company’s Wealth Management business segment have grown in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, and the Company expects this trend to continue. See “Business Segments—Lending Activities” herein and “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Credit Risk” in Item 3. In addition, interest expense declined in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 due to the Company’s redemption of all the Class A Preferred Interests owned by Citi and its affiliates, in connection with the Company’s acquisition of 100% ownership of the Wealth Management JV effective at the end of the second quarter of 2013.

Other.

Other revenues were $80 million and $142 million in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, a decrease of 42% and 30% from the comparable periods of 2013, primarily due to lower gains on sales of the AFS Securities portfolio and a gain on sale of the global stock plan business in the prior year period.

Non-interest Expenses.

Non-interest expenses increased 3% and 2% in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, from the comparable periods of 2013. Compensation and benefits expenses increased 7% and 6% in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, from the comparable periods of 2013, primarily due to a higher formulaic payout to Wealth Management representatives linked to higher net revenues and by an increase in the fair value of deferred compensation plan referenced investments. Non-compensation expenses decreased 9% and 7% in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, from the comparable periods of 2013, primarily due to costs incurred in the prior year periods in conjunction with the purchase of the remaining interest in the Wealth Management JV. Information processing and communication expenses decreased 26% and 16% in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, from the comparable periods of 2013, primarily due to lower technology infrastructure costs. Other expenses decreased 17% and 14% in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, from the comparable periods of 2013, primarily due to lower amortization expense and a $14 million insurance recovery. The decrease in the six months ended June 30, 2014 was also due to a lower FDIC assessment on deposits.

117 LOGO


Table of Contents

INVESTMENT MANAGEMENT

INCOME STATEMENT INFORMATION

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in millions)

Revenues:

Investment banking

$ 1 $ 1 $ 5 $ 6

Trading

(6 ) 53 (26 ) 47

Investments

163 135 409 328

Asset management, distribution and administration fees

518 473 991 928

Other

24 12 66 14

Total non-interest revenues

700 674 1,445 1,323

Interest income

1 3 2 5

Interest expense

9 4 15 10

Net interest

(8 ) (1 ) (13 ) (5 )

Net revenues

692 673 1,432 1,318

Compensation and benefits

291 297 576 556

Non-compensation expenses

196 216 388 415

Total non-interest expenses

487 513 964 971

Income from continuing operations before income taxes

205 160 468 347

Provision for income taxes

63 38 154 90

Income from continuing operations

142 122 314 257

Discontinued operations:

Income from discontinued operations before income taxes

5 6 1

Provision for income taxes

2 2

Income from discontinued operations

3 4 1

Net income

145 122 318 258

Net income applicable to nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

7 21 61 72

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 138 $ 101 $ 257 $ 186

Amounts applicable to Morgan Stanley:

Income from continuing operations

$ 135 $ 101 $ 253 $ 185

Income from discontinued operations

3 4 1

Net income applicable to Morgan Stanley

$ 138 $ 101 $ 257 $ 186

LOGO 118


Table of Contents

Statistical Data.

The Investment Management business segment’s period-end and average assets under management or supervision were as follows:

At
June 30,
Average for the
Three  Months Ended
June 30,
Average for the
Six  Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in billions)

Assets under management or supervision by asset class:

Traditional Asset Management:

Equity

$ 150 $ 125 $ 146 $ 128 $ 144 $ 127

Fixed income

62 59 62 62 61 62

Liquidity

121 106 117 100 115 101

Alternatives(1)

35 29 34 29 33 28

Total Traditional Asset Management

368 319 359 319 353 318

Real Estate Investing

20 20 20 20 21 20

Merchant Banking

8 8 8 9 8 9

Total assets under management or supervision

$ 396 $ 347 $ 387 $ 348 $ 382 $ 347

Share of minority stake assets(2)

$ 7 $ 6 $ 7 $ 6 $ 7 $ 6

(1) The alternatives asset class includes a range of investment products such as funds of hedge funds, funds of private equity funds and funds of real estate funds.
(2) Amounts represent the Investment Management business segment’s proportional share of assets managed by entities in which it owns a minority stake.

Activity in the Investment Management business segment’s assets under management or supervision during the quarters and six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013 was as follows:

Three Months Ended
June 30,
Six Months Ended
June 30,
2014 2013 2014 2013
(dollars in billions)

Balance at beginning of period

$ 382 $ 341 $ 373 $ 338

Net flows by asset class:

Traditional Asset Management:

Equity

1 4

Fixed income

(2 ) (1 )

Liquidity

7 11 9 6

Alternatives(1)

1 1 3 1

Total Traditional Asset Management

9 10 15 7

Real Estate Investing

(2 ) (1 ) (2 ) (1 )

Merchant Banking

1 1 1 1

Total net flows

8 10 14 7

Net market appreciation (depreciation)

6 (4 ) 9 2

Total net increase

14 6 23 9

Balance at end of period

$ 396 $ 347 $ 396 $ 347

(1) The alternatives asset class includes a range of investment products such as funds of hedge funds, funds of private equity funds and funds of real estate funds.

119 LOGO


Table of Contents

Trading. The Company recognized losses of $6 million and $26 million in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, compared with gains of $53 million and $47 million in the comparable periods of 2013. Trading results in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 primarily reflected losses related to certain consolidated real estate funds sponsored by the Company. Trading results in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013 primarily reflected gains related to certain consolidated real estate funds sponsored by the Company.

Investments. The Company recorded net investment gains of $163 million and $409 million in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, compared with gains of $135 million and $328 million in the comparable periods of 2013. The increase in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 was primarily related to higher net investment gains predominantly within the Company’s Merchant Banking and Traditional Asset Management businesses, partially offset by lower gains on investments in the Real Estate Investing business, driven by the deconsolidation of certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund sponsored by the Company.

Asset Management, Distribution and Administration Fees. Asset management, distribution and administration fees increased 10% to $518 million and increased 7% to $991 million in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively. The increase primarily reflected higher management and administration revenues, as a result of higher average assets under management.

The Company’s assets under management increased $49 billion from $347 billion at June 30, 2013 to $396 billion at June 30, 2014, reflecting market appreciation and positive net flows. The Company recorded net inflows of $8 billion and $14 billion in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, reflecting net customer inflows in equity, liquidity and alternatives funds. The inflows in the six months ended June 30, 2014 were partially offset by net customer outflows in real estate funds and fixed income funds. The Company recorded net customer inflows of $10 billion and $7 billion in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, respectively, primarily reflecting net customer inflows in liquidity funds. The inflows in the quarter ended June 30, 2013 were partially offset by net customer outflows in fixed income funds.

Other. Other revenues were $24 million and $66 million in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, as compared with $12 million and $14 million in the comparable periods of 2013. The results in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 included higher revenues associated with the Company’s minority investment in certain third party investment managers.

Non-interest Expenses.

Non-interest expenses were $487 million and $964 million in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, as compared with $513 million and $971 million in the comparable periods of 2013. Compensation and benefits expenses were essentially flat in the quarter ended June 30, 2014, and increased 4% in the six months ended June 30, 2014 principally due to an increase in the fair value of deferred compensation plan referenced investments and an increase in base salaries. Non-compensation expenses decreased 9% and 7% in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, primarily due to lower occupancy and equipment and other expenses, as a result of lower consumption taxes in the European Union, and were partially offset by higher marketing and business development expenses. The decrease in the quarter ended June 30, 2014 was also partially offset by higher information processing and communication expenses.

Nonredeemable Noncontrolling Interests.

Nonredeemable noncontrolling interests are primarily related to the consolidation of certain real estate funds sponsored by the Company. Investment gains associated with these consolidated funds were $7 million and $78 million in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively, compared with losses of $25 million in the quarter ended June 30, 2013 and gains of $41 million in the six months ended June 30, 2013. Nonredeemable noncontrolling interests decreased in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 primarily due to the deconsolidation of certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund sponsored by the Company. The deconsolidation was due to the Volcker Rule becoming effective on April 1, 2014, combined with an earlier expiration of a credit facility that was not renewed by the Company.

LOGO 120


Table of Contents

Accounting Developments.

Accounting for Share-Based Payments When the Terms of an Award Provide That a Performance Target Could Be Achieved after the Requisite Service Period.

In June 2014, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (the “FASB”) issued an accounting update clarifying that entities should treat performance targets that could be met after the requisite service period of a share-based payment award as performance conditions that affect vesting. Therefore, an entity would not record compensation expense (measured as of the grant date) for an award where transfer to the employee is contingent upon satisfaction of the performance target until it becomes probable that the performance target will be met. The guidance is effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2016. Early adoption is permitted. This guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements.

Repurchase-to-Maturity Transactions, Repurchase Financings, and Disclosures.

In June 2014, the FASB issued an accounting update requiring repurchase-to-maturity transactions be accounted for as secured borrowings consistent with the accounting for other repurchase agreements. This accounting update also requires separate accounting for a transfer of a financial asset executed contemporaneously with a repurchase agreement with the same counterparty (a repurchase financing), which will result in secured borrowing accounting for the repurchase agreement. This guidance is effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2015. In addition, new disclosures are required for sales of financial assets where the Company retains substantially all the exposure throughout the term and the collateral pledged and remaining maturity of repurchase and securities lending agreements, which are effective January 1, 2015, and April 1, 2015, respectively. This guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements.

Revenue from Contracts with Customers.

In May 2014, the FASB issued an accounting update to clarify the principles of revenue recognition and to develop a common revenue recognition standard across all industries for U.S. GAAP and International Financial Reporting Standards. The core principle of this guidance is that an entity should recognize revenue to depict the transfer of promised goods or services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to which the entity expects to be entitled in exchange for those goods or services. This guidance is effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2017. The Company is currently evaluating the potential impact of adopting this accounting standard update.

Reclassification of Residential Real Estate Collateralized Consumer Mortgage Loans upon Foreclosure.

In January 2014, the FASB issued an accounting update clarifying when an in-substance repossession or foreclosure occurs; that is, when a creditor should be considered to have received physical possession of residential real estate property collateralizing a consumer mortgage loan such that the loan receivable should be derecognized and the real estate property recognized. This guidance is effective for the Company beginning January 1, 2015. This guidance can be applied using either a modified retrospective transition method or a prospective transition method. This guidance is not expected to have a material impact on the Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements.

121 LOGO


Table of Contents

Other Matters.

Legal Matters.

Subsequent to the release of the Company’s earnings on July 17, 2014, legal accruals were increased, which increased Other expenses within the Institutional Securities business segment in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 by $53 million related to agreements in principle to settle certain mortgage-related matters (see “Contingencies—Legal” in Note 11 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1). This decreased diluted EPS and diluted EPS from continuing operations by $0.02 in the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014. The settlements were considered to be recognizable subsequent events requiring adjustment to the June 30, 2014 condensed consolidated financial statements under U.S. GAAP.

Return on Equity Goal.

The Company is aiming to improve its returns to shareholders with a goal of achieving a 10% or more return on average common equity excluding DVA (“Return on Equity”), subject to the successful execution of its strategic objectives.

The Company plans to progress toward achieving its Return on Equity goal through the following strategies. In the Wealth Management business, the Company plans to continue to improve profitability through cost discipline and revenue growth, as reflected in a pre-tax margin target of 22-25% by year end 2015. In the Fixed Income and Commodities businesses, the Company plans to improve its Return on Equity to more than 10% by: optimizing the Commodities business through reducing exposure to physical commodities; pursuing, in the Fixed Income business, a more centralized decision-making process with more strategic resource allocation and a focus on expenses, leveraging technology, capital and balance sheet optimization; and continuing to reduce RWAs. Across the entire organization, the Company plans to pursue the following: executing its overall expense reduction plan and improving expense ratios; growing earnings through Morgan Stanley-specific opportunities, particularly with respect to deposit growth in its U.S. Banks and optimization of lending products; and prudently returning excess capital return to shareholders, as appropriate, and subject to regulatory approval.

The Company’s Return on Equity goal and its related strategies are forward-looking statements that may be materially affected by many factors including, among other things: macroeconomic and market conditions; legislative and regulatory developments; industry trading and investment banking volumes; equity market levels; interest rate environment; and litigation expenses. Given the uncertainties surrounding these and other factors, there are significant risks that the Company’s Return on Equity goal may not be realized, and actual results may differ from the goal and the differences may be material and adverse. Accordingly, the Company cautions that undue reliance is not to be placed on any of these forward-looking statements. See “Forward-Looking Statements” immediately preceding Part I, Item 1, and “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of the Company’s Form 10-K for additional information regarding these forward-looking statements. The Return on Equity is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company considers to be a useful measure to the Company and investors to assess operating performance.

U.S. Banks’ Lending Activities.

The Company provides loans to a variety of customers, from large corporate and institutional clients to high net worth individuals, primarily through the Company’s U.S. Banks. The Company’s lending activities in the Institutional Securities business segment primarily include corporate lending activities, in which the Company provides loans or lending commitments to certain corporate clients. In addition to corporate lending activities, the Institutional Securities business segment engages in other lending activities. The Company’s lending activities in the Wealth Management business segment include securities-based lending that allows clients to borrow money against the value of qualifying securities in PLAs and residential mortgage lending. The Company expects its lending activities to continue to grow.

LOGO 122


Table of Contents

The following table presents the Company’s U.S. Banks’ lending activities included in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition:

At
June 30,  2014
At
June 30,  2013
(dollars in billions)

Institutional Securities U.S. Bank data(1):

Total corporate funded loans

$ 9.7 $ 8.4

Total other funded loans(2)

10.8 2.8

Wealth Management U.S. Bank data(3):

Securities-based lending and other loans

$ 18.4 $ 12.5

Residential real estate loans

12.7 7.7

(1) Institutional Securities U.S. Bank refers to the Company’s U.S. bank operating subsidiary, MSBNA.
(2) In addition to primary corporate lending activity, the Institutional Securities business segment engages in other lending activities. These activities include corporate loans purchased in the secondary market, commercial mortgage lending, asset-backed lending and financing extended to Institutional equities customers.
(3) Wealth Management U.S. Bank refers to the Company’s U.S. bank operating subsidiaries, MSBNA and MSPBNA.

For a further discussion of the Company’s credit risks, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Credit Risk” in Item 3. See also Notes 8 and 11 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for additional information about the Company’s financing receivables and lending commitments, respectively.

Available for Sale Securities.

During the quarters ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company reported net unrealized gains (losses) of $162 million and $(342) million, net of tax, respectively, on its AFS Securities portfolio. During the six months ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, the Company reported net unrealized gains (losses) of $236 million and $(369) million, net of tax, respectively. Gains (losses) in the AFS Securities portfolio are included in Accumulated other comprehensive income (loss) for all periods presented. The losses in 2013 were primarily due to rising long-term interest rates during the quarter ended June 30, 2013.

Real Estate.

The Company acts as the general partner for various real estate funds and also invests in certain of these funds as a limited partner. The Company’s real estate investments at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 are described below. Such amounts exclude investments associated with certain employee deferred compensation and co-investment plans.

At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition included amounts representing real estate investment assets of consolidated subsidiaries of approximately $0.2 billion and $2.2 billion, respectively, including noncontrolling interests of approximately $0.2 billion and $1.8 billion, respectively, for a net amount of approximately $19 million and $451 million, respectively. The decrease was driven by the deconsolidation of certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund sponsored by the Company. The deconsolidation was due to the Volcker Rule becoming effective on April 1, 2014, combined with an earlier expiration of a credit facility that was not renewed by the Company. This net presentation is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company considers to be a useful measure for the Company and investors to use in assessing the Company’s net exposure. In addition, the Company has contractual capital commitments, guarantees, lending facilities and counterparty arrangements with respect to real estate investments of $0.2 billion at June 30, 2014.

In addition to the Company’s real estate investments, the Company engages in various real estate-related activities, including origination of loans secured by commercial and residential properties. The Company also securitizes and trades in a wide range of commercial and residential real estate and real estate-related whole

123 LOGO


Table of Contents

loans, mortgages and other real estate. In connection with these activities, the Company has provided, or otherwise agreed to be responsible for, representations and warranties. Under certain circumstances, the Company may be required to repurchase such assets or make other payments related to such assets if such representations and warranties are breached. The Company continues to monitor its real estate-related activities in order to manage its exposures and potential liability from these markets and businesses. See “Legal Proceedings—Residential Mortgage and Credit Crisis Related Matters” in Part II, Item 1, herein and Note 11 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Part I, Item 1 for further information.

Income Tax Matters.

The Company’s effective tax rate from continuing operations for the six months ended June 30, 2014 included a discrete net tax benefit of $609 million principally associated with remeasurement of reserves and related interest due to new information regarding the status of a multi-year tax authority examination.

New York State corporate tax reform (the “tax reform”) was signed into law on March 31, 2014. The tax reform, which is effective for tax years beginning on or after January 1, 2015, merges the existing bank franchise tax into a substantially amended general corporation franchise tax and adopts customer based single receipts factor for all New York taxpayers. The tax reform mainly impacted the Company’s banking subsidiaries and did not have a material impact on the Company’s 2014 annual effective tax rate and condensed consolidated statement of income for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014.

The income of certain foreign subsidiaries earned outside of the U.S. has previously been excluded from taxation in the U.S. as a result of a provision of U.S. tax law that defers the imposition of tax on certain active financial services income until such income is repatriated to the U.S. as a dividend. This provision as well as other provisions that allow for tax benefits from certain tax credits, which expired for taxable years beginning on or after January 1, 2014, had previously been extended by Congress on several occasions, including the most recent extension which occurred during 2013. The increase to the effective tax rate as a result of the expiration of the provisions is estimated to be immaterial on a quarterly and on an annual basis.

The Company’s effective tax rate from continuing operations for the six months ended June 30, 2013 included a discrete tax benefit of $81 million due to the retroactive effective date of the Relief Act. The Relief Act that was enacted on January 2, 2013, among other things, extended with retroactive effect to January 1, 2012 a provision of U.S. tax law that defers the imposition of tax on certain active financial services income of certain foreign subsidiaries earned outside of the U.S. until such income is repatriated to the U.S. as a dividend. Additionally, the Company’s effective tax rate from continuing operations for the six months ended June 30, 2013 included a discrete net tax benefit of $61 million associated with remeasurement of reserves and related interest based on new information regarding the status of certain tax authority examinations.

Regulatory Outlook.

The Dodd-Frank Act was enacted on July 21, 2010. While certain portions of the Dodd-Frank Act became effective immediately, most other portions are effective following transition periods or through numerous rulemakings by multiple governmental agencies, and although a large number of rules have been proposed, many are still subject to final rulemaking or transition periods. U.S. regulators also plan to propose additional regulations to implement the Dodd-Frank Act. Accordingly, it remains difficult to assess fully the impact that the Dodd-Frank Act will have on the Company and on the financial services industry generally. In addition, various international developments, such as the adoption of or further revisions to risk-based capital, leverage and liquidity standards by the Basel Committee, including Basel III, and the implementation of those standards in jurisdictions in which the Company operates, will continue to impact the Company in the coming years.

At the end of 2013, the U.S. regulators adopted the final Volcker Rule regulations. Banking entities, including the Company, generally have until July 21, 2015 to bring all of their activities and investments into conformance with the Volcker Rule, subject to possible extensions. The Company is continuing its review of activities that

LOGO 124


Table of Contents

may be affected by the Volcker Rule, including its trading operations and asset management activities, and is taking steps to establish the necessary compliance programs to comply with the Volcker Rule. Given the complexity of the new framework, the full impact of the Volcker Rule is still uncertain, and will ultimately depend on the interpretation and implementation by the five regulatory agencies responsible for its oversight.

It is likely that 2014 and subsequent years will see further material changes in the way major financial institutions are regulated in both the U.S. and other markets in which the Company operates, although it remains difficult to predict the exact impact these changes will have on the Company’s business, financial condition, results of operations and cash flows for a particular future period. See also “Business—Supervision and Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of the Form 10-K.

125 LOGO


Table of Contents

Critical Accounting Policies.

The Company’s condensed consolidated financial statements are prepared in accordance with accounting principles generally accepted in the U.S., which require the Company to make estimates and assumptions (see Note 1 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1). The Company believes that of its significant accounting policies (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 on Form 10-K and Note 2 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1), the following policies involve a higher degree of judgment and complexity.

Fair Value.

Financial Instruments Measured at Fair Value. A significant number of the Company’s financial instruments are carried at fair value. The Company makes estimates regarding valuation of assets and liabilities measured at fair value in preparing the consolidated financial statements. These assets and liabilities include, but are not limited to:

Trading assets and Trading liabilities;

AFS Securities;

Securities received as collateral and Obligation to return securities received as collateral;

Certain Securities purchased under agreements to resell;

Certain Deposits;

Certain Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings, primarily structured notes;

Certain Securities sold under agreements to repurchase;

Certain Other secured financings; and

Certain Long-term borrowings, primarily structured notes.

Fair value is defined as the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability ( i.e. , the “exit price”) in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date.

In determining fair value, the Company uses various valuation approaches. A hierarchy for inputs is used in measuring fair value that maximizes the use of observable prices and inputs and minimizes the use of unobservable prices and inputs by requiring that the relevant observable inputs be used when available. The hierarchy is broken down into three levels, wherein Level 1 uses observable prices in active markets, and Level 3 consists of valuation techniques that incorporate significant unobservable inputs and, therefore, require the greatest use of judgment. In periods of market disruption, the observability of prices and inputs may be reduced for many instruments. This condition could cause an instrument to be recategorized from Level 1 to Level 2 or Level 2 to Level 3. In addition, a downturn in market conditions could lead to declines in the valuation of many instruments. For further information on the valuation process, fair value definition, Level 1, Level 2, Level 3 and related valuation techniques, and quantitative information about and sensitivity of significant unobservable inputs used in Level 3 fair value measurements, see Notes 2 and 4 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 on Form 10-K and Note 4 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1.

Assets and Liabilities Measured at Fair Value on a Non-recurring Basis. At June 30, 2014, certain of the Company’s assets were measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis, primarily relating to loans, other investments, premises, equipment and software costs, intangible assets and other assets. The Company incurs losses or gains for any adjustments of these assets to fair value. A downturn in market conditions could result in impairment charges in future periods.

For assets and liabilities measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis, fair value is determined by using various valuation approaches. The same hierarchy as described above, which maximizes the use of observable inputs and minimizes the use of unobservable inputs by generally requiring that the observable inputs be used when available, is used in measuring fair value for these items.

LOGO 126


Table of Contents

See Note 4 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for further information on assets and liabilities that are measured at fair value on a non-recurring basis.

Fair Value Control Processes . The Company employs control processes to validate the fair value of its financial instruments, including those derived from pricing models. These control processes are designed to ensure that the values used for financial reporting are based on observable inputs wherever possible. In the event that observable inputs are not available, the control processes are designed to assure that the valuation approach utilized is appropriate and consistently applied and that the assumptions are reasonable.

See Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 on Form 10-K for additional information regarding the Company’s valuation policies, processes and procedures.

Goodwill and Intangible Assets.

Goodwill. The Company tests goodwill for impairment on an annual basis on July 1 and on an interim basis when certain events or circumstances exist. The Company tests for impairment at the reporting unit level, which is generally at the level of or one level below its business segments. Goodwill no longer retains its association with a particular acquisition once it has been assigned to a reporting unit. As such, all the activities of a reporting unit, whether acquired or organically developed, are available to support the value of the goodwill. For both the annual and interim tests, the Company has the option to first assess qualitative factors to determine whether the existence of events or circumstances leads to a determination that it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is less than its carrying amount. If after assessing the totality of events or circumstances, the Company determines it is more likely than not that the fair value of a reporting unit is greater than its carrying amount, then performing the two-step impairment test is not required. However, if the Company concludes otherwise, then it is required to perform the first step of the two-step impairment test. Goodwill impairment is determined by comparing the estimated fair value of a reporting unit with its respective carrying value. If the estimated fair value exceeds the carrying value, goodwill at the reporting unit level is not deemed to be impaired. If the estimated fair value is below carrying value, however, further analysis is required to determine the amount of the impairment. Additionally, if the carrying value of a reporting unit is zero or a negative value and it is determined that it is more likely than not the goodwill is impaired, further analysis is required. The estimated fair value of the reporting units is derived based on valuation techniques the Company believes market participants would use for each of the reporting units. The estimated fair value is generally determined by utilizing a discounted cash flow methodology or methodologies that incorporate price-to-book and price-to-earnings multiples of certain comparable companies. At each annual goodwill impairment testing date, each of the Company’s reporting units with goodwill had a fair value that was substantially in excess of its carrying value.

Intangible Assets . Amortizable intangible assets are amortized over their estimated useful lives and are reviewed for impairment on an interim basis when certain events or circumstances exist. An impairment exists when the carrying amount of the intangible asset exceeds its fair value. An impairment loss will be recognized only if the carrying amount of the intangible asset is not recoverable and exceeds its fair value. The carrying amount of the intangible asset is not recoverable if it exceeds the sum of the expected undiscounted cash flows.

For both goodwill and intangible assets, to the extent an impairment loss is recognized, the loss establishes the new cost basis of the asset. Subsequent reversal of impairment losses is not permitted. For amortizable intangible assets, the new cost basis is amortized over the remaining useful life of that asset. Adverse market or economic events could result in impairment charges in future periods.

See Notes 2 and 4 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 and Notes 2, 4 and 9 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 on Form 10-K for additional information about goodwill and intangible assets.

127 LOGO


Table of Contents

Legal and Regulatory Contingencies.

In the normal course of business, the Company has been named, from time to time, as a defendant in various legal actions, including arbitrations, class actions and other litigation, arising in connection with its activities as a global diversified financial services institution.

Certain of the actual or threatened legal actions include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages or claims for indeterminate amounts of damages. In some cases, the entities that would otherwise be the primary defendants in such cases are bankrupt or in financial distress.

The Company is also involved, from time to time, in other reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by governmental and self-regulatory agencies regarding the Company’s business, and involving, among other matters, sales and trading activities, financial products or offerings sponsored, underwritten or sold by the Company, and accounting and operational matters, certain of which may result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, injunctions or other relief.

Accruals for litigation and regulatory proceedings are generally determined on a case-by-case basis. Where available information indicates that it is probable a liability had been incurred at the date of the condensed consolidated financial statements and the Company can reasonably estimate the amount of that loss, the Company accrues the estimated loss by a charge to income. In many proceedings, however, it is inherently difficult to determine whether any loss is probable or even possible or to estimate the amount of any loss. For certain legal proceedings and investigations, the Company can estimate possible losses, additional losses, ranges of loss or ranges of additional loss in excess of amounts accrued. For certain other legal proceedings and investigations, the Company cannot reasonably estimate such losses, particularly for proceedings and investigations where the factual record is being developed or contested or where plaintiffs or government entities seek substantial or indeterminate damages, restitution, disgorgement or penalties. Numerous issues may need to be resolved, including through potentially lengthy discovery and determination of important factual matters, determination of issues related to class certification and the calculation of damages or other relief, and by addressing novel or unsettled legal questions relevant to the proceedings or investigations in question, before a loss or additional loss or range of loss or additional loss can be reasonably estimated for a proceeding or investigation.

Significant judgment is required in deciding when and if to make these accruals and the actual cost of a legal claim or regulatory fine/penalty may ultimately be materially different from the recorded accruals.

See Note 11 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for additional information on legal proceedings.

Income Taxes.

The Company is subject to the income and indirect tax laws of the U.S., its states and municipalities and those of the foreign jurisdictions in which the Company has significant business operations. These tax laws are complex and subject to different interpretations by the taxpayer and the relevant governmental taxing authorities. The Company must make judgments and interpretations about the application of these inherently complex tax laws when determining the provision for income taxes and the expense for indirect taxes and must also make estimates about when certain items affect taxable income in the various tax jurisdictions. Disputes over interpretations of the tax laws may be settled with the taxing authority upon examination or audit. The Company periodically evaluates the likelihood of assessments in each taxing jurisdiction resulting from current and subsequent years’ examinations, and unrecognized tax benefits related to potential losses that may arise from tax audits are established in accordance with the guidance on accounting for unrecognized tax benefits. Once established, unrecognized tax benefits are adjusted when there is more information available or when an event occurs requiring a change.

LOGO 128


Table of Contents

The Company’s provision for income taxes is composed of current and deferred taxes. Current income taxes approximate taxes to be paid or refunded for the current period. The Company’s deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities and are measured using the applicable enacted tax rates and laws that will be in effect when such differences are expected to reverse. The Company’s deferred tax balances also include deferred assets related to tax attributes carryforwards, such as net operating losses and tax credits that will be realized through reduction of future tax liabilities and, in some cases, are subject to expiration if not utilized within certain periods. The Company performs regular reviews to ascertain whether deferred tax assets are realizable. These reviews include management’s estimates and assumptions regarding future taxable income and incorporate various tax planning strategies, including strategies that may be available to utilize net operating losses before they expire. Once the deferred tax asset balances have been determined, the Company may record a valuation allowance against the deferred tax asset balances to reflect the amount of these balances (net of valuation allowance) that the Company estimates it is more likely than not to realize at a future date. Both current and deferred income taxes could reflect adjustments related to the Company’s unrecognized tax benefits.

Significant judgment is required in estimating the consolidated provision for (benefit from) income taxes, current and deferred tax balances (including valuation allowance, if any), accrued interest or penalties and uncertain tax positions. Revisions in our estimates and/or the actual costs of a tax assessment may ultimately be materially different from the recorded accruals and unrecognized tax benefits, if any.

See Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements in Item 8 on Form 10-K for additional information on the Company’s significant assumptions, judgments and interpretations associated with the accounting for income taxes and Note 17 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for additional information on the Company’s tax examinations.

129 LOGO


Table of Contents

Liquidity and Capital Resources.

The Company’s senior management establishes liquidity and capital policies. Through various risk and control committees, the Company’s senior management reviews business performance relative to these policies, monitors the availability of alternative sources of financing, and oversees the liquidity and interest rate and currency sensitivity of the Company’s asset and liability position. The Company’s Treasury Department, Firm Risk Committee, Asset and Liability Management Committee and other control groups assist in evaluating, monitoring and controlling the impact that the Company’s business activities have on its condensed consolidated statements of financial condition, liquidity and capital structure. Liquidity and capital matters are reported regularly to the Board’s Risk Committee.

The Balance Sheet.

The Company monitors and evaluates the composition and size of its balance sheet on a regular basis. The Company’s balance sheet management process includes quarterly planning, business specific limits, monitoring of business specific usage versus limits, key metrics and new business impact assessments.

The Company establishes balance sheet limits at the consolidated, business segment and business unit levels. The Company monitors balance sheet usage versus limits, and variances resulting from business activity or market fluctuations are reviewed. On a regular basis, the Company reviews current performance versus limits and assesses the need to re-allocate limits based on business unit needs. The Company also monitors key metrics, including asset and liability size, composition of the balance sheet, limit utilization and capital usage.

The tables below summarize total assets for the Company’s business segments at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013:

At June 30, 2014
Institutional
Securities
Wealth
Management
Investment
Management
Total
(dollars in millions)

Assets

Cash and cash equivalents(1)

$ 22,953 $ 17,483 $ 449 $ 40,885

Cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements(2)

42,198 2,515 44,713

Trading assets

253,935 2,197 3,429 259,561

AFS Securities

8,946 56,528 65,474

Securities received as collateral(2)

19,498 19,498

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell(2)

98,326 10,630 108,956

Securities borrowed(2)

147,092 374 147,466

Customer and other receivables(2)

31,843 22,053 661 54,557

Loans:

Held for investment, net of allowance

17,436 31,194 48,630

Held for sale

6,541 89 6,630

Other assets(3)

18,746 10,172 1,280 30,198

Total assets(4)

$ 667,514 $ 153,235 $ 5,819 $ 826,568

LOGO 130


Table of Contents
At December 31, 2013
Institutional
Securities
Wealth
Management
Investment
Management
Total
(dollars in millions)

Assets

Cash and cash equivalents(1)

$ 30,169 $ 28,967 $ 747 $ 59,883

Cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements(2)

36,422 2,781 39,203

Trading assets

273,959 2,104 4,681 280,744

AFS Securities

53,430 53,430

Securities received as collateral(2)

20,508 20,508

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell(2)

106,812 11,318 118,130

Securities borrowed(2)

129,366 341 129,707

Customer and other receivables(2)

33,927 22,493 684 57,104

Loans:

Held for investment

11,661 24,884 36,545

Held for sale

6,229 100 6,329

Other assets(3)

19,543 10,293 1,283 31,119

Total assets(4)

$ 668,596 $ 156,711 $ 7,395 $ 832,702

(1) Cash and cash equivalents include Cash and due from banks and Interest bearing deposits with banks.
(2) Certain of these assets are included in secured financing assets (see “Secured Financing” herein).
(3) Other assets include Other investments; Premises, equipment and software costs; Goodwill; Intangible assets; and Other assets.
(4) Total assets include Global Liquidity Reserves of $192 billion and $202 billion at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively. On April 1, 2014, the Company deconsolidated approximately $1.6 billion in total assets that were related to certain legal entities associated with a real estate fund sponsored by the Company.

A substantial portion of the Company’s total assets consists of liquid marketable securities and short-term receivables arising principally from sales and trading activities in the Institutional Securities business segment. The liquid nature of these assets provides the Company with flexibility in managing the size of its balance sheet. The Company’s total assets decreased to $827 billion at June 30, 2014 from $833 billion at December 31, 2013. The decrease in total assets was primarily due to a decrease in Trading assets, primarily due to reductions in U.S. government and agency securities, Corporate equities and Corporate and other debt, partially offset by an increase in Securities borrowed.

The Company’s assets and liabilities are primarily related to transactions attributable to sales and trading and securities financing activities. At June 30, 2014, securities financing assets and liabilities were $361 billion and $339 billion, respectively. At December 31, 2013, securities financing assets and liabilities were $352 billion and $353 billion, respectively. Securities financing transactions include cash deposited with clearing organizations or segregated under federal and other regulations or requirements, repurchase and resale agreements, securities borrowed and loaned transactions, securities received as collateral and obligation to return securities received, and customer and other receivables and payables. Securities borrowed or purchased under agreements to resell and securities loaned or sold under agreements to repurchase are treated as collateralized financings (see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K and Note 6 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1). Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned were $142 billion at June 30, 2014 and averaged $149 billion and $157 billion during the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively. The Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned period-end balance was lower than the average balances during the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 as the Company’s assets decreased. Securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed were $256 billion at June 30, 2014 and averaged $264 billion and $260 billion during the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, respectively. Securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed period-end balance was lower than the average balances during the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014 as the Company’s assets and requirements for collateral decreased.

131 LOGO


Table of Contents

Securities financing assets and liabilities also include matched book transactions with minimal market, credit and/or liquidity risk. Matched book transactions accommodate customers, as well as obtain securities for the settlement and financing of inventory positions. The customer receivable portion of the securities financing transactions includes customer margin loans, collateralized by customer-owned securities, and customer cash, which is segregated in accordance with regulatory requirements. The customer payable portion of the securities financing transactions primarily includes customer payables to the Company’s prime brokerage customers. The Company’s risk exposure on these transactions is mitigated by collateral maintenance policies that limit the Company’s credit exposure to customers. Included within securities financing assets were $19 billion and $21 billion at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, respectively, recorded in accordance with accounting guidance for the transfer of financial assets that represented offsetting assets and liabilities for fully collateralized non-cash loan transactions.

Liquidity Risk Management Framework.

The primary goal of the Company’s liquidity risk management framework is to ensure that the Company has access to adequate funding across a wide range of market conditions. The framework is designed to enable the Company to fulfill its financial obligations and support the execution of the Company’s business strategies.

The following principles guide the Company’s liquidity risk management framework:

Sufficient liquid assets should be maintained to cover maturing liabilities and other planned and contingent outflows;

Maturity profile of assets and liabilities should be aligned, with limited reliance on short-term funding;

Source, counterparty, currency, region, and term of funding should be diversified; and

Limited access to funding should be anticipated through the Contingency Funding Plan (“CFP”).

The core components of the Company’s liquidity risk management framework are the CFP, Liquidity Stress Tests and the Global Liquidity Reserve (as defined below), which support the Company’s target liquidity profile.

Contingency Funding Plan.

The Company’s CFP describes the data and information flows, limits, targets, operating environment indicators, escalation procedures, roles and responsibilities, and available mitigating actions in the event of a liquidity stress. The CFP also sets forth the principal elements of the Company’s liquidity stress testing which identifies stress events of different severity and duration, assesses current funding sources and uses and establishes a plan for monitoring and managing a potential liquidity stress event.

Liquidity Stress Tests.

The Company uses liquidity stress tests to model liquidity outflows across multiple scenarios over a range of time horizons. These scenarios contain various combinations of idiosyncratic and systemic stress events.

The assumptions underpinning the Liquidity Stress Tests include, but are not limited to, the following:

No government support;

No access to equity and unsecured debt markets;

Repayment of all unsecured debt maturing within the stress horizon;

Higher haircuts and significantly lower availability of secured funding;

Additional collateral that would be required by trading counterparties, certain exchanges and clearing organizations related to credit rating downgrades;

LOGO 132


Table of Contents

Additional collateral that would be required due to collateral substitutions, collateral disputes and uncalled collateral;

Discretionary unsecured debt buybacks;

Drawdowns on unfunded commitments provided to third parties;

Client cash withdrawals and reduction in customer short positions that fund long positions;

Limited access to the foreign exchange swap markets;

Return of securities borrowed on an uncollateralized basis; and

Maturity roll-off of outstanding letters of credit with no further issuance.

The Liquidity Stress Tests are produced for the Parent and major operating subsidiaries, as well as at major currency levels, to capture specific cash requirements and cash availability across the Company, including a limited number of asset sales in a stressed environment. The Liquidity Stress Tests assume that subsidiaries will use their own liquidity first to fund their obligations before drawing liquidity from the Parent. The Parent will support its subsidiaries and will not have access to subsidiaries’ liquidity reserves. In addition to the assumptions underpinning the Liquidity Stress Tests, the Company takes into consideration the settlement risk related to intra-day settlement and clearing of securities and financing activities.

At June 30, 2014, the Company maintained sufficient liquidity to meet current and contingent funding obligations as modeled in its Liquidity Stress Tests.

Global Liquidity Reserve.

The Company maintains sufficient liquidity reserves (“Global Liquidity Reserve”) to cover daily funding needs and to meet strategic liquidity targets sized by the CFP and Liquidity Stress Tests. The size of the Global Liquidity Reserve is actively managed by the Company. The following components are considered in sizing the Global Liquidity Reserve: unsecured debt maturity profile, balance sheet size and composition, funding needs in a stressed environment inclusive of contingent cash outflows and collateral requirements. In addition, the Global Liquidity Reserve includes an additional reserve, which is primarily a discretionary surplus based on the Company’s risk tolerance and is subject to change dependent on market and firm-specific events.

The Global Liquidity Reserve is held within the Parent and major operating subsidiaries. The Global Liquidity Reserve is composed of diversified cash and cash equivalents and unencumbered highly liquid securities. Eligible unencumbered securities include U.S. government securities, U.S. agency securities, U.S. agency mortgage-backed securities, non-U.S. government securities and other highly liquid investment grade securities.

Global Liquidity Reserve by Type of Investment.

The table below summarizes the Company’s Global Liquidity Reserve by type of investment:

At
June 30, 2014
(dollars in billions)

Cash deposits with banks

$ 15

Cash deposits with central banks

20

Unencumbered highly liquid securities:

U.S. government obligations

71

U.S. agency and agency mortgage-backed securities

33

Non-U.S. sovereign obligations(1)

35

Investments in money market funds

1

Other investment grade securities

17

Global Liquidity Reserve

$ 192

133 LOGO


Table of Contents

(1) Non-U.S. sovereign obligations are composed of unencumbered German, French, Dutch, U.K., Brazilian and Japanese government obligations.

The ability to monetize assets during a liquidity crisis is critical. The Company believes that the assets held in the Global Liquidity Reserve can be monetized within five business days in a stressed environment given the highly liquid and diversified nature of the reserves. The currency profile of the Global Liquidity Reserve is consistent with the CFP and Liquidity Stress Tests. In addition to the Global Liquidity Reserve, the Company has other cash and cash equivalents and other unencumbered assets that are available for monetization that are not included in the balances in the table above.

Global Liquidity Reserve Held by Bank and Non-Bank Legal Entities.

The table below summarizes the Global Liquidity Reserve held by bank and non-bank legal entities:

Average Balance(1)
At
June 30,
2014
At
March 31,
2014
For the Three
Months Ended
June 30, 2014
For the Three
Months Ended
March 31, 2014
(dollars in billions)

Bank legal entities:

Domestic

$ 78 $ 84 $ 82 $ 85

Foreign

6 6 6 5

Total Bank legal entities

84 90 88 90

Non-Bank legal entities:

Domestic(2)

74 78 75 77

Foreign

34 35 34 33

Total Non-Bank legal entities

108 113 109 110

Total

$ 192 $ 203 $ 197 $ 200

(1) The Company calculates the average Global Liquidity Reserve based upon daily amounts.
(2) The Parent held $58 billion at June 30, 2014, which averaged $55 billion during the quarter ended June 30, 2014.

Basel Liquidity Framework.

The Basel Committee has developed two standards intended for use in liquidity risk supervision: the Liquidity Coverage Ratio (“LCR”) and the Net Stable Funding Ratio (“NSFR”).

The LCR was developed to ensure banks have sufficient high-quality liquid assets to cover net cash outflows arising from significant stress over 30 calendar days. This standard’s objective is to promote the short-term resilience of the liquidity risk profile of banks and bank holding companies. The Company is compliant with the Basel Committee’s version of the LCR, which stipulates that the ratio of the Company’s portfolio of unencumbered high-quality liquid assets to total net cash outflows over a 30-day standardized supervisory liquidity stress scenario must be at least 100%.

In October 2013, the U.S. banking regulators proposed a rule to implement the LCR in the United States (“U.S. LCR proposal”). The U.S. LCR proposal would apply to the Company and the Company’s U.S. Banks. The U.S. LCR proposal is more stringent in certain respects compared with the Basel Committee’s version of the LCR, and includes a generally narrower definition of high-quality liquid assets, a different methodology for calculating net cash outflows during the 30-day stress period as well as a shorter, two-year phase-in period that ends on December 31, 2016. The Company continues to evaluate the U.S. LCR proposal and its potential impact on the Company’s current liquidity and funding requirements.

LOGO 134


Table of Contents

The NSFR has a time horizon of one year and is defined as the ratio of the amount of available stable funding to the amount of required stable funding. This standard’s objective is to promote resilience over a longer time horizon. In January 2014, the Basel Committee proposed revisions to the original December 2010 version of the NSFR and continues to contemplate the introduction of the NSFR, including any final revisions, as a minimum standard by January 1, 2018.

Funding Management.

The Company manages its funding in a manner that reduces the risk of disruption to the Company’s operations. The Company pursues a strategy of diversification of secured and unsecured funding sources (by product, by investor and by region) and attempts to ensure that the tenor of the Company’s liabilities equals or exceeds the expected holding period of the assets being financed.

The Company funds its balance sheet on a global basis through diverse sources. These sources may include the Company’s equity capital, long-term debt, repurchase agreements, securities lending, deposits, commercial paper, letters of credit and lines of credit. The Company has active financing programs for both standard and structured products targeting global investors and currencies.

Secured Financing. A substantial portion of the Company’s total assets consists of liquid marketable securities and arises principally from its Institutional Securities business segment’s sales and trading activities. The liquid nature of these assets provides the Company with flexibility in funding these assets with secured financing. The Company’s goal is to achieve an optimal mix of durable secured and unsecured financing. Secured financing investors principally focus on the quality of the eligible collateral posted. Accordingly, the Company actively manages its secured financing book based on the quality of the assets being funded.

The Company utilizes shorter-term secured financing only for highly liquid assets and has established longer tenor limits for less liquid asset classes, for which funding may be at risk in the event of a market disruption. The Company defines highly liquid assets as government-issued or government-guaranteed securities with a high degree of fundability, and less liquid assets as those that do not meet the criteria. At June 30, 2014, the weighted average maturity of the Company’s secured financing against less liquid assets was greater than 120 days. To further minimize the refinancing risk of secured financing for less liquid assets, the Company has established concentration limits to diversify its investor base and reduce the amount of monthly maturities for secured financing of less liquid assets. Furthermore, the Company obtains spare capacity, or term secured funding liabilities in excess of less liquid inventory, as an additional risk mitigant to replace maturing trades in the event that secured financing markets or the Company’s ability to access them become limited. Finally, in addition to the above risk management framework, the Company holds a portion of its Global Liquidity Reserve against the potential disruption to its secured financing capabilities.

Unsecured Financing .    The Company views long-term debt and deposits as stable sources of funding. Unencumbered securities and non-security assets are financed with a combination of long-term and short-term debt and deposits. The Company’s unsecured financings include structured borrowings, whose payments and redemption values are based on the performance of certain underlying assets, including equity, credit, foreign exchange, interest rates and commodities. When appropriate, the Company may use derivative products to conduct asset and liability management and to make adjustments to the Company’s interest rate and structured borrowings risk profile (see Note 12 to the consolidated financial statements on Form 10-K).

Short-Term Borrowings. The Company’s unsecured short-term borrowings consist of commercial paper, bank loans, bank notes and structured notes with maturities of 12 months or less at issuance.

135 LOGO


Table of Contents

The table below summarizes the Company’s short-term unsecured borrowings:

At
June 30, 2014
At
December 31, 2013
(dollars in millions)

Commercial paper

$ $ 8

Other short-term borrowings

1,783 2,134

Total

$ 1,783 $ 2,142

Deposits. The Company’s bank subsidiaries’ funding sources include time deposits, money market deposit accounts, demand deposit accounts, repurchase agreements, federal funds purchased, commercial paper and Federal Home Loan Bank advances. The vast majority of deposits in the Company’s U.S. Banks are sourced from the Company’s retail brokerage accounts and are considered to have stable, low-cost funding characteristics. Concurrent with the acquisition of the remaining 35% stake in the Wealth Management JV, the deposit sweep agreement between Citi and the Company was terminated. During the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, $5 billion and $10 billion, respectively, of deposits held by Citi relating to the Company’s customer accounts were transferred to the Company’s depository institutions. At June 30, 2014, approximately $18 billion of additional deposits are scheduled to be transferred to the Company’s depository institutions on an agreed-upon basis through June 2015 (see Note 3 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1).

Deposits were as follows:

At
June 30, 2014(1)
At
December 31, 2013(1)
(dollars in millions)

Savings and demand deposits

$ 115,550 $ 109,908

Time deposits(2)

2,145 2,471

Total(3)

$ 117,695 $ 112,379

(1) Total deposits subject to FDIC insurance at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 were $88 billion and $84 billion, respectively.
(2) Certain time deposit accounts are carried at fair value under the fair value option (see Note 4 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1).
(3) At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, approximately $109 billion and $104 billion, respectively, were attributed to the Wealth Management business segment. These total deposits exclude deposits held by Citi relating to the Company’s customer accounts.

Senior Indebtedness . At June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, the aggregate outstanding carrying amount of the Company’s senior indebtedness (including guaranteed obligations of the indebtedness of subsidiaries) was approximately $140 billion and $143 billion, respectively.

Long-Term Borrowings. The Company believes that accessing debt investors through multiple distribution channels helps provide consistent access to the unsecured markets. In addition, the issuance of long-term debt allows the Company to reduce reliance on short-term credit sensitive instruments ( e.g ., commercial paper and other unsecured short-term borrowings). Long-term borrowings are generally managed to achieve staggered maturities, thereby mitigating refinancing risk, and to maximize investor diversification through sales to global institutional and retail clients across regions, currencies and product types. Availability and cost of financing to the Company can vary depending on market conditions, the volume of certain trading and lending activities, the Company’s credit ratings and the overall availability of credit.

The Company may engage in various transactions in the credit markets (including, for example, debt retirements) that it believes are in the best interests of the Company and its investors.

LOGO 136


Table of Contents

Long-term borrowings by maturity profile at June 30, 2014 consisted of the following:

Parent Subsidiaries Total
(dollars in millions)

Due in 2014

$ 6,731 $ 2,758 $ 9,489

Due in 2015

19,159 1,184 20,343

Due in 2016

20,826 1,670 22,496

Due in 2017

24,503 1,585 26,088

Due in 2018

15,604 1,145 16,749

Thereafter

52,212 2,106 54,318

Total

$ 139,035 $ 10,448 $ 149,483

Long-Term Borrowing Activity for the Six Months Ended June 30, 2014. During the six months ended June 30, 2014, the Company issued and reissued notes with a principal amount of approximately $14.8 billion. This amount included the Company’s issuances of $1.5 billion in senior debt on May 22, 2014, $3.0 billion in senior debt on April 28, 2014, $2.1 billion in senior debt on March 31, 2014 and $2.8 billion in senior debt on January 24, 2014. In connection with the note issuances, the Company generally enters into certain transactions to obtain floating interest rates. The weighted average maturity of the Company’s long-term borrowings, based upon stated maturity dates, was approximately 5.6 years at June 30, 2014. During the six months ended June 30, 2014, approximately $21.3 billion in aggregate long-term borrowings matured or were retired. Subsequent to June 30, 2014 and through July 31, 2014, the Company’s long-term borrowings (net of repayments) increased by approximately $2.0 billion. This amount includes the Company’s issuance of $3.0 billion in senior debt on July 23, 2014.

Credit Ratings.

The Company relies on external sources to finance a significant portion of its day-to-day operations. The cost and availability of financing generally is impacted by the Company’s credit ratings. In addition, the Company’s credit ratings can have an impact on certain trading revenues, particularly in those businesses where longer term counterparty performance is a key consideration, such as OTC derivative transactions, including credit derivatives and interest rate swaps. Rating agencies will look at company specific factors; other industry factors such as regulatory or legislative changes; the macro-economic environment and perceived levels of government support, among other things.

Some rating agencies have stated that they currently incorporate various degrees of credit rating uplift from external sources of potential support, as well as perceived government support of systemically important banks, including the credit ratings of the Company. Rating agencies continue to monitor the progress of U.S. financial reform legislation to assess whether the possibility of extraordinary government support for the financial system in any future financial crises is negatively impacted. Legislative and rulemaking outcomes may lead to reduced uplift assumptions for U.S. banks and thereby place downward pressure on credit ratings. For example, in November 2013, Moody’s Investor Services Inc. (“Moody’s”) took certain ratings actions with respect to eight large U.S. banking groups, including downgrading the Company to remove certain uplift from the U.S. government support in their ratings. At the same time, proposed and final U.S. financial reform legislation and attendant rulemaking also have positive implications for credit ratings such as higher standards for capital and liquidity levels. The net result on credit ratings and the timing of any change in rating agency views on changes in government support and other financial reform is currently uncertain.

137 LOGO


Table of Contents

At July 31, 2014, the Parent’s and Morgan Stanley Bank, N.A.’s senior unsecured ratings were as set forth below:

Parent Morgan Stanley Bank, N.A.
Short-Term
Debt
Long-Term
Debt
Rating
Outlook
Short-Term
Debt
Long-Term
Debt
Rating
Outlook

DBRS, Inc.(1)

R-1 (middle) A (high) Stable

Fitch Ratings, Inc.

F1 A Stable F1 A Stable

Moody’s(2)

P-2 Baa2 Positive P-2 A3 Positive

Rating and Investment Information, Inc.

a-1 A Negative

Standard & Poor’s Financial Services LLC

A-2 A- Negative A-1 A Negative

(1) On June 12, 2014, DBRS, Inc. confirmed the ratings for the Company, including its Long-Term Debt rating of A (high) and Short-Term Instruments rating of R-1 (middle). The Rating Outlook trend on all long-term ratings has been revised to Stable from Negative, while the Rating Outlook trend on all short-term ratings remains Stable.
(2) On July 24, 2014, Moody’s affirmed the Company’s long-term debt rating as well as the ratings of its subsidiaries and changed the Ratings Outlook to Positive from Stable.

In connection with certain OTC trading agreements and certain other agreements where the Company is a liquidity provider to certain financing vehicles associated with the Institutional Securities business segment, the Company may be required to provide additional collateral or immediately settle any outstanding liability balances with certain counterparties or pledge additional collateral to certain exchanges and clearing organizations in the event of a future credit rating downgrade irrespective of whether the Company is in a net asset or liability position.

The additional collateral or termination payments that may be called in the event of a future credit rating downgrade vary by contract and can be based on ratings by either or both of Moody’s and S&P. At June 30, 2014, the future potential collateral amounts and termination payments that could be called or required by counterparties or exchanges and clearing organizations in the event of one-notch or two-notch downgrade scenarios based on the relevant contractual downgrade triggers were $1,606 million and an incremental $3,149 million, respectively.

While certain aspects of a credit rating downgrade are quantifiable pursuant to contractual provisions, the impact it will have on the Company’s business and results of operation in future periods is inherently uncertain and will depend on a number of interrelated factors, including, among others, the magnitude of the downgrade, individual client behavior and future mitigating actions the Company may take. The liquidity impact of additional collateral requirements is included in the Company’s Liquidity Stress Tests.

Capital Management.

The Company’s senior management views capital as an important source of financial strength. The Company actively manages its consolidated capital position based upon, among other things, business opportunities, risks, capital availability and rates of return together with internal capital policies, regulatory requirements and rating agency guidelines and, therefore, in the future may expand or contract its capital base to address the changing needs of its businesses. The Company attempts to maintain total capital, on a consolidated basis, at least equal to the sum of its operating subsidiaries’ required equity.

At June 30, 2014, the Company had approximately $0.8 billion remaining under its current share repurchase program out of the $6 billion authorized by the Board of Directors in December 2006. The share repurchase program is for capital management purposes and considers, among other things, business segment capital needs as well as equity-based compensation and benefit plan requirements. Share repurchases under the Company’s existing authorized program will be exercised from time to time at prices the Company deems appropriate subject to various factors, including the Company’s capital position and market conditions. The share repurchases may

LOGO 138


Table of Contents

be effected through open market purchases or privately negotiated transactions, including through Rule 10b5-1 plans, and may be suspended at any time. Share repurchases by the Company are subject to regulatory approval (see “Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds” in Part II, Item 2). The share repurchase program has no set expiration or termination date.

In March 2014, the Company received no objection from the Federal Reserve to the Company’s 2014 capital plan, which included a share repurchase of up to $1 billion of the Company’s outstanding common stock beginning in the second quarter of 2014 through the end of the first quarter of 2015, as well as an increase in the Company’s quarterly common stock dividend to $0.10 per share from $0.05 per share, beginning with the dividend declared on April 17, 2014. During the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2014, the Company repurchased approximately $284 million and $434 million, respectively, of the Company’s outstanding common stock as part of its share repurchase program.

The Board of Directors determines the declaration and payment of dividends on a quarterly basis. In July 2014, the Company announced that its Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend per common share of $0.10. In June 2014, the Company also announced that the Board of Directors declared a quarterly dividend of $252.78 per share of Series A Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $0.25278), a quarterly dividend of $25.00 per share of Series C Non-Cumulative Non-Voting Perpetual Preferred Stock, a quarterly dividend of $445.31 per share of Series E Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock (represented by Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000 th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $0.44531), a quarterly dividend of $429.69 per share of Series F Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000 th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $0.42969), an initial quarterly dividend of $349.65 per share of Series G Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/1,000 th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $0.34965) and an initial semi-annual dividend of $287.64 per share of Series H Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock (represented by Depositary Shares, each representing a 1/25 th interest in a share of preferred stock and each having a dividend of $11.50556).

Issuances of Preferred Stock.

Series G Preferred Stock. On April 29, 2014, the Company issued 20,000,000 Depositary Shares, for an aggregate price of $500 million. Each Depositary Share represents a 1/1,000th interest in a share of perpetual 6.625% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series G, $0.01 par value (“Series G Preferred Stock”). The Series G Preferred Stock is redeemable at the Company’s option, (i) in whole or in part, from time to time, on any dividend payment date on or after July 15, 2019 or (ii) in whole but not in part at any time within 90 days following a regulatory capital treatment event (as described in the terms of that series), in each case at a redemption price of $25,000 per share (equivalent to $25.00 per Depositary Share). The Series G Preferred Stock also has a preference over the Company’s common stock upon liquidation. The Series G Preferred Stock offering (net of related issuance costs) resulted in proceeds of approximately $494 million.

Series H Preferred Stock. On April 29, 2014, the Company issued 1,300,000 Depositary Shares, for an aggregate price of $1,300 million. Each Depositary Share represents a 1/25th interest in a share of perpetual Fixed-to-Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series H, $0.01 par value (“Series H Preferred Stock”). The Series H Preferred Stock is redeemable at the Company’s option, (i) in whole or in part, from time to time, on any dividend payment date on or after July 15, 2019 or (ii) in whole but not in part at any time within 90 days following a regulatory capital treatment event (as described in the terms of that series), in each case at a redemption price of $25,000 per share (equivalent to $1,000 per Depositary Share). The Series H Preferred Stock also has a preference over the Company’s common stock upon liquidation. The Series H Preferred Stock offering (net of related issuance costs) resulted in proceeds of approximately $1,294 million.

139 LOGO


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the tangible Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity and tangible common equity at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013 and average balances for the six months ended June 30, 2014:

Balance at Average Balance(1)
June 30,
2014
December 31,
2013
For the Six
Months Ended
June 30, 2014
(dollars in millions)

Common equity

$ 65,735 $ 62,701 $ 63,944

Preferred equity

5,020 3,220 3,991

Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity

70,755 65,921 67,935

Junior subordinated debentures issued to capital trusts

4,876 4,849 4,862

Less: Goodwill and net intangible assets(2)

(9,731 ) (9,873 ) (9,803 )

Tangible Morgan Stanley shareholders’ equity

$ 65,900 $ 60,897 $ 62,994

Common equity

$ 65,735 $ 62,701 $ 63,944

Less: Goodwill and net intangible assets(2)

(9,731 ) (9,873 ) (9,803 )

Tangible common equity(3)

$ 56,004 $ 52,828 $ 54,141

(1) The Company calculates its average balances based upon month-end balances.
(2) The goodwill and net intangible assets deduction excluding mortgage servicing rights (net of disallowable mortgage servicing rights) was $7 million at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013.
(3) Tangible common equity, a non-GAAP financial measure, equals common equity less goodwill and net intangible assets as defined above. The Company views tangible common equity as a useful measure to investors because it is a commonly utilized metric and reflects the common equity deployed in the Company’s businesses.

Capital Covenants.

In October 2006 and April 2007, the Company executed replacement capital covenants in connection with offerings by Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VII and Morgan Stanley Capital Trust VIII (the “Capital Securities”), which become effective after the scheduled redemption date in 2046. Under the terms of the replacement capital covenants, the Company has agreed, for the benefit of certain specified holders of debt, to limitations on its ability to redeem or repurchase any of the Capital Securities for specified periods of time. For a complete description of the Capital Securities and the terms of the replacement capital covenants, see the Company’s Current Reports on Form 8-K dated October 12, 2006 and April 26, 2007.

Regulatory Requirements.

Regulatory Capital Framework.

The Company is a financial holding company under the Bank Holding Company Act of 1956, as amended, and is subject to the regulation and oversight of the Federal Reserve. The Federal Reserve establishes capital requirements for the Company, including well-capitalized standards, and evaluates the Company’s compliance with such capital requirements. The Office of the Comptroller of the Currency (“OCC”) establishes similar capital requirements and standards for the Company’s U.S. Banks.

Implementation of U.S. Basel III.

The U.S. banking regulators have comprehensively revised their risk-based and leverage capital framework to implement many aspects of the Basel III capital standards established by the Basel Committee. The U.S. banking regulators’ revised capital framework is referred to herein as “U.S. Basel III.” The Company and the Company’s U.S. Banks became subject to U.S. Basel III on January 1, 2014. Aspects of U.S. Basel III, such as the minimum risk-based capital ratio requirements, new capital buffers and certain deductions from and adjustments to capital, will be phased-in over several years. Prior to January 1, 2014, the Company and the Company’s U.S. Banks

LOGO 140


Table of Contents

calculated regulatory capital ratios using the U.S. banking regulators’ U.S. Basel I-based rules (“U.S. Basel I”) as supplemented by rules that implemented the Basel Committee’s market risk capital framework amendment, commonly referred to as “Basel 2.5.”

Regulatory Capital. Under U.S. Basel III new items are deducted from the respective tiers of regulatory capital and certain existing regulatory deductions and adjustments are modified or are no longer applicable. The majority of these capital deductions are subject to a phase-in schedule and will be fully phased in by 2018. Unrealized gains and losses on AFS Securities are reflected in Common Equity Tier 1 capital, subject to a phase-in schedule. The percentage of the regulatory deductions and adjustments to Common Equity Tier 1 capital that apply to the Company in 2014 ranges from 20% to 100%, depending on the specific item.

In addition, U.S. Basel III also narrows the eligibility criteria for regulatory capital instruments. As a result of these revisions, existing trust preferred securities will be fully phased out of the Company’s Tier 1 capital by January 1, 2016. Thereafter, existing trust preferred securities that do not satisfy U.S. Basel III’s eligibility criteria for Tier 2 capital will be phased out of the Company’s regulatory capital by January 1, 2022.

Risk-weighted Assets. The Company is required to calculate and hold capital against credit, market and operational RWAs. RWAs reflect both on- and off-balance sheet risk of the Company. Credit RWAs reflect capital charges attributable to the risk of loss arising from a borrower or counterparty failing to meet its financial obligations. Market RWAs reflect capital charges attributable to the risk of loss resulting from adverse changes in market prices and other factors. For a further discussion of the Company’s market and credit risks, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Credit Risk” in Item 3. Operational RWAs reflect capital charges attributable to the risk of loss resulting from inadequate or failed processes, people and systems or from external events ( e.g. , fraud, legal and compliance risks or damage to physical assets). The Company may incur operational risks across the full scope of its business activities, including revenue-generating activities ( e.g. , sales and trading) and control groups ( e.g. , information technology and trade processing).

In March 2014, the Basel Committee established a new methodology for calculating counterparty credit risk exposures: the standardized approach for measuring counterparty credit risk exposures (“SA-CCR”). The Company understands that U.S. banking regulators are considering whether and how to implement the SA-CCR methodology in the United States, which may in the future impact the Company’s calculation of RWAs. In addition, the Basel Committee has several proposals under consideration related to RWA calculation methodologies, including proposals with respect to trading book and securitization positions. The impact of these proposals on the Company’s calculation of RWAs will not be known with certainty until such proposals are finalized.

Calculation of Risk-based Capital Ratios. On February 21, 2014, the Federal Reserve and the OCC approved the Company’s and the Company’s U.S. Banks’ completion of the parallel run process under the Advanced Approach framework. As Advanced Approach banking organizations, the Company and the Company’s U.S. Banks are required to compute risk-based capital ratios using both (i) a Standardized Approach, represented as U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5 for calendar year 2014 and beginning in 2015, the U.S. Basel III Standardized Approach for calculating credit and market RWAs; and (ii) after completing the parallel run process, an advanced internal ratings-based approach for calculating credit RWAs and advanced measurement approaches for calculating operational RWAs, as supplemented by advanced market RWAs calculated under U.S. Basel III (the “Advanced Approach”). A key difference between the Standardized and Advanced Approach is that the former mandates the use of standardized risk weights and methodologies for calculating RWAs, whereas the latter permits the use of supervisor-approved internal models and methodologies that meet specified qualitative and quantitative requirements to calculate RWAs, which generally give rise to more risk-sensitive measurements. The Advanced Approach includes a specific capital requirement for operational risk.

To implement a provision of the Dodd-Frank Act, U.S. Basel III subjects Advanced Approach banking organizations, such as the Company and the Company’s U.S. Banks, to a permanent “capital floor.” The capital

141 LOGO


Table of Contents

floor is based on the lower of the capital ratios calculated under either the Advanced Approach or a Standardized Approach, represented as U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5 for calendar year 2014 and, beginning on January 1, 2015, the U.S. Basel III Standardized Approach. The U.S. Basel III Standardized Approach modifies certain U.S. Basel I methods for calculating RWAs and prescribes new standardized risk weights for certain types of assets and exposures. The capital floor applies to the calculation of both minimum risk-based capital requirements as well as the capital conservation buffer and, if deployed by banking regulators, the countercyclical capital buffer.

The methods for calculating each of the Company’s risk-based capital ratios will change as U.S. Basel III’s revisions to the numerator and denominator are phased-in and as the Company begins calculating RWAs using the Advanced Approach and the Standardized Approach. These ongoing methodological changes may result in differences in the Company’s reported capital ratios from one reporting period to the next that are independent of changes to the Company’s capital base, asset composition, off-balance sheet exposures or risk profile. The basis for the calculation of the Company’s U.S. Basel III capital ratios, on a transitional and fully phased-in basis, are presented below:

Transition Period

Fully Phased-In(1)

March 31, 2014

June 30, 2014 to
December 31, 2014

2015 to 2017

2018 and onwards

Regulatory Capital (Numerator
of risk-based capital and leverage ratios)

U.S. Basel III Transitional(2) U.S. Basel III

RWAs (Denominator of risk-based capital ratios)

Standardized Approach U.S. Basel I and Basel  2.5 U.S. Basel III  Standardized Approach
Advanced Approach(3) U.S. Basel III Advanced  Approach

Denominator of leverage ratios

Tier 1 Leverage Ratio Adjusted Average  On-Balance Sheet Assets(4)

Supplementary Leverage
Ratio(5)

Adjusted Average On-Balance Sheet Assets and Certain Off-Balance Sheet Exposures

(1) By the beginning of 2018, U.S. Basel III rules defining capital (numerator of capital ratios) will be fully phased-in, except for the exclusion of non-qualifying trust preferred securities from Tier 2 capital, which will be fully phased-in beginning in 2022. In addition, the Company will also be subject to a 2.5% Common Equity Tier 1 capital conservation buffer and, if deployed by banking regulators, up to a 2.5% Common Equity Tier 1 countercyclical buffer on a fully phased-in basis beginning in 2019. The capital conservation buffer and, if deployed, the countercyclical buffer apply to each of the Common Equity Tier 1, Tier 1 and Total Capital ratios. The requirements for these additional capital buffers will be phased-in beginning in 2016.
(2) Beginning June 30, 2014, as a result of the Company’s and the Company’s U.S. Banks’ completion of the Advanced Approach parallel run, the amount of expected credit loss that exceeds eligible credit reserves must be deducted 20% from Common Equity Tier 1 capital and 80% from Additional Tier 1 capital. Over the next several years, this deduction from Common Equity Tier 1 capital will incrementally increase and the amount deducted from Additional Tier 1 capital will correspondingly decrease, until fully transitioned by 2018. In addition, under the Basel III Advanced Approach framework, the allowance for loan losses cannot be included in Tier 2 capital. Instead, an Advanced Approach banking organization may include in Tier 2 capital any eligible credit reserves that exceed its total expected credit losses to the extent that the excess reserve amount does not exceed 0.6% of its Advanced Approach credit RWAs. The allowance for loan losses may continue to be included in Tier 2 capital for purposes of calculating capital ratios under U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5 and under the Standardized Approach, up to 1.25% of credit RWAs.
(3) Public reporting of Advanced Approach capital ratios began with the quarter ended June 30, 2014.
(4) In accordance with U.S. Basel III, adjusted average assets represent the Company’s average total on-balance sheet assets minus certain amounts deducted from Tier 1 capital.
(5) Beginning in 2015, the Company will be required to publicly disclose its supplementary leverage ratio, which will become effective as a capital standard on January 1, 2018.

Beginning in the second quarter of 2014, the Company’s risk-based capital ratios for regulatory purposes are the lower of each ratio calculated under U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5 and the Advanced Approach.

LOGO 142


Table of Contents

Beginning January 1, 2015, the Company’s risk-based capital ratios for regulatory purposes for calculating the capital conservation buffer and, if deployed by banking regulators, the countercyclical capital buffer, will be the lower of each ratio calculated under the Advanced Approach and U.S. Basel III Standardized Approach.

The Company’s Regulatory Capital and Capital Ratios. The following table presents the Company’s capital ratios at June 30, 2014. Each ratio represents the lower of the Company’s risk-based capital ratios (on a transitional basis) calculated using a U.S. Basel III transitional numerator and RWAs computed under U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5 and under the Advanced Approach.

At June 30, 2014, the Company’s risk-based capital ratios were lower under the Advanced Approach transitional rules. In addition, the table also presents the minimum required regulatory capital ratios applicable under U.S. Basel III:

Actual Capital Ratios
June 30, 2014
Required Minimum Capital Ratios
2014 Fully Phased-In(2)

Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio

13.9 % 4.0 % 4.5 %

Tier 1 capital ratio

15.4 % 5.5 % 6.0 %

Total capital ratio

17.4 % 8.0 % 8.0 %

Tier 1 leverage ratio(1)

7.8 % 4.0 % 4.0 %

(1) Defined as the ratio of Tier 1 capital to average total on-balance sheet assets (subject to certain adjustments in accordance with U.S. Basel III rules).
(2) Minimum fully phased-in capital ratios do not include the capital conservation buffer and countercyclical capital buffer.

On a fully phased-in basis by 2019, the Company will also be subject to a 2.5% Common Equity Tier 1 capital conservation buffer and, if deployed by banking regulators, up to a 2.5% Common Equity Tier 1 countercyclical buffer. Failure to maintain such buffers will result in restrictions on the Company’s ability to make capital distributions, including the payment of dividends and the repurchase of stock and to pay discretionary bonuses to executive officers.

While the Federal Reserve has not yet revised the well-capitalized standard for financial holding companies to reflect the higher capital standards in U.S. Basel III, the U.S. banking regulators have revised the well-capitalized standards for insured depository institutions such as the Company’s U.S. Banks. Assuming that the Federal Reserve will apply the same or very similar well-capitalized standards to financial holding companies, each of the Company’s risk-based capital ratios and Tier 1 leverage ratio, at June 30, 2014, would exceed the revised well-capitalized standard.

143 LOGO


Table of Contents

The following is a six-month roll-forward of the Company’s Common Equity Tier 1 capital, Additional Tier 1 capital and Tier 2 capital calculated under U.S. Basel III on a transitional basis from December 31, 2013 to June 30, 2014.

Six Months Ended
June 30, 2014
(dollars in millions)

Common Equity Tier 1 capital:

Tier 1 Common capital under U.S. Basel I rules at December 31, 2013

$ 49,917

Change in the value of shareholders’ common equity

3,034

New items subject to deduction and adjustments under U.S. Basel III Advanced transitional rules:

Credit spread premium over risk-free rate for derivative liabilities

(147 )

Investments in capital instruments of unconsolidated financial institutions

(98 )

Expected credit loss that exceeds eligible credit reserves(1)

(31 )

Other new deductions and adjustments

(41 )

Modification of existing deductions under U.S. Basel III Advanced transitional rules:

Net goodwill

(201 )

Net intangible assets (other than goodwill and mortgage servicing assets)

2,703

Net deferred tax assets

2,285

Net after-tax debt valuation adjustment

(1,047 )

Adjustments related to accumulated other comprehensive income

186

U.S. Basel I deductions that are no longer applicable under U.S. Basel III Advanced transitional rules

1,584

Common Equity Tier 1 capital under U.S. Basel III Advanced transitional rules at June 30, 2014

$ 58,144

Additional Tier 1 capital:

Additional Tier 1 capital under U.S. Basel I rules at December 31, 2013

$ 11,090

New issuance of qualifying preferred stock

1,800

Modification of treatment of Additional Tier 1 capital components under U.S. Basel III Advanced transitional rules:

Trust preferred securities

(2,323 )

Nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

(1,924 )

New items subject to deduction and adjustments under U.S. Basel III Advanced transitional rules:

Net deferred tax assets

(2,376 )

Credit spread premium over risk-free rate for derivative liabilities

(589 )

Net after-tax debt valuation adjustment

911

Expected credit loss that exceeds eligible credit reserves

(123 )

Other adjustments and deductions

(77 )

Additional Tier 1 capital at June 30, 2014

$ 6,389

Tier 1 capital (Common Equity Tier 1 capital plus Additional Tier 1 capital) at June 30, 2014

$ 64,533

Tier 2 capital:

Tier 2 capital under U.S. Basel I rules at December 31, 2013

$ 4,993

Change in subordinated debt

288

De-recognition of allowance for loan and lease losses under Basel III Advanced transitional rules(2)

(284 )

New capital components subject to recognition under U.S. Basel III Advanced transitional rules:

Trust preferred securities

2,438

Nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

23

New items subject to deduction and adjustments under U.S. Basel III Advanced transitional rules

(54 )

U.S. Basel I deductions that are no longer applicable under U.S. Basel III Advanced transitional rules

850

Tier 2 capital at June 30, 2014

$ 8,254

Total capital at June 30, 2014

$ 72,787

(1) Beginning June 30, 2014, as a result of the Company’s and the Company’s U.S. Banks’ completion of the Advanced Approach parallel run, the amount of expected credit loss that exceeds eligible credit reserves must be deducted 20% from Common Equity Tier 1 capital and 80% from Additional Tier 1 capital. Over the next several years, this deduction from Common Equity Tier 1 capital will incrementally increase and the amount deducted from Additional Tier 1 capital will correspondingly decrease, until fully transitioned by 2018.

LOGO 144


Table of Contents
(2) For purposes of calculating capital ratios under the Advanced Approach, the allowance for loan losses cannot be included in Tier 2 capital. Instead, an Advanced Approach banking organization may include in Tier 2 capital any eligible credit reserves that exceed its total expected credit losses to the extent that the excess reserve amount does not exceed 0.6% of its Advanced Approach credit RWAs. The allowance for loan losses may continue to be included in Tier 2 capital for purposes of calculating capital ratios under U.S. Basel I and Basel 2.5 and under the Standardized Approach, up to 1.25% of credit RWAs.

The following table shows the adjustments made to the Company’s equity to determine Common Equity Tier 1, Additional Tier 1, Tier 2 and Total capital as defined in U.S. Basel III on a transitional basis.

At June 30, 2014 At December 31, 2013
U.S. Basel III
Transitional/
Advanced Approach
U.S. Basel III
Transitional/
Basel I + 2.5
Approach
U.S. Basel I
(dollars in millions)

Common Equity Tier 1 capital:

Common stock and surplus

$ 21,324 $ 21,324 $ 21,622

Retained earnings

45,144 45,144 42,172

Accumulated other comprehensive (loss)

(733 ) (733 ) (1,093 )

Regulatory adjustments and deductions:

Less: Net goodwill

(6,796 ) (6,796 ) (6,595 )

Less: Net intangible assets (other than goodwill and mortgage servicing assets)

(576 ) (576 ) (3,279 )

Less: Credit spread premium over risk free rate for derivative liabilities

(147 ) (147 ) N/A

Less: Net deferred tax assets

(594 ) (594 ) (2,879 )

Less: Investments in capital instruments of unconsolidated financial institutions

(98 ) (98 ) N/A

After-tax debt valuation adjustment

228 228 1,275

Adjustments related to accumulated other comprehensive income

464 464 278

Expected credit loss over eligible credit reserves(1)

(31 ) (31 ) N/A

Other adjustments and deductions

(41 ) (41 ) (1,584 )

Total Common Equity Tier 1 capital

$ 58,144 $ 58,144 $ 49,917

Additional Tier 1 capital:

Preferred stock

$ 5,020 $ 5,020 $ 3,220

Trust preferred securities

2,438 2,438 4,761

Nonredeemable noncontrolling interests

1,185 1,185 3,109

Regulatory adjustments and deductions:

Less: Net deferred tax assets

(2,376 ) (2,376 ) N/A

Less: Credit spread premium over risk free rate for derivative liabilities

(589 ) (589 ) N/A

After-tax debt valuation adjustment

911 911 N/A

Expected credit loss over eligible credit reserves

(123 ) (123 ) N/A

Other adjustments and deductions

(77 ) (77 ) N/A

Additional Tier 1 capital

$ 6,389 $ 6,389 $ 11,090

Total Tier 1 capital

$ 64,533 $ 64,533 $ 61,007

Tier 2 capital:

Subordinated debt

$ 5,847 $ 5,847 $ 5,559

Trust preferred securities

2,438 2,438 N/A

Other qualifying amounts(1)

23 318 284

Regulatory adjustments and deductions

(54 ) (54 ) (850 )

Total Tier 2 capital

$ 8,254 $ 8,549 $ 4,993

Total capital

$ 72,787 $ 73,082 $ 66,000

145 LOGO


Table of Contents

N/A—Not Applicable

(1) For purposes of calculating capital ratios under the Advanced Approach, the allowance for loan losses cannot be included in Tier 2 capital. Instead, an Advanced Approach banking organization may include in Tier 2 capital any eligible credit reserves that exceed its total expected credit losses to the extent that the excess reserve amount does not exceed 0.6% of its Advanced Approach credit RWAs. The allowance for loan losses may continue to be included in Tier 2 capital for purposes of calculating capital ratios under U.S. Basel I and Basel 2.5 and under the Standardized Approach, up to 1.25% of credit RWAs.

The following table presents the Company’s RWAs and regulatory capital ratios at June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013:

At June 30, 2014 At December 31, 2013
U.S. Basel III
Transitional/
Advanced Approach
U.S. Basel III
Transitional/
Basel I + 2.5  Approach
U.S. Basel I(1)
(dollars in millions)

RWAs:

Credit risk

$ 182,381 $ 288,794 $ 255,915

Market risk

126,800 114,144 133,760

Operational risk

108,873 N/A N/A

Total RWAs

$ 418,054 $ 402,938 $ 389,675

Capital ratios:

Common Equity Tier 1 ratio/Tier 1 common capital ratio

13.9 % 14.4 % 12.8 %

Tier 1 capital ratio

15.4 % 16.0 % 15.7 %

Total capital ratio

17.4 % 18.1 % 16.9 %

Tier 1 leverage ratio

7.8 % 7.8 % 7.6 %

Adjusted average assets(2)

$ 824,662 $ 824,662 $ 805,838

N/A—Not Applicable

(1) The standards applicable in 2013 included U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5. The Company’s Total capital, Tier 1 capital, Tier 1 common capital and Tier 1 leverage ratios and RWAs at December 31, 2013 were calculated under this framework.
(2) Average total on-balance sheet assets subject to certain adjustments in accordance with U.S. Basel I rules for the quarter ended December 31, 2013 and U.S. Basel III rules for the quarter ended June 30, 2014.

The Company estimates its pro forma Common Equity Tier 1 risk-based capital ratio under the fully phased-in Advanced Approach and the fully phased-in U.S. Basel III Standardized Approach to be approximately 12.3% and 10.7%, respectively, at June 30, 2014. These estimates are based on the Company’s current understanding of U.S. Basel III and other factors, which may be subject to change as the Company receives additional clarification and implementation guidance from regulators relating to U.S. Basel III, and as the interpretation of the regulation evolves over time. The pro forma risk-based Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio estimates are non-GAAP financial measures that the Company considers to be useful measures for evaluating compliance with new regulatory capital requirements that have not yet become effective. The pro forma risk-based Common Equity Tier 1 capital ratio estimates are based on shareholders’ equity, Common Equity Tier 1 capital, RWAs and certain other data inputs at June 30, 2014. These preliminary estimates are subject to risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results to differ materially and should not be taken as a projection of what the Company’s capital ratios, RWAs, earnings or other results will actually be at future dates. For a discussion of risks and uncertainties that may affect the future results of the Company, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of the Form 10-K.

Capital Plans and Stress Tests .    The Federal Reserve’s capital plan final rule requires large bank holding companies such as the Company to submit annual capital plans in order for the Federal Reserve to assess their systems and processes that incorporate forward-looking projections of revenues and losses to monitor and

LOGO 146


Table of Contents

maintain their internal capital adequacy. The rule also requires that such companies receive no objection from the Federal Reserve before making a capital distribution.

In addition, the Federal Reserve’s final rule on stress testing under the Dodd-Frank Act requires the Company to conduct semi-annual company-run stress tests. The rule also subjects the Company to an annual supervisory stress test conducted by the Federal Reserve. The capital planning and stress testing requirements for large bank holding companies form part of the Federal Reserve’s annual Comprehensive Capital Assessment and Review (“CCAR”) process.

The Company submitted its 2014 annual capital plan to the Federal Reserve in January 2014. In March 2014, the Federal Reserve published summary results of the Dodd-Frank Act and CCAR supervisory stress tests of each large bank holding company, including the Company. The Company received no objection to its 2014 capital plan (see “Capital Management” herein).

In February 2014, the Federal Reserve issued a final rule specifying how large bank holding companies, including the Company, should incorporate U.S. Basel III into their capital plans and Dodd-Frank Act stress test results. Among other things, the final rule requires large bank holding companies to project both Tier 1 Common capital ratio using the methodology currently in effect under U.S. Basel I as supplemented by Basel 2.5 and Common Equity Tier 1 ratio under U.S. Basel III after giving effect to transitional arrangements. The final rule also requires Advanced Approach banking organizations, including the Company, to incorporate the Advanced Approach into the capital planning and stress testing cycles that begin on October 1, 2015. In June 2014, the Federal Reserve proposed revisions to its capital planning and stress testing regulations that would, among other things, limit a large bank holding company’s ability to make capital distributions in any quarter to the extent that its actual capital issuances were less than the amount indicated in its capital plan for that quarter and shift the commencement and submission dates of the capital plan and stress test cycles beginning with the 2015-2016 cycles.

The Dodd-Frank Act also requires a national bank with total consolidated assets of more than $10 billion to conduct an annual company-run stress test. Beginning in 2012, the OCC’s implementing regulation requires national banks with $50 billion or more in average total consolidated assets, including MSBNA, to conduct its Dodd-Frank Act stress test. MSBNA submitted its company-run stress test results to the OCC and the Federal Reserve on January 6, 2014. The OCC’s regulation also requires a national bank with more than $10 billion but less than $50 billion in average total consolidated assets, including MSPBNA, to submit the results of its Dodd-Frank Act stress test by March 31, 2014. However, MSPBNA was given an exemption by the OCC for the 2014 Dodd-Frank Act stress test.

Risk-based Capital Surcharge. In addition to U.S. Basel III, the Dodd-Frank Act requires the Federal Reserve to establish more stringent capital requirements for certain bank holding companies, including the Company. The Federal Reserve has indicated that it intends to address this requirement by implementing the Basel Committee’s capital surcharge for global systemically important banks (“G-SIBs”). The Financial Stability Board (“FSB”) has provisionally identified the G-SIBs and assigned each G-SIB a Common Equity Tier 1 capital surcharge ranging from 1.0% to 2.5% of RWAs. The Company was provisionally assigned a G-SIB capital surcharge of 1.5%. The FSB has stated that it intends to annually update the list of G-SIBs and the risk-based capital surcharge assigned to each G-SIB.

Supplementary Leverage Ratio. The U.S. banking regulators have issued a final rule to implement enhanced supplementary leverage ratio standards for certain large bank holding companies and their insured depository institution subsidiaries, including the Company and the Company’s U.S. Banks. Under the final rule, a covered bank holding company would need to maintain a Tier 1 supplementary leverage capital buffer of greater than 2% in addition to the 3% minimum supplementary leverage ratio (for a total of greater than 5%), in order to avoid limitations on capital distributions, including dividends and stock repurchases, and discretionary bonus payments

147 LOGO


Table of Contents

to executive officers. The final rule also establishes a “well-capitalized” threshold based on a supplementary leverage ratio of 6% for insured depository institution subsidiaries, including the Company’s U.S. Banks. In April 2014, the U.S. banking regulators proposed revisions to the denominator of the supplementary leverage ratio to implement the Basel Committee’s January 2014 revisions to the denominator of the Basel III leverage ratio. The revised denominator proposed by the U.S. banking regulators differs from the original version of the supplementary leverage ratio in the U.S. Basel III final rule with respect to the treatment of, among other things, derivatives (including centrally cleared derivatives and sold credit protection), repo-style transactions and certain off-balance sheet items. The enhanced supplementary leverage ratio standards will become effective on January 1, 2018 with public disclosure beginning in 2015. Based on a preliminary analysis of the U.S. banking regulators’ enhanced supplementary leverage ratio final rule and proposed revisions to the denominator of the supplementary leverage ratio, the Company estimates its pro forma supplementary leverage ratio to be approximately 4.6% at June 30, 2014. This estimate utilizes a fully phased-in Basel III Tier 1 capital numerator and a denominator of approximately $1.25 trillion which represents the Company’s consolidated assets under U.S. GAAP as adjusted, among other items, by: (i) the addition of the potential future exposure for derivative contracts (including contracts cleared for clients), off-balance sheet exposures multiplied by their respective credit conversion factors, counterparty credit risk associated with repo-style transactions, and the effective notional amount of sold credit protection reduced by certain qualifying purchased credit protection; and (ii) the subtraction of certain amounts deducted from the computation of Tier 1 capital. The pro forma supplementary leverage ratio estimate is a non-GAAP financial measure that the Company considers to be a useful measure for evaluating compliance with new regulatory capital requirements that have not yet become effective. Based on a preliminary analysis of the proposed standards, the Company expects to achieve a supplementary leverage ratio of greater than 5% in 2015 through accretion of capital and other actions, which may include derivative portfolio compression and other balance sheet optimization. The Company’s estimated Basel III supplementary leverage ratio is based upon its current interpretation and expectations regarding the proposed rule, and remains subject to ongoing review and revision. As the revised denominator of the supplementary leverage ratio is currently a proposed rule, and may change based on final rules issued by the U.S. banking regulators, the Company’s expectations are subject to risks and uncertainties that may cause actual results to differ materially from estimates based on the proposed denominator revisions. Further, the expectations should not be taken as a projection of what the Company’s supplemental leverage ratios or earnings or assets will actually be at future dates. For a discussion of risks and uncertainties that may affect the future results of the Company, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of the Form 10-K.

Required Capital.

The Company’s required capital (“Required Capital”) estimation is based on the Required Capital Framework, an internal capital adequacy measure. This framework is a risk-based and leverage use-of-capital measure, which is compared with the Company’s regulatory capital to ensure the Company maintains an amount of going concern capital after absorbing potential losses from extreme stress events where applicable, at a point in time. The Company defines the difference between its regulatory capital and aggregate Required Capital as Parent capital. Average Common Equity Tier 1 capital, aggregate Required Capital and Parent capital for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 were approximately $56.9 billion, $40.1 billion and $16.8 billion, respectively. The Company generally holds Parent capital for prospective regulatory requirements, including U.S. Basel III transitional deductions and adjustments expected to reduce the Company’s capital through 2018. The increase in Parent capital from the fourth quarter of 2013 to the second quarter of 2014 was primarily driven by these transitional provisions. The Company also holds Parent capital for organic growth, acquisitions and other capital needs.

Common Equity Tier 1 capital and common equity attribution to the business segments is based on capital usage calculated by the Required Capital Framework as well as each business segment’s relative contribution to total Company Required Capital. Required Capital is assessed at each business segment and further attributed to product lines. This process is intended to align capital with the risks in each business segment in order to allow senior management to evaluate returns on a risk-adjusted basis. The Required Capital Framework will evolve over time in response to changes in the business and regulatory environment and to incorporate enhancements in modeling techniques. The Company will continue to evaluate the framework with respect to the impact of future regulatory requirements, as appropriate.

LOGO 148


Table of Contents

The following table presents the business segments’ and Parent’s average Common Equity Tier 1 capital and average common equity for the quarters ended June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013:

June 30, 2014 (U.S. Basel III) December 31, 2013 (U.S. Basel I)
Average
Common Equity
Tier 1 Capital
Average
Common Equity
Average Tier 1
Common Capital
Average
Common Equity
(dollars in billions)

Institutional Securities

$ 32.5 $ 33.3 $ 31.4 $ 36.2

Wealth Management

5.5 11.5 4.5 13.2

Investment Management

2.1 3.1 1.8 2.9

Parent capital

16.8 16.7 11.9 10.7

Total

$ 56.9 $ 64.6 $ 49.6 $ 63.0

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements with Unconsolidated Entities.

The Company enters into various arrangements with unconsolidated entities, including variable interest entities, primarily in connection with its Institutional Securities and Investment Management business segments. See “Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements with Unconsolidated Entities” included in Part II, Item 7, of the Form 10-K and Note 7 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for further information.

See Note 11 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for further information on guarantees.

Commitments.

The Company’s commitments associated with outstanding letters of credit and other financial guarantees obtained to satisfy collateral requirements, investment activities, corporate lending and financing arrangements, mortgage lending and margin lending at June 30, 2014 were $161 billion. See Note 11 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for further information on Commitments.

Effects of Inflation and Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates.

To the extent that an increased inflation outlook results in rising interest rates or has negative impacts on the valuation of financial instruments that exceed the impact on the value of the Company’s liabilities, it may adversely affect the Company’s financial position and profitability. Rising inflation may also result in increases in the Company’s non-interest expenses that may not be readily recoverable in higher prices of services offered.

A significant portion of the Company’s business is conducted in currencies other than the U.S. dollar, and changes in foreign exchange rates relative to the U.S. dollar, therefore, can affect the value of non-U.S. dollar net assets, revenues and expenses. Potential exposures as a result of these fluctuations in currencies are closely monitored, and, where cost-justified, strategies are adopted that are designed to reduce the impact of these fluctuations on the Company’s financial performance. These strategies may include the financing of non-U.S. dollar assets with direct or swap-based borrowings in the same currency and the use of currency forward contracts or the spot market in various hedging transactions related to net assets, revenues, expenses or cash flows.

149 LOGO


Table of Contents
Item 3. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk.

Market Risk.

Market risk refers to the risk that a change in the level of one or more market prices, rates, indices, implied volatilities (the price volatility of the underlying instrument imputed from option prices), correlations or other market factors, such as market liquidity, will result in losses for a position or portfolio. Generally, the Company incurs market risk as a result of trading, investing and client facilitation activities, principally within the Institutional Securities business segment where the substantial majority of the Company’s Value-at-Risk (“VaR”) for market risk exposures is generated. In addition, the Company incurs trading-related market risk within the Wealth Management business segment. The Investment Management business segment incurs principally Non-trading market risk primarily from capital investments in real estate funds and investments in private equity vehicles. For a further discussion of the Company’s Market Risk, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management” in Part II, Item 7A of the Form 10-K.

VaR.

The Company uses the statistical technique known as VaR as one of the tools used to measure, monitor and review the market risk exposures of its trading portfolios. The Market Risk Department calculates and distributes daily VaR-based risk measures to various levels of management.

VaR Methodology, Assumptions and Limitations.

The Company estimates VaR using a model based on volatility adjusted historical simulation for general market risk factors and Monte Carlo simulation for name-specific risk in corporate shares, bonds, loans and related derivatives. The model constructs a distribution of hypothetical daily changes in the value of trading portfolios based on the following: historical observation of daily changes in key market indices or other market risk factors; and information on the sensitivity of the portfolio values to these market risk factor changes. The Company’s VaR model uses four years of historical data with a volatility adjustment to reflect current market conditions. The Company’s VaR for risk management purposes (“Management VaR”) is computed at a 95% level of confidence over a one-day time horizon, which is a useful indicator of possible trading losses resulting from adverse daily market moves. The Company’s 95%/one-day VaR corresponds to the unrealized loss in portfolio value that, based on historically observed market risk factor movements, would have been exceeded with a frequency of 5%, or five times in every 100 trading days, if the portfolio were held constant for one day.

The Company’s VaR model generally takes into account linear and non-linear exposures to equity and commodity price risk, interest rate risk, credit spread risk and foreign exchange rates. The model also takes into account linear exposures to implied volatility risks for all asset classes and non-linear exposures to implied volatility risks for equity, commodity and foreign exchange referenced products. The VaR model also captures certain implied correlation risks associated with portfolio credit derivatives as well as certain basis risks ( e.g., corporate debt and related credit derivatives).

The Company uses VaR as one of a range of risk management tools. Among their benefits, VaR models permit estimation of a portfolio’s aggregate market risk exposure, incorporating a range of varied market risks and portfolio assets. One key element of the VaR model is that it reflects risk reduction due to portfolio diversification or hedging activities. However, VaR has various limitations, which include, but are not limited to: use of historical changes in market risk factors, which may not be accurate predictors of future market conditions, and may not fully incorporate the risk of extreme market events that are outsized relative to observed historical market behavior or reflect the historical distribution of results beyond the 95% confidence interval; and reporting of losses in a single day, which does not reflect the risk of positions that cannot be liquidated or hedged in one day. A small proportion of market risk generated by trading positions is not included in VaR. The modeling of the risk characteristics of some positions relies on approximations that, under certain circumstances, could produce significantly different results from those produced using more precise measures. VaR is most

LOGO 150


Table of Contents

appropriate as a risk measure for trading positions in liquid financial markets and will understate the risk associated with severe events, such as periods of extreme illiquidity. The Company is aware of these and other limitations and, therefore, uses VaR as only one component in its risk management oversight process. This process also incorporates stress testing and scenario analyses and extensive risk monitoring, analysis, and control at the trading desk, division and Company levels.

The Company’s VaR model evolves over time in response to changes in the composition of trading portfolios and to improvements in modeling techniques and systems capabilities. The Company is committed to continuous review and enhancement of VaR methodologies and assumptions in order to capture evolving risks associated with changes in market structure and dynamics. As part of the Company’s regular process improvements, additional systematic and name-specific risk factors may be added to improve the VaR model’s ability to more accurately estimate risks to specific asset classes or industry sectors.

Since the reported VaR statistics are estimates based on historical data, VaR should not be viewed as predictive of the Company’s future revenues or financial performance or of its ability to monitor and manage risk. There can be no assurance that the Company’s actual losses on a particular day will not exceed the VaR amounts indicated below or that such losses will not occur more than five times in 100 trading days for a 95%/one-day VaR. VaR does not predict the magnitude of losses which, should they occur, may be significantly greater than the VaR amount.

VaR statistics are not readily comparable across firms because of differences in the firms’ portfolios, modeling assumptions and methodologies. These differences can result in materially different VaR estimates across firms for similar portfolios. The impact of such differences varies depending on the factor history assumptions, the frequency with which the factor history is updated, and the confidence level. As a result, VaR statistics are more useful when interpreted as indicators of trends in a firm’s risk profile, rather than as an absolute measure of risk to be compared across firms.

The Company utilizes the same VaR model for risk management purposes as well as regulatory capital calculations. The Company’s VaR model has been approved by the Company’s regulators for use in regulatory capital calculations.

The portfolio of positions used for the Company’s Management VaR differs from that used for regulatory capital requirements (“Regulatory VaR”), as Management VaR contains certain positions that are excluded from Regulatory VaR. Examples include counterparty credit valuation adjustments, and loans that are carried at fair value and associated hedges. Additionally, the Company’s Management VaR excludes certain risks contained in its Regulatory VaR, such as hedges to counterparty exposures related to the Company’s own credit spread.

Table 1 below presents the Management VaR for the Company’s Trading portfolio, on a period-end, quarterly average and quarterly high and low basis. The Credit Portfolio is disclosed as a separate category from the Primary Risk Categories, and includes loans that are carried at fair value and associated hedges, as well as counterparty credit valuation adjustments and related hedges.

151 LOGO


Table of Contents

Trading Risks.

The table below presents the Company’s 95%/one-day Management VaR:

Table 1: 95% Management VaR 95%/One-Day VaR for the
Quarter Ended June 30, 2014
95%/One-Day VaR for the
Quarter Ended March 31, 2014

Market Risk Category

Period
End
Average High Low Period
End
Average High Low
(dollars in millions)

Interest rate and credit spread

$ 32 $ 31 $ 37 $ 26 $ 31 $ 33 $ 40 $ 28

Equity price

21 18 22 15 19 19 26 16

Foreign exchange rate

7 9 17 6 15 14 17 11

Commodity price

18 19 22 17 19 20 24 15

Less: Diversification benefit(1)(2)

(31 ) (34 ) N/A N/A (41 ) (40 ) N/A N/A

Primary Risk Categories

$ 47 $ 43 $ 49 $ 37 $ 43 $ 46 $ 53 $ 41

Credit Portfolio

9 11 14 9 13 12 13 11

Less: Diversification benefit(1)(2)

(6 ) (6 ) N/A N/A (7 ) (8 ) N/A N/A

Total Management VaR

$ 50 $ 48 $ 55 $ 41 $ 49 $ 50 $ 58 $ 45

(1) Diversification benefit equals the difference between the total Management VaR and the sum of the component VaRs. This benefit arises because the simulated one-day losses for each of the components occur on different days; similar diversification benefits also are taken into account within each component.
(2) N/A–Not Applicable. The high and low VaR values for the total Management VaR and each of the component VaRs might have occurred on different days during the quarter, and therefore the diversification benefit is not an applicable measure.

The Company’s average Management VaR for the Primary Risk Categories for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 was $43 million compared with $46 million for the quarter ended March 31, 2014. The decrease was primarily driven by reduced exposure to credit spread products.

The average Credit Portfolio VaR for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 was $11 million compared with $12 million for the quarter ended March 31, 2014.

The average Total Management VaR for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 was $48 million compared with $50 million for the quarter ended March 31, 2014. This decrease was driven by the reduced risk in Primary Risk Categories.

Distribution of VaR Statistics and Net Revenues for the quarter ended June 30, 2014.

One method of evaluating the reasonableness of the Company’s VaR model as a measure of the Company’s potential volatility of net revenues is to compare the VaR with actual trading revenues. Assuming no intra-day trading, for a 95%/one-day VaR, the expected number of times that trading losses should exceed VaR during the year is 13, and, in general, if trading losses were to exceed VaR more than 21 times in a year, the adequacy of the VaR model would be questioned. The Company evaluates the reasonableness of its VaR model by comparing the potential declines in portfolio values generated by the model with actual trading results for the Company, as well as individual business units. For days where losses exceed the VaR statistic, the Company examines the drivers of trading losses to evaluate the VaR model’s accuracy relative to realized trading results.

The distribution of VaR Statistics and Net Revenues is presented in the histograms below for both the Primary Risk Categories and the Total Trading populations.

LOGO 152


Table of Contents

Primary Risk Categories.

As shown in Table 1, the Company’s average 95%/one-day Primary Risk Categories VaR for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 was $43 million. The histogram below presents the distribution of the Company’s daily 95%/one-day Primary Risk Categories VaR for the quarter ended June 30, 2014, which was in a range between $36 million and $48 million for approximately 95% of the trading days during the quarter.

LOGO

153 LOGO


Table of Contents

The histogram below shows the distribution of daily net trading revenues, which includes profits and losses from positions included in VaR for the Company’s businesses that comprise the Primary Risk Categories for the quarter ended June 30, 2014. Daily net trading revenues also include intraday trading activities but exclude certain items not captured in the VaR model, such as fees, commissions and net interest income. Daily net trading revenues differ from the definition of revenue required for Regulatory VaR backtesting, which further excludes intraday trading. During the quarter ended June 30, 2014, the Company’s businesses that comprise the Primary Risk Categories experienced net trading losses on 3 days, of which no day was in excess of the 95%/one-day Primary Risk Categories VaR.

LOGO

LOGO 154


Table of Contents

Total Trading—including the Primary Risk Categories and the Credit Portfolio.

As shown in Table 1, the Company’s average 95%/one-day Total Management VaR, which includes the Primary Risk Categories and the Credit Portfolio, for the quarter ended June 30, 2014 was $48 million. The histogram below presents the distribution of the Company’s daily 95%/one-day Total Management VaR for the quarter ended June 30, 2014, which was in a range between $41 million and $53 million for approximately 95% of trading days during the quarter.

LOGO

155 LOGO


Table of Contents

The histogram below shows the distribution of daily net trading revenues, which includes profits and losses from primary risk categories, credit portfolio positions and intraday trading activities, for the Company’s Trading businesses for the quarter ended June 30, 2014. Daily net trading revenues also include intraday trading activities but exclude certain items not captured in the VaR model, such as fees, commissions and net interest income. Daily net trading revenues differ from the definition of revenue required for Regulatory VaR backtesting, which further excludes intraday trading. During the quarter ended June 30, 2014, the Company experienced net trading losses on 3 days, of which no day was in excess of the 95%/one-day Total Management VaR.

LOGO

Non-Trading Risks.

The Company believes that sensitivity analysis is an appropriate representation of the Company’s non-trading risks. Reflected below is this analysis, which covers substantially all of the non-trading risk in the Company’s portfolio.

Counterparty Exposure Related to the Company’s Own Credit Spread.

The credit spread risk relating to the Company’s own mark-to-market derivative counterparty exposure is managed separately from VaR. The credit spread risk sensitivity of this exposure corresponds to an increase in value of approximately $6 million for each 1 basis point widening in the Company’s credit spread level for both June 30, 2014 and March 31, 2014.

Funding Liabilities.

The credit spread risk sensitivity of the Company’s mark-to-market funding liabilities corresponded to an increase in value of approximately $11 million for each 1 basis point widening in the Company’s credit spread level for both June 30, 2014 and March 31, 2014.

Interest Rate Risk Sensitivity on Income from Continuing Operations.

The Company measures the interest rate risk of certain assets and liabilities by calculating the hypothetical sensitivity of net interest income to potential changes in the level of interest rates over the next 12 months. This sensitivity analysis includes positions that are mark-to-market, as well as positions that are accounted for on an

LOGO 156


Table of Contents

accrual basis. For interest rate derivatives that are perfect economic hedges to non-mark-to-market assets or liabilities, the disclosed sensitivities include only the impact of the coupon accrual mismatch.

The hypothetical model does not assume any growth, change in business focus, asset pricing philosophy or asset/liability funding mix and does not capture how the Company would respond to significant changes in market conditions. Furthermore, the model does not reflect the Company’s expectations regarding the movement of interest rates in the near term, nor the actual effect on income from continuing operations before income taxes if such changes were to occur.

Given the current low interest rate environment, the Company uses the following interest rate scenarios to quantify the Company’s interest rate risk sensitivity: instantaneous parallel shocks of 100 and 200 basis point increases and 100 basis point decrease to all points on all yield curves simultaneously.

+200  Basis
Points
+100  Basis
Points
-100 Basis
Points(1)
(dollars in millions)

Impact on the Company’s consolidated income from continuing operations before income taxes:

June 30, 2014

$ 1,248 $ 716 N/M

March 31, 2014

1,259 714 N/M

(1) N/M – Not Meaningful given the current low interest rate environment.

Due to the non-trading nature of the assets and liabilities in the Company’s U.S. bank entities, net interest income sensitivity is computed and analyzed by management for both upward and downward movements in the yield curve. The Company uses the following interest rate scenarios to quantify the Company’s U.S. Banks’ interest rate risk sensitivity: instantaneous parallel shocks of 100 and 200 basis point increases and 100 basis point decrease to all points on all yield curves simultaneously.

+200  Basis
Points
+100  Basis
Points
-100  Basis
Points
(dollars in millions)

Impact on the Company’s U.S. Banks’ income from continuing operations before income taxes:

June 30, 2014

$ 593 $ 388 $ (275 )

March 31, 2014

669 420 (321 )

Investments.

The Company makes investments in both public and private companies. These investments are predominantly equity positions with long investment horizons, the majority of which are for business facilitation purposes. The market risk related to these investments is measured by estimating the potential reduction in net income associated with a 10% decline in investment values.

10% Sensitivity

Investments

June 30, 2014 March 31, 2014
(dollars in millions)

Investments related to Investment Management activities:

Hedge fund investments

$ 105 $ 108

Private equity and infrastructure funds

137 148

Real estate funds

159 158

Other investments:

Mitsubishi UFJ Morgan Stanley Securities Co., Ltd.

153 170

Other Company investments

234 194

157 LOGO


Table of Contents

Equity Market Sensitivity.

In the Company’s Wealth Management and Investment Management business segments, certain fee-based revenue streams are driven by the value of clients’ equity holdings. The overall level of revenues for those streams also depends on multiple additional factors that include, but are not limited to, the level and duration of the equity market decline, price volatility, the geographic and industry mix of client assets, the rate and magnitude of client investments and redemptions, and the impact of such market decline and price volatility on client behavior. Therefore, overall revenues do not correlate completely with changes in the equity markets.

Credit Risk.

Credit risk refers to the risk of loss arising when a borrower, counterparty or issuer does not meet its financial obligations. For a further discussion of the Company’s credit risks, see “Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk—Risk Management—Credit Risk” in Part II, Item 7A of the Form 10-K. See Notes 8 and 11 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for additional information about the Company’s financing receivables and lending commitments, respectively.

Lending Activities.

The Company provides loans to a variety of customers, from large corporate and institutional clients to high net worth individuals. In addition, the Company purchases loans in the secondary market. The table below summarizes the Company’s loan activity at June 30, 2014. Loans held for investment and loans held for sale are classified in Loans and loans held at fair value are classified in Trading assets in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition at June 30, 2014. See Notes 4 and 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for further information.

Institutional
Securities
Corporate
Lending(1)
Institutional
Securities
Other
Lending(2)
Wealth
Management
Lending(3)
Total(4)
(dollars in millions)

Corporate loans

$ 9,237 $ 5,151 $ 4,272 $ 18,660

Consumer loans

14,304 14,304

Residential real estate loans

12,618 12,618

Wholesale real estate loans

3,048 3,048

Loans held for investment, net of allowance

9,237 8,199 31,194 48,630

Corporate loans

5,304 187 5,491

Consumer loans

Residential real estate loans

4 89 93

Wholesale real estate loans

1,046 1,046

Loans held for sale

5,304 1,237 89 6,630

Corporate loans

1,236 8,352 9,588

Consumer loans

Residential real estate loans

1,873 1,873

Wholesale real estate loans

2,266 2,266

Loans held at fair value

1,236 12,491 13,727

Total loans

$ 15,777 $ 21,927 $ 31,283 $ 68,987

(1) In addition to loans, at June 30, 2014, $67.1 billion of unfunded lending commitments were accounted for as held for investment, $19.9 billion of unfunded lending commitments were accounted for as held for sale and $5.5 billion of unfunded lending commitments were accounted for at fair value.
(2) In addition to loans, at June 30, 2014, $1.8 billion of unfunded lending commitments were accounted for as held for investment, $0.2 billion of unfunded lending commitments were accounted for as held for sale and $2.3 billion of unfunded lending commitments were accounted for at fair value.

LOGO 158


Table of Contents
(3) In addition to loans, at June 30, 2014, $4.2 billion of unfunded lending commitments were accounted for as held for investment. At June 30, 2014 there were no unfunded lending commitments accounted for as held for sale.
(4) The above table excludes customer margin loans outstanding of $28.3 billion and employee loans outstanding of $5.2 billion at June 30, 2014. See Notes 6 and 8 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for further information.

Institutional Securities Corporate Lending Activities. In connection with certain of its Institutional Securities business segment activities, the Company provides loans or lending commitments to select corporate clients. These loans and lending commitments have varying terms; may be senior or subordinated; may be secured or unsecured; are generally contingent upon representations, warranties and contractual conditions applicable to the borrower; and may be syndicated, traded or hedged by the Company.

The Company’s corporate lending credit exposure is primarily from loan and lending commitments used for general corporate purposes, working capital and liquidity purposes and typically consists of revolving lines of credit, letter of credit facilities and term loans. In addition, the Company provides “event-driven” loans and lending commitments associated with a particular event or transaction, such as to support client merger, acquisition or recapitalization activities. The Company’s “event-driven” loans and lending commitments typically consist of revolving lines of credit, term loans and bridge loans.

Corporate lending commitments may not be indicative of the Company’s actual funding requirements, as the commitment may expire unused or the borrower may not fully utilize the commitment or the Company’s portion of the commitment may be reduced through the syndication or sales process. Such syndications or sales may involve third-party institutional investors where the Company may have a custodial relationship, such as prime brokerage clients.

The Company may hedge and/or sell its exposures in connection with loans and lending commitments. Additionally, the Company may mitigate credit risk by requiring borrowers to pledge collateral and include financial covenants in lending commitments. In the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition these loans are carried at either fair value with changes in fair value recorded in earnings; held for investment, which are recorded at amortized cost; or held for sale, which are recorded at lower of cost or fair value.

The table below presents the Company’s credit exposure from its corporate lending positions and lending commitments, which are measured in accordance with the Company’s internal risk management standards at June 30, 2014. The “total corporate lending exposure” column includes funded and unfunded lending commitments. Lending commitments represent legally binding obligations to provide funding to clients for all lending transactions. Since commitments associated with these business activities may expire unused or may not be utilized to full capacity, they do not necessarily reflect the actual future cash funding requirements.

Corporate Lending Commitments and Funded Loans at June 30, 2014

Years to Maturity Total
Corporate
Lending

Exposure(2)

Credit Rating(1)

Less than 1 1-3 3-5 Over 5
(dollars in millions)

AAA

$ 263 $ 74 $ 24 $ $ 361

AA

3,476 2,441 4,806 10,723

A

2,819 3,363 12,886 422 19,490

BBB

12,565 9,906 21,396 309 44,176

Investment grade

19,123 15,784 39,112 731 74,750

Non-investment grade

1,796 7,983 17,533 5,086 32,398

Total

$ 20,919 $ 23,767 $ 56,645 $ 5,817 $ 107,148

(1) Obligor credit ratings are determined by the Company’s Credit Risk Management Department.
(2) Total corporate lending exposure represents the Company’s potential loss assuming the market price of funded loans and lending commitments was zero.

159 LOGO


Table of Contents

During the quarter ended June 30, 2014, the loans and lending commitments in Corporate Lending increased approximately 12%, mainly due to growth in “event-driven” loans and lending commitments. At June 30, 2014, the aggregate amount of investment grade funded loans was $6.9 billion and the aggregate amount of non-investment grade funded loans was $7.9 billion. In connection with these corporate lending activities (which include corporate funded and unfunded lending commitments), the Company had hedges (which include “single name,” “sector” and “index” hedges) with a notional amount of $8.7 billion related to the total corporate lending exposure of $107.1 billion at June 30, 2014. At June 30, 2014, all Corporate lending activities held for investment were current.

“Event-Driven” Loans and Lending Commitments at June 30, 2014.

Included in the total corporate lending exposure amounts in the table above at June 30, 2014 were “event-driven” exposures of $24.2 billion composed of funded loans of $4.0 billion and lending commitments of $20.2 billion. Included in the “event-driven” exposure at June 30, 2014 were $12.2 billion of loans and lending commitments to non-investment grade borrowers. The maturity profile of the “event-driven” loans and lending commitments at June 30, 2014 was as follows: 50% will mature in less than 1 year, 7% will mature within 1 to 3 years, 23% will mature within 3 to 5 years and 20% will mature in over 5 years.

Industry Exposure—Corporate Lending. The Company also monitors its credit exposure to individual industries for credit exposure arising from corporate loans and lending commitments as discussed below.

The following table shows the Company’s credit exposure from its primary corporate loans and lending commitments by industry at June 30, 2014:

Industry

Corporate  Lending
Exposure
(dollars in millions)

Consumer staples

$ 16,887

Funds, exchanges and other financial services(1)

12,908

Energy

12,160

Utilities

11,687

Consumer discretionary

9,885

Industrials

9,425

Healthcare

9,271

Materials

7,519

Information technology

7,373

Telecommunications services

4,798

Insurance

3,555

Other

1,680

Total

$ 107,148

(1) Includes mutual funds, pension funds, private equity and real estate funds, exchanges and clearinghouses and diversified financial services.

Institutional Securities Other Lending Activities. In addition to the primary corporate lending activities described above, the Institutional Securities business segment engages in other lending activities. These activities primarily include corporate loans purchased in the secondary market, commercial and residential mortgage lending, asset-backed lending and financing extended to institutional clients. During the quarter ended June 30, 2014, the loans and lending commitments associated with these activities increased approximately 28%, mainly due to growth in corporate and wholesale real estate loans. At June 30, 2014, approximately 99.9% of Institutional Securities Other lending activities held for investment were current; approximately 0.1% were on non-accrual status because the loans were past due for a period of 90 days or more or payment of principal or interest was in doubt.

LOGO 160


Table of Contents

At June 30, 2014, Institutional Securities Other lending activities by remaining contract maturity were as follows:

Years to Maturity Total Institutional
Securities Other
Lending Activities
Less than 1 1-3 3-5 Over 5
(dollars in millions)

Corporate loans

$ 4,452 $ 5,188 $ 1,699 $ 2,353 $ 13,692

Consumer loans

Residential real estate loans

71 1,806 1,877

Wholesale real estate loans

306 1,871 2,571 1,610 6,358

Total

$ 4,758 $ 7,059 $ 4,341 $ 5,769 $ 21,927

In addition, Institutional Securities Other lending activities include margin lending, which allows the client to borrow against the value of qualifying securities. At June 30, 2014, Institutional Securities margin lending of $14.3 billion is classified within Customer and other receivables in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.

Wealth Management Lending Activities. The principal Wealth Management lending activities includes securities-based lending and residential real estate loans. At June 30, 2014, Wealth Management’s lending activities by remaining contract maturity were as follows:

Years to Maturity Total Wealth
Management
Lending Activities
Less than 1 1-3 3-5 Over 5
(dollars in millions)

Securities-based lending and other loans

$ 16,451 $ 918 $ 600 $ 607 $ 18,576

Residential real estate loans

12,707 12,707

Total

$ 16,451 $ 918 $ 600 $ 13,314 $ 31,283

Securities-based lending provided to the Company’s retail clients is primarily conducted through the Company’s Portfolio Loan Account (“PLA”) platform and had an outstanding balance of $16.3 billion within the $18.6 billion in the above table at June 30, 2014. These loans allow the client to borrow money against the value of qualifying securities for any purpose other than purchasing securities. The Company establishes approved credit lines against qualifying securities and monitors limits daily and, pursuant to such guidelines, requires customers to deposit additional collateral, or reduce debt positions, when necessary. These credit lines are uncommitted loan facilities, as the Company reserves the right not to make any advances, or may terminate these credit lines at any time whether or not an event of default has occurred. Factors considered in the review of these loans are the amount, the proposed pledged collateral and its diversification profile and, in the case of concentrated positions, liquidity of the underlying collateral or potential hedging strategies. Underlying collateral is also reviewed with respect to the valuation, trading history, volatility and any issuer or industry concentrations.

Residential real estate loans consist of first and second lien mortgages, including home equity lines of credit (“HELOC”) loans. For these loans, a loan evaluation process is adopted within a framework of credit underwriting policies and collateral valuation. The Company’s underwriting policy is designed to ensure that all borrowers pass an assessment of capacity and willingness to pay, which includes an analysis of applicable industry standard credit scoring models (e.g., Fair Isaac Corporation (“FICO”) scores), debt ratios and reserves of the borrower. Loan-to-value ratios are determined based on independent third-party property appraisal/valuations, and security lien position is established through title/ownership reports. Mortgage and HELOC loans are held for investment in the Company’s portfolio.

During the quarter ended June 30, 2014, the loans and lending commitments associated with Wealth Management’s lending activities increased approximately 8%, mainly due to growth in PLA and residential real

161 LOGO


Table of Contents

estate loans. At June 30, 2014, approximately 99.9% of Wealth Management’s lending activities held for investment were current; less than 0.1% were on non-accrual status because the loans were past due for a period of 90 days or more or payment of principal or interest was in doubt.

Wealth Management also provides margin lending to retail clients and had an outstanding balance of $14.0 billion at June 30, 2014, which is classified within Customer and other receivables in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition.

In addition, the Company’s Wealth Management business segment has employee loans that are granted primarily in conjunction with a program established by the Company to retain and recruit certain employees. These loans, recorded in Customer and other receivables in the condensed consolidated statements of financial condition, are full recourse, require periodic payments and have repayment terms ranging from four to 12 years. The Company establishes an allowance for loan amounts it does not consider recoverable from terminated employees, which is recorded in Compensation and benefits expense.

Credit Exposure—Derivatives.

The Company incurs credit risk as a dealer in over-the-counter (“OTC”) derivatives. Credit risk with respect to derivative instruments arises from the failure of a counterparty to perform according to the terms of the contract. In connection with its OTC derivative activities, the Company generally enters into master netting agreements and collateral arrangements with counterparties. These agreements provide the Company with the ability to demand collateral as well as to liquidate collateral and offset receivables and payables covered under the same master agreement in the event of counterparty default. The Company manages its trading positions by employing a variety of risk mitigation strategies. These strategies include diversification of risk exposures and hedging. Hedging activities consist of the purchase or sale of positions in related securities and financial instruments, including a variety of derivative products ( e.g. , futures, forwards, swaps and options). For credit exposure information on the Company’s OTC derivative products, see Note 10 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1.

Credit Derivatives. A credit derivative is a contract between a seller (guarantor) and buyer (beneficiary) of protection against the risk of a credit event occurring on one or more debt obligations issued by a specified reference entity. The beneficiary typically pays a periodic premium over the life of the contract and is protected for the period. If a credit event occurs, the guarantor is required to make payment to the beneficiary based on the terms of the credit derivative contract. Credit events, as defined in the contract, may be one or more of the following defined events: bankruptcy, dissolution or insolvency of the referenced entity, failure to pay, obligation acceleration, repudiation, payment moratorium and restructurings.

The Company trades in a variety of credit derivatives and may either purchase or write protection on a single name or portfolio of referenced entities. In transactions referencing a portfolio of entities or securities, protection may be limited to a tranche of exposure or a single name within the portfolio. The Company is an active market maker in the credit derivatives markets. As a market maker, the Company works to earn a bid-offer spread on client flow business and manages any residual credit or correlation risk on a portfolio basis. Further, the Company uses credit derivatives to manage its exposure to residential and commercial mortgage loans and corporate lending exposures during the periods presented. The effectiveness of the Company’s credit default swap (“CDS”) protection as a hedge of the Company’s exposures may vary depending upon a number of factors, including the contractual terms of the CDS.

The Company actively monitors its counterparty credit risk related to credit derivatives. A majority of the Company’s counterparties is composed of banks, broker-dealers, insurance and other financial institutions. Contracts with these counterparties may include provisions related to counterparty rating downgrades, which may result in additional collateral being required by the Company. As with all derivative contracts, the Company considers counterparty credit risk in the valuation of its positions and recognizes credit valuation adjustments as appropriate within Trading revenues in the condensed consolidated statements of income.

LOGO 162


Table of Contents

The following table summarizes the key characteristics of the Company’s credit derivative portfolio by counterparty at June 30, 2014. The fair values shown are before the application of any counterparty or cash collateral netting. For additional credit exposure information on the Company’s credit derivative portfolio, see Note 10 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1.

At June 30, 2014
Fair Values(1) Notionals
Receivable Payable Net Beneficiary Guarantor
(dollars in millions)

Banks and securities firms

$ 27,917 $ 27,205 $ 712 $ 903,065 $ 876,853

Insurance and other financial institutions

6,331 6,080 251 203,386 236,649

Non-financial entities

101 105 (4 ) 6,451 5,345

Total

$ 34,349 $ 33,390 $ 959 $ 1,112,902 $ 1,118,847

(1) The Company’s CDS are classified in both Level 2 and Level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Approximately 5% of receivable fair values and 7% of payable fair values represent Level 3 amounts (see Note 4 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1).

Other.

In addition to the activities noted above, there are other credit risks managed by the Company’s Credit Risk Management Department and various business areas within the Institutional Securities business segment. The Company participates in securitization activities whereby it extends short- or long-term funding to clients through loans and lending commitments that are secured by assets of the borrower and generally provide for over-collateralization, including commercial real estate, loans secured by loan pools, commercial company loans, and secured lines of revolving credit. Credit risk with respect to these loans and lending commitments arises from the failure of a borrower to perform according to the terms of the loan agreement or a decline in the underlying collateral value. See Note 7 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for information about the Company’s securitization activities. Certain risk management activities as they pertain to establishing appropriate collateral amounts for the Company’s prime brokerage and securitized product businesses are primarily monitored within those respective areas in that they determine the appropriate collateral level for each strategy or position. In addition, a collateral management group monitors collateral levels against requirements and oversees the administration of the collateral function. See Note 6 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1 for additional information about the Company’s collateralized transactions.

Country Risk Exposure.

Country risk exposure is the risk that uncertainties arising from the economic, social, security and political conditions within a foreign country (any country other than the U.S.) will adversely affect the ability of the sovereign government and/or obligors within the country to honor their obligations to the Company. Country risk exposure is measured in accordance with the Company’s internal risk management standards and includes obligations from sovereign governments, corporations, clearinghouses and financial institutions. The Company actively manages country risk exposure through a comprehensive risk management framework that combines credit and market fundamentals and allows the Company to effectively identify, monitor and limit country risk. Country risk exposure before and after hedges is monitored and managed.

The Company’s obligor credit evaluation process may also identify indirect exposures whereby an obligor has vulnerability or exposure to another country or jurisdiction. Examples of indirect exposures include mutual funds that invest in a single country, offshore companies whose assets reside in another country to that of the offshore jurisdiction and finance company subsidiaries of corporations. Indirect exposures identified through the credit evaluation process may result in a reclassification of country risk.

163 LOGO


Table of Contents

The Company conducts periodic stress testing that seeks to measure the impact on the Company’s credit and market exposures of shocks stemming from negative economic or political scenarios. When deemed appropriate by the Company’s risk managers, the stress test scenarios include possible contagion effects. Second order risks such as the impact for core European banks of their peripheral exposures may also be considered. The Company also conducts legal and documentation analysis of its exposures to obligors in peripheral jurisdictions, which are defined as exposures in Greece, Ireland, Italy, Portugal and Spain, to identify the risk that such exposures could be redenominated into new currencies or subject to capital controls in the case of country exit from the Euro-zone. This analysis, and results of the stress tests, may result in the amendment of limits or exposure mitigation.

The Company’s sovereign exposures consist of financial instruments entered into with sovereign and local governments. Its non-sovereign exposures consist of exposures to primarily corporations and financial institutions. The following table shows the Company’s ten largest non-U.S. country risk net exposures at June 30, 2014. Index credit derivatives are included in the Company’s country risk exposure tables. Each reference entity within an index is allocated to that reference entity’s country of risk. Index exposures are allocated to the underlying reference entities in proportion to the notional weighting of each reference entity in the index, adjusted for any fair value receivable/payable for that reference entity. Where credit risk crosses multiple jurisdictions, for example, a CDS purchased from an issuer in a specific country that references bonds issued by an entity in a different country, the fair value of the CDS is reflected in the Net Counterparty Exposure column based on the country of the CDS issuer. Further, the notional amount of the CDS adjusted for the fair value of the receivable/payable is reflected in the Net Inventory column based on the country of the underlying reference entity.

Country

Net
Inventory(1)
Net
Counterparty
Exposure(2)(3)
Funded
Lending
Unfunded
Commitments
Exposure
Before
Hedges
Hedges(4) Net
Exposure(5)
(dollars in millions)

United Kingdom:

Sovereigns

$ 251 $ 25 $ $ $ 276 $ (191 ) $ 85

Non-sovereigns

1,209 13,208 1,882 6,494 22,793 (2,005 ) 20,788

Subtotal

$ 1,460 $ 13,233 $ 1,882 $ 6,494 $ 23,069 $ (2,196 ) $ 20,873

Netherlands

Sovereigns

$ (236 ) $ 2 $ $ $ (234 ) $ (34 ) $ (268 )

Non-sovereigns

683 824 316 4,253 6,076 (245 ) 5,831

Subtotal

$ 447 $ 826 $ 316 $ 4,253 $ 5,842 $ (279 ) $ 5,563

France:

Sovereigns

$ (973 ) $ $ $ $ (973 ) $ (11 ) $ (984 )

Non-sovereigns

891 2,299 338 2,818 6,346 (676 ) 5,670

Subtotal

$ (82 ) $ 2,299 $ 338 $ 2,818 $ 5,373 $ (687 ) $ 4,686

Germany:

Sovereigns

$ (1,194 ) $ 200 $ $ $ (994 ) $ (1,186 ) $ (2,180 )

Non-sovereigns

67 3,011 386 4,237 7,701 (1,410 ) 6,291

Subtotal

$ (1,127 ) $ 3,211 $ 386 $ 4,237 $ 6,707 $ (2,596 ) $ 4,111

Japan:

Sovereigns

$ 2,064 $ 92 $ $ $ 2,156 $ (11 ) $ 2,145

Non-sovereigns

224 1,727 20 1,971 (50 ) 1,921

Subtotal

$ 2,288 $ 1,819 $ 20 $ $ 4,127 $ (61 ) $ 4,066

LOGO 164


Table of Contents

Country

Net
Inventory(1)
Net
Counterparty
Exposure(2)(3)
Funded
Lending
Unfunded
Commitments
Exposure
Before
Hedges
Hedges(4) Net
Exposure(5)
(dollars in millions)

Canada:

Sovereigns

$ 17 $ 73 $ $ $ 90 $ $ 90

Non-sovereigns

779 1,568 166 1,321 3,834 (55 ) 3,779

Subtotal

$ 796 $ 1,641 $ 166 $ 1,321 $ 3,924 $ (55 ) $ 3,869

Brazil:

Sovereigns

$ 2,944 $ $ $ $ 2,944 $ $ 2,944

Non-sovereigns

(72 ) 142 999 165 1,234 (402 ) 832

Subtotal

$ 2,872 $ 142 $ 999 $ 165 $ 4,178 $ (402 ) $ 3,776

Singapore:

Sovereigns

$ 2,236 $ 166 $ $ $ 2,402 $ $ 2,402

Non-sovereigns

132 494 22 315 963 (42 ) 921

Subtotal

$ 2,368 $ 660 $ 22 $ 315 $ 3,365 $ (42 ) $ 3,323

Australia:

Sovereigns

$ (122 ) $ 27 $ $ $ (95 ) $ $ (95 )

Non-sovereigns

684 301 907 1,401 3,293 (348 ) 2,945

Subtotal

$ 562 $ 328 $ 907 $ 1,401 $ 3,198 $ (348 ) $ 2,850

China:

Sovereigns

$ 426 $ 77 $ $ $ 503 $ $ 503

Non-sovereigns

1,110 308 583 86 2,087 (44 ) 2,043

Subtotal

$ 1,536 $ 385 $ 583 $ 86 $ 2,590 $ (44 ) $ 2,546

(1) Net inventory represents exposure to both long and short single-name and index positions ( i.e. , bonds and equities at fair value and CDS based on notional amount assuming zero recovery adjusted for any fair value receivable or payable). As a market maker, the Company transacts in these CDS positions to facilitate client trading. At June 30, 2014, gross purchased protection, gross written protection and net exposures related to single-name and index credit derivatives for those countries were $(339.6) billion, $337.1 billion and $(2.5) billion, respectively. For a further description of the triggers for purchased credit protection and whether those triggers may limit the effectiveness of the Company’s hedges, see “Credit Exposure—Derivatives” herein.
(2) Net counterparty exposure ( i.e ., repurchase transactions, securities lending and OTC derivatives) takes into consideration legally enforceable master netting agreements and collateral.
(3) At June 30, 2014, the benefit of collateral received against counterparty credit exposure was $8.1 billion in the U.K., with 97% of collateral consisting of cash, U.S. and U.K. government obligations, and $14.2 billion in Germany with nearly all of the collateral consisting of cash and government obligations of France, Belgium, Netherlands, Finland and Austria. The benefit of collateral received against counterparty credit exposure in the eight other countries totaled approximately $13.7 billion, with collateral primarily consisting of cash, U.S. and Japanese government obligations. These amounts do not include collateral received on secured financing transactions.
(4) Represents CDS hedges (purchased and sold) on net counterparty exposure and funded lending executed by trading desks responsible for hedging counterparty and lending credit risk exposures for the Company. Based on the CDS notional amount assuming zero recovery adjusted for any fair value receivable or payable.
(5) In addition, at June 30, 2014, the Company had exposure to these countries for overnight deposits with banks of approximately $9.3 billion.

165 LOGO


Table of Contents

Industry Exposure—OTC Derivative Products. The Company also monitors its credit exposure to individual industries for current exposure arising from the Company’s OTC derivative contracts.

The following table shows the Company’s OTC derivative products at fair value by industry at June 30, 2014:

Industry

OTC Derivative
Products(1)
(dollars in millions)

Utilities

$ 3,973

Funds, exchanges and other financial services(2)

2,974

Banks and securities firms

2,702

Special purpose vehicles

1,984

Regional governments

1,781

Healthcare

1,498

Industrials

1,115

Not-for-profit organizations

967

Sovereign governments

894

Energy

658

Other

2,071

Total

$ 20,617

(1) For further information on derivative instruments and hedging activities, see Note 10 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1.
(2) Includes mutual funds, pension funds, private equity and real estate funds, exchanges and clearinghouses and diversified financial services.

LOGO 166


Table of Contents
Item 4. Controls and Procedures.

Under the supervision and with the participation of the Company’s management, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, we conducted an evaluation of the effectiveness of the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”)). Based on this evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this report.

No change in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) of the Exchange Act) occurred during the period covered by this report that materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

167 LOGO


Table of Contents

FINANCIAL DATA SUPPLEMENT (Unaudited)

Average Balances and Interest Rates and Net Interest Income

Three Months Ended June 30, 2014
Average
Weekly
Balance
Interest Annualized
Average
Rate
(dollars in millions)

Assets

Interest earning assets:

Trading assets(1):

U.S.

$ 101,440 $ 417 1.7 %

Non-U.S.

118,709 111 0.4

Available for sale securities:

U.S.

62,007 150 1.0

Loans:

U.S.

50,565 346 2.8

Non-U.S.

406 12 12.0

Interest bearing deposits with banks:

U.S.

33,763 16 0.2

Non-U.S.

6,981 8 0.5

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed(2):

U.S.

178,601 (145 ) (0.3 )

Non-U.S.

85,654 18 0.1

Other:

U.S.

69,365 167 1.0

Non-U.S.

15,150 150 4.0

Total

$ 722,641 $ 1,250 0.7 %

Non-interest earning assets

112,784

Total assets

$ 835,425

Liabilities and Equity

Interest bearing liabilities:

Deposits:

U.S.

$ 117,278 $ 17 0.1 %

Non-U.S.

214

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings(3):

U.S.

1,013

Non-U.S.

799 2 1.0

Long-term debt(3):

U.S.

142,372 915 2.6

Non-U.S.

8,721 15 0.7

Trading liabilities(1):

U.S.

24,638

Non-U.S.

57,880

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned(4):

U.S.

89,703 136 0.6

Non-U.S.

58,904 167 1.1

Other:

U.S.

119,892 (321 ) (1.1 )

Non-U.S.

49,131 52 0.4

Total

$ 670,545 $ 983 0.6

Non-interest bearing liabilities and equity

164,880

Total liabilities and equity

$ 835,425

Net interest income and net interest rate spread

$ 267 0.1 %

LOGO 168


Table of Contents

FINANCIAL DATA SUPPLEMENT (Unaudited)—(Continued)

Average Balances and Interest Rates and Net Interest Income

Three Months Ended June 30, 2013
Average
Weekly
Balance
Interest Annualized
Average
Rate
(dollars in millions)

Assets

Interest earning assets:

Trading assets(1):

U.S.

$ 126,580 $ 521 1.7 %

Non-U.S.

104,393 92 0.4

Available for sale securities:

U.S.

41,126 110 1.1

Loans:

U.S.

31,937 254 3.2

Non-U.S.

532 24 18.3

Interest bearing deposits with banks:

U.S.

21,541 15 0.3

Non-U.S.

8,793 10 0.5

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed(2)(5):

U.S.

185,772 (101 ) (0.2 )

Non-U.S.

96,984 20 0.1

Other:

U.S.

61,827 185 1.2

Non-U.S.

20,478 138 2.7

Total

$ 699,963 $ 1,268 0.7 %

Non-interest earning assets

128,296

Total assets

$ 828,259

Liabilities and Equity

Interest bearing liabilities:

Deposits:

U.S.

$ 79,284 $ 41 0.2 %

Non-U.S.

316

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings(3):

U.S.

1,041

Non-U.S.

1,326 5 1.5

Long-term debt(3):

U.S.

154,864 900 2.4

Non-U.S.

14,033 17 0.5

Trading liabilities(1):

U.S.

31,755

Non-U.S.

60,176

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned(4)(5):

U.S.

108,117 171 0.6

Non-U.S.

74,909 200 1.1

Other:

U.S.

96,971 (304 ) (1.3 )

Non-U.S.

37,064 34 0.4

Total

$ 659,856 $ 1,064 0.7

Non-interest bearing liabilities and equity

168,403

Total liabilities and equity

$ 828,259

Net interest income and net interest rate spread

$ 204 %

169 LOGO


Table of Contents

FINANCIAL DATA SUPPLEMENT (Unaudited)—(Continued)

Average Balances and Interest Rates and Net Interest Income

Six Months Ended June 30, 2014
Average
Weekly
Balance
Interest Annualized
Average
Rate
(dollars in millions)

Assets

Interest earning assets:

Trading assets(1):

U.S.

$ 105,660 $ 810 1.6 %

Non-U.S.

117,122 219 0.4

Available for sale securities:

U.S.

58,719 288 1.0

Loans:

U.S.

47,070 703 3.0

Non-U.S.

396 27 13.8

Interest bearing deposits with banks:

U.S.

38,912 40 0.2

Non-U.S.

6,854 19 0.6

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed(2):

U.S.

175,119 (218 ) (0.3 )

Non-U.S.

85,169 82 0.2

Other:

U.S.

69,524 329 1.0

Non-U.S.

15,597 294 3.8

Total

$ 720,142 $ 2,593 0.7 %

Non-interest earning assets

113,698

Total assets

$ 833,840

Liabilities and Equity

Interest bearing liabilities:

Deposits:

U.S.

$ 115,793 $ 30 0.1 %

Non-U.S.

194

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings(3):

U.S.

880

Non-U.S.

647 2 0.6

Long-term debt(3):

U.S.

143,115 1,838 2.6

Non-U.S.

8,537 27 0.6

Trading liabilities(1):

U.S.

24,898

Non-U.S.

56,344

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned(4):

U.S.

95,941 277 0.6

Non-U.S.

61,331 352 1.2

Other:

U.S.

114,789 (608 ) (1.1 )

Non-U.S.

46,749 100 0.4

Total

$ 669,218 $ 2,018 0.6

Non-interest bearing liabilities and equity

164,622

Total liabilities and equity

$ 833,840

Net interest income and net interest rate spread

$ 575 0.1 %

LOGO 170


Table of Contents

FINANCIAL DATA SUPPLEMENT (Unaudited)—(Continued)

Average Balances and Interest Rates and Net Interest Income

Six Months Ended June 30, 2013
Average
Weekly
Balance
Interest Annualized
Average
Rate
(dollars in millions)

Assets

Interest earning assets:

Trading assets(1):

U.S.

$ 127,382 $ 1,048 1.7 %

Non-U.S.

100,285 169 0.3

Available for sale securities:

U.S.

41,269 206 1.0

Loans:

U.S.

30,292 488 3.3

Non-U.S.

542 34 12.7

Interest bearing deposits with banks:

U.S.

22,018 30 0.3

Non-U.S.

8,203 21 0.5

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed(2)(5):

U.S.

188,330 (109 ) (0.1 )

Non-U.S.

99,587 76 0.2

Other:

U.S.

62,917 371 1.2

Non-U.S.

18,528 278 3.0

Total

$ 699,353 $ 2,612 0.8 %

Non-interest earning assets

126,957

Total assets

$ 826,310

Liabilities and Equity

Interest bearing liabilities:

Deposits:

U.S.

$ 80,416 $ 82 0.2 %

Non-U.S.

309

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings(3):

U.S.

910 1 0.2

Non-U.S.

1,020 13 2.6

Long-term debt(3):

U.S.

157,661 1,842 2.4

Non-U.S.

11,976 35 0.6

Trading liabilities(1):

U.S.

36,289

Non-U.S.

60,629

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned(4)(5):

U.S.

105,574 371 0.7

Non-U.S.

72,356 406 1.1

Other:

U.S.

94,344 (593 ) (1.3 )

Non-U.S.

34,403 69 0.4

Total

$ 655,887 $ 2,226 0.7

Non-interest bearing liabilities and equity

170,423

Total liabilities and equity

$ 826,310

Net interest income and net interest rate spread

$ 386 0.1 %

171 LOGO


Table of Contents

FINANCIAL DATA SUPPLEMENT (Unaudited)—(Continued)

Rate/Volume Analysis

The following tables set forth an analysis of the effect on net interest income of volume and rate changes:

Three Months Ended June 30, 2014 versus
Three Months Ended June 30, 2013
Increase (decrease) due to
change in:
Volume Rate Net Change
(dollars in millions)

Interest earning assets

Trading Assets:

U.S.

$ (103 ) $ (1 ) $ (104 )

Non-U.S.

13 6 19

Available for sale securities:

U.S.

56 (16 ) 40

Loans:

U.S.

148 (56 ) 92

Non-U.S.

(6 ) (6 ) (12 )

Interest bearing deposits with banks:

U.S.

9 (8 ) 1

Non-U.S.

(2 ) (2 )

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed(5):

U.S.

4 (48 ) (44 )

Non-U.S.

(2 ) (2 )

Other:

U.S.

22 (40 ) (18 )

Non-U.S.

(37 ) 49 12

Change in interest income

$ 102 $ (120 ) $ (18 )

Interest bearing liabilities

Deposits:

U.S.

$ 20 $ (44 ) $ (24 )

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings:

U.S.

Non-U.S.

(2 ) (1 ) (3 )

Long-term debt:

U.S.

(73 ) 88 15

Non-U.S.

(6 ) 4 (2 )

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned(5):

U.S.

(29 ) (6 ) (35 )

Non-U.S.

(43 ) 10 (33 )

Other:

U.S.

(72 ) 55 (17 )

Non-U.S.

11 7 18

Change in interest expense

$ (194 ) $ 113 $ (81 )

Change in net interest income

$ 296 $ (233 ) $ 63

LOGO 172


Table of Contents

FINANCIAL DATA SUPPLEMENT (Unaudited)—(Continued)

Rate/Volume Analysis

Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 versus
Six Months Ended June 30, 2013
Increase (decrease) due to change in:
Volume Rate Net Change
(dollars in millions)

Interest earning assets

Trading assets:

U.S.

$ (179 ) $ (59 ) $ (238 )

Non-U.S.

28 22 50

Available for sale securities:

U.S.

87 (5 ) 82

Loans:

U.S.

270 (55 ) 215

Non-U.S.

(9 ) 2 (7 )

Interest bearing deposits with banks:

U.S.

23 (13 ) 10

Non-U.S.

(3 ) 1 (2 )

Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed(5):

U.S.

8 (117 ) (109 )

Non-U.S.

(11 ) 17 6

Other:

U.S.

39 (81 ) (42 )

Non-U.S.

(44 ) 60 16

Change in interest income

$ 209 $ (228 ) $ (19 )

Interest bearing liabilities

Deposits:

U.S.

$ 36 $ (88 ) $ (52 )

Commercial paper and other short-term borrowings:

U.S.

(1 ) (1 )

Non-U.S.

(5 ) (6 ) (11 )

Long-term debt:

U.S.

(170 ) 166 (4 )

Non-U.S.

(10 ) 2 (8 )

Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned(5):

U.S.

(34 ) (60 ) (94 )

Non-U.S.

(62 ) 8 (54 )

Other:

U.S.

(128 ) 113 (15 )

Non-U.S.

25 6 31

Change in interest expense

$ (348 ) $ 140 $ (208 )

Change in net interest income

$ 557 $ (368 ) $ 189

(1) Interest expense on Trading liabilities is reported as a reduction of Interest income on Trading assets.
(2) Includes fees paid on securities borrowed.
(3) The Company also issues structured notes that have coupon or repayment terms linked to the performance of debt or equity securities, indices, currencies or commodities, which are recorded within Trading revenues (see Note 4 to the condensed consolidated financial statements in Item 1).
(4) Includes fees received on securities loaned.
(5) During the fourth quarter of 2013, the Company identified that certain fees paid on securities borrowed which had been reported within Interest expense should have been reported within Interest income and that certain fees received on securities loaned which had been reported within Interest income should have been reported within Interest expense. The 2013 Form 10-K reflected the adjusted classification on a full year basis. To correct the corresponding 2013 quarterly periods to conform to the Form 10-K presentation, “Securities sold under agreements to repurchase and Securities loaned” and “Federal funds sold and securities purchased under agreements to resell and Securities borrowed” were reduced by $147 million and $191 million for the quarter and six months ended June 30, 2013, respectively. This adjustment had no impact on net interest income.

173 LOGO


Table of Contents

Part II—Other Information.

Item 1. Legal Proceedings.

In addition to the matters described in the Company’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended December 31, 2013 (the “Form 10-K”), the Company’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarterly period ended March 31, 2014 (the “First Quarter Form 10-Q”), and those described below, in the normal course of business, the Company has been named, from time to time, as a defendant in various legal actions, including arbitrations, class actions and other litigation, arising in connection with its activities as a global diversified financial services institution. Certain of the actual or threatened legal actions include claims for substantial compensatory and/or punitive damages or claims for indeterminate amounts of damages. In some cases, the entities that would otherwise be the primary defendants in such cases are bankrupt or in financial distress.

The Company is also involved, from time to time, in other reviews, investigations and proceedings (both formal and informal) by governmental and self-regulatory agencies regarding the Company’s business, and involving, among other matters, sales and trading activities, financial products or offerings sponsored, underwritten or sold by the Company, and accounting and operational matters, certain of which may result in adverse judgments, settlements, fines, penalties, injunctions or other relief.

The Company contests liability and/or the amount of damages as appropriate in each pending matter. Where available information indicates that it is probable a liability had been incurred at the date of the condensed consolidated financial statements and the Company can reasonably estimate the amount of that loss, the Company accrues the estimated loss by a charge to income. The Company expects future litigation accruals in general to continue to be elevated and the changes in accruals from period to period may fluctuate significantly, given the current environment regarding government investigations and private litigation affecting global financial services firms, including the Company.

In many proceedings and investigations, however, it is inherently difficult to determine whether any loss is probable or even possible or to estimate the amount of any loss. The Company cannot predict with certainty if, how or when such proceedings or investigations will be resolved or what the eventual settlement, fine, penalty or other relief, if any, may be, particularly for proceedings and investigations where the factual record is being developed or contested or where plaintiffs or government entities seek substantial or indeterminate damages, restitution, disgorgement or penalties. Numerous issues may need to be resolved, including through potentially lengthy discovery and determination of important factual matters, determination of issues related to class certification and the calculation of damages or other relief, and by addressing novel or unsettled legal questions relevant to the proceedings or investigations in question, before a loss or additional loss or range of loss or additional loss can be reasonably estimated for a proceeding or investigation. Subject to the foregoing, the Company believes, based on current knowledge and after consultation with counsel, that the outcome of such proceedings and investigations will not have a material adverse effect on the consolidated financial condition of the Company, although the outcome of such proceedings or investigations could be material to the Company’s operating results and cash flows for a particular period depending on, among other things, the level of the Company’s revenues or income for such period.

Over the last several years, the level of litigation and investigatory activity (both formal and informal) by government and self-regulatory agencies has increased materially in the financial services industry. As a result, the Company expects that it may become the subject of increased claims for damages and other relief and, while the Company has identified below certain proceedings that the Company believes to be material, individually or collectively, there can be no assurance that additional material losses will not be incurred from claims that have not yet been asserted or are not yet determined to be material.

LOGO 174


Table of Contents

The following developments have occurred with respect to certain matters previously reported in the Form 10-K and the First Quarter Form 10-Q or concern new actions that have been filed since the First Quarter Form 10-Q:

Residential Mortgage and Credit Crisis Related Matters.

Regulatory and Governmental Matters.

The Company is continuing to respond to subpoenas and requests for information from certain federal and state regulatory and governmental entities, including among others various members of the RMBS Working Group of the Financial Fraud Enforcement Task Force (“RMBS Working Group”), concerning the origination, financing, purchase, securitization and servicing of subprime and non-subprime residential mortgages and related matters such as residential mortgages backed securities (“RMBS”), collateralized debt obligations (“CDOs”), structured investment vehicles (“SIVs”) and credit default swaps backed by or referencing mortgage pass through certificates. These matters include, but are not limited to, investigations related to the Company’s due diligence on loans that it purchased for securitization, the Company’s communications with ratings agencies, the Company’s disclosures to investors, and the Company’s handling of servicing and foreclosure related issues.

On May 8, 2014, the California Attorney General’s Office (“CAAG”), which is one of the members of the RMBS Working Group, indicated that it has made certain preliminary conclusions that the Company made knowing and material misrepresentations regarding RMBS and that it knowingly caused material misrepresentations to be made regarding the Cheyne SIV, which issued securities marketed to the California Public Employees Retirement System. The CAAG has further indicated that it believes the Company’s conduct violated California law and that it may seek treble damages, penalties and injunctive relief. The Company does not agree with these conclusions and has presented defenses to them to the CAAG.

On July 23, 2014, the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission (“SEC”) approved the Company’s Offer of Settlement to resolve the SEC’s investigation of certain subprime RMBS transactions sponsored and underwritten by the Company in 2007. Pursuant to the settlement, which was previously disclosed as an agreement in principle in the Form 10-K, the Company was charged with violating Sections 17(a)(2) and 17(a)(3) of the Securities Act, agreed to pay disgorgement and penalties in an amount of $275 million and neither admitted nor denied the SEC’s findings.

Class Actions.

On July 22, 2014, the parties in In re Morgan Stanley Mortgage Pass-Through Certificates Litigation reached an agreement in principle to settle the litigation. The settlement is subject to court approval.

On July 23, 2014, the parties in In re IndyMac Mortgage-Backed Securities Litigation reached an agreement in principle to settle the litigation. The settlement is subject to court approval.

On July 17, 2014, the parties in Ge Dandong, et al. v. Pinnacle Performance Ltd. reached an agreement in principle to settle the litigation. The settlement is subject to court approval.

Other Litigation.

On May 23, 2014, plaintiff and the defendants in the upcoming bellwether trial in Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco v. Credit Suisse Securities (USA) LLC, et al. and Federal Home Loan Bank of San Francisco v. Deutsche Bank Securities Inc. et al. filed motions for summary adjudication. The Company is a defendant in these cases, but will not be a defendant in the bellwether trial.

On July 16, 2014, the plaintiff in Federal Home Loan Bank of Boston v. Ally Financial, Inc. F/K/A GMAC LLC et al . voluntarily dismissed its claims against the Company with respect to one of the securitizations at issue.

On May 15, 2014, the appellate court in Allstate Insurance Co. v. Morgan Stanley et al. denied defendants’ appeal from the trial court’s decision denying in substantial part defendants’ motion to dismiss the amended complaint.

175 LOGO


Table of Contents

On May 1, 2014, the plaintiff in Sealink Funding Limited v. Morgan Stanley, et al . filed a notice of appeal of the court’s decision granting the defendants’ motion to dismiss the complaint.

On June 23, 2014, the court in Dexia SA/NV, et al. v. Morgan Stanley, et al. denied plaintiffs’ motion to renew their opposition to defendants’ motion to dismiss the amended complaint. On July 16, 2014, plaintiffs filed a notice of appeal of that decision.

On June 5, 2014, the defendants in The Prudential Insurance Company of America, et al. v. Morgan Stanley, et al. filed a renewed motion to dismiss the amended complaint.

On July 2, 2014, the parties in Asset Management Fund d/b/a AMF Funds et al v. Morgan Stanley et al. reached an agreement to settle the litigation. On July 18, 2014, the parties filed a stipulation of voluntary discontinuance of the action with prejudice.

On June 10, 2014, the court in Deutsche Zentral-Genossenschaftsbank AG et al. v. Morgan Stanley et al. denied the defendants’ motion to dismiss the case. On July 10, 2014, the Company filed a renewed motion to dismiss with respect to two certificates at issue in the case.

On July 11, 2014, the defendants in National Credit Union Administration Board v. Morgan Stanley & Co. Inc., et al. filed a motion for reconsideration of the court’s order on the motion to dismiss the complaint or, in the alternative, for certification of interlocutory appeal and a stay of all proceedings.

On June 17, 2014, the plaintiffs in Phoenix Light SF Limited et al v. Morgan Stanley et al. filed an amended complaint against the Company and certain affiliates. The complaint alleges that defendants made untrue statements and material omissions in the sale to plaintiffs, or their assignors, of certain mortgage pass-through certificates backed by securitization trusts containing residential mortgage loans. The total amount of certificates allegedly issued by the Company and/or sold to plaintiffs or their assignors by the Company was approximately $344 million. The complaint raises common law claims of fraud, fraudulent inducement, aiding and abetting fraud, negligent misrepresentation and rescission based on mutual mistake and seeks, among other things, compensatory damages, punitive damages or alternatively rescission or rescissionary damages associated with the purchase of such certificates.

On July 21, 2014, the Company filed a motion to dismiss the complaint in Deutsche Bank National Trust Company v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital Holdings LLC .

On April 30, 2014, the defendants in Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation, as Receiver for United Western Bank v. Banc of America Funding Corp., et al. filed a motion to dismiss the complaint.

Commercial Mortgage Related Matter.

On June 16, 2014, the court in The Bank of New York Mellon Trust, National Association v. Morgan Stanley Mortgage Capital, Inc. granted the Company’s supplemental motion for summary judgment. On June 17, 2014, the court entered judgment in the Company’s favor. On July 16, 2014, the plaintiff filed a notice of appeal.

Matters Related to the CDS Market.

The Company and the other recipients of the Statement of Objections issued by the European Commission (“EC”) in July 2013 with respect to the development of exchange traded credit default swap products attended oral hearings before the EC during the period May 12-19, 2014. The Company’s oral hearing took place on May 15, 2014. On May 23, 2014, the defendants in In Re: Credit Default Swaps Antitrust Litigation filed a motion to dismiss the plaintiffs’ second consolidated amended class action complaint.

LOGO 176


Table of Contents
Item 2. Unregistered Sales of Equity Securities and Use of Proceeds.

The table below sets forth the information with respect to purchases made by or on behalf of the Company of its common stock during the quarterly period ended June 30, 2014.

Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities

(dollars in millions, except per share amounts)

Period

Total
Number of
Shares
Purchased
Average Price
Paid Per
Share
Total Number of
Shares Purchased
As Part of Publicly
Announced Plans
or Programs(C)
Approximate Dollar
Value of Shares
that May Yet Be
Purchased Under
the Plans or
Programs

Month #1

(April 1, 2014—April 30, 2014)

Share Repurchase Program(A)

1,150,900 $ 30.96 1,150,900 $ 1,024

Employee Transactions(B)

155,643 $ 30.99

Month #2

(May 1, 2014—May 31, 2014)

Share Repurchase Program(A)

4,703,800 $ 30.14 4,703,800 $ 883

Employee Transactions(B)

50,447 $ 30.19

Month #3

(June 1, 2014—June 30, 2014)

Share Repurchase Program(A)

3,395,500 $ 31.56 3,395,500 $ 776

Employee Transactions(B)

28,678 $ 31.24

Total

Share Repurchase Program(A)

9,250,200 $ 30.76 9,250,200 $ 776

Employee Transactions(B)

234,768 $ 30.85

(A) On December 19, 2006, the Company announced that its Board of Directors authorized the repurchase of up to $6 billion of the Company’s outstanding stock under a share repurchase program (the “Share Repurchase Program”). The Share Repurchase Program is a program for capital management purposes that considers, among other things, business segment capital needs, as well as equity-based compensation and benefit plan requirements. The Share Repurchase Program has no set expiration or termination date. Share repurchases by the Company are subject to regulatory approval. In March 2014, the Company received no objection from the Federal Reserve to repurchase up to $1 billion of the Company’s outstanding common stock beginning in the second quarter of 2014 through the end of the first quarter of 2015 under the Company’s 2014 capital plan. During the quarter ended June 30, 2014, the Company repurchased approximately $284 million of the Company’s outstanding common stock as part of its Share Repurchase Program. For further information, see “Liquidity and Capital Resources—Capital Management” in Part I, Item 2.
(B) Includes: (1) shares delivered or attested in satisfaction of the exercise price and/or tax withholding obligations by holders of employee and director stock options (granted under employee and director stock compensation plans) who exercised options; (2) shares withheld, delivered or attested (under the terms of grants under employee and director stock compensation plans) to offset tax withholding obligations that occur upon vesting and release of restricted shares; (3) shares withheld, delivered and attested (under the terms of grants under employee and director stock compensation plans) to offset tax withholding obligations that occur upon the delivery of outstanding shares underlying restricted stock units, and (4) shares withheld, delivered and attested (under the terms of grants under employee and director stock compensation plans) to offset the cash payment for fractional shares. The Company’s employee and director stock compensation plans provide that the value of the shares withheld, delivered or attested shall be valued using the fair market value of the Company’s common stock on the date the relevant transaction occurs, using a valuation methodology established by the Company.
(C) Share purchases under publicly announced programs are made pursuant to open-market purchases, Rule 10b5-1 plans or privately negotiated transactions (including with employee benefit plans) as market conditions warrant and at prices the Company deems appropriate, and may be suspended at any time.

Item 6. Exhibits.

An exhibit index has been filed as part of this Report on Page E-1.

177 LOGO


Table of Contents

SIGNATURE

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned thereunto duly authorized.

MORGAN STANLEY

(Registrant)

By: /s/ R UTH P ORAT

Ruth Porat

Executive Vice President and

Chief Financial Officer

By: /s/ P AUL C. W IRTH

Paul C. Wirth

Deputy Chief Financial Officer

Date: August 5, 2014

LOGO 178


Table of Contents

EXHIBIT INDEX

MORGAN STANLEY

Quarter Ended June 30, 2014

Exhibit No. Description
12 Statement Re: Computation of Ratio of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Computation of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividends.
15 Letter of awareness from Deloitte & Touche LLP, dated August 5, 2014, concerning unaudited interim financial information.
31.1 Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of Chief Executive Officer.
31.2 Rule 13a-14(a) Certification of Chief Financial Officer.
32.1 Section 1350 Certification of Chief Executive Officer.
32.2 Section 1350 Certification of Chief Financial Officer.
101 Interactive data files pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T: (i) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition—June 30, 2014 and December 31, 2013, (ii) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Income—Three Months and Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, (iii) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income—Three Months and Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, (iv) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Cash Flows—Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, (v) the Condensed Consolidated Statements of Changes in Total Equity—Six Months Ended June 30, 2014 and 2013, and (vi) Notes to Condensed Consolidated Financial Statements (unaudited).

E-1 LOGO
TABLE OF CONTENTS